US20120280971A1 - Circuits for controlling display apparatus - Google Patents
Circuits for controlling display apparatus Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20120280971A1 US20120280971A1 US13/551,025 US201213551025A US2012280971A1 US 20120280971 A1 US20120280971 A1 US 20120280971A1 US 201213551025 A US201213551025 A US 201213551025A US 2012280971 A1 US2012280971 A1 US 2012280971A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- shutter
- interconnect
- voltage
- control matrix
- data
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
Images
Classifications
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G09—EDUCATION; CRYPTOGRAPHY; DISPLAY; ADVERTISING; SEALS
- G09G—ARRANGEMENTS OR CIRCUITS FOR CONTROL OF INDICATING DEVICES USING STATIC MEANS TO PRESENT VARIABLE INFORMATION
- G09G3/00—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes
- G09G3/20—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes for presentation of an assembly of a number of characters, e.g. a page, by composing the assembly by combination of individual elements arranged in a matrix no fixed position being assigned to or needed to be assigned to the individual characters or partial characters
- G09G3/34—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes for presentation of an assembly of a number of characters, e.g. a page, by composing the assembly by combination of individual elements arranged in a matrix no fixed position being assigned to or needed to be assigned to the individual characters or partial characters by control of light from an independent source
- G09G3/3433—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes for presentation of an assembly of a number of characters, e.g. a page, by composing the assembly by combination of individual elements arranged in a matrix no fixed position being assigned to or needed to be assigned to the individual characters or partial characters by control of light from an independent source using light modulating elements actuated by an electric field and being other than liquid crystal devices and electrochromic devices
- G09G3/3473—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes for presentation of an assembly of a number of characters, e.g. a page, by composing the assembly by combination of individual elements arranged in a matrix no fixed position being assigned to or needed to be assigned to the individual characters or partial characters by control of light from an independent source using light modulating elements actuated by an electric field and being other than liquid crystal devices and electrochromic devices based on light coupled out of a light guide, e.g. due to scattering, by contracting the light guide with external means
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G09—EDUCATION; CRYPTOGRAPHY; DISPLAY; ADVERTISING; SEALS
- G09G—ARRANGEMENTS OR CIRCUITS FOR CONTROL OF INDICATING DEVICES USING STATIC MEANS TO PRESENT VARIABLE INFORMATION
- G09G3/00—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes
- G09G3/20—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes for presentation of an assembly of a number of characters, e.g. a page, by composing the assembly by combination of individual elements arranged in a matrix no fixed position being assigned to or needed to be assigned to the individual characters or partial characters
- G09G3/34—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes for presentation of an assembly of a number of characters, e.g. a page, by composing the assembly by combination of individual elements arranged in a matrix no fixed position being assigned to or needed to be assigned to the individual characters or partial characters by control of light from an independent source
- G09G3/3433—Control arrangements or circuits, of interest only in connection with visual indicators other than cathode-ray tubes for presentation of an assembly of a number of characters, e.g. a page, by composing the assembly by combination of individual elements arranged in a matrix no fixed position being assigned to or needed to be assigned to the individual characters or partial characters by control of light from an independent source using light modulating elements actuated by an electric field and being other than liquid crystal devices and electrochromic devices
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G09—EDUCATION; CRYPTOGRAPHY; DISPLAY; ADVERTISING; SEALS
- G09G—ARRANGEMENTS OR CIRCUITS FOR CONTROL OF INDICATING DEVICES USING STATIC MEANS TO PRESENT VARIABLE INFORMATION
- G09G2300/00—Aspects of the constitution of display devices
- G09G2300/08—Active matrix structure, i.e. with use of active elements, inclusive of non-linear two terminal elements, in the pixels together with light emitting or modulating elements
- G09G2300/0809—Several active elements per pixel in active matrix panels
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G09—EDUCATION; CRYPTOGRAPHY; DISPLAY; ADVERTISING; SEALS
- G09G—ARRANGEMENTS OR CIRCUITS FOR CONTROL OF INDICATING DEVICES USING STATIC MEANS TO PRESENT VARIABLE INFORMATION
- G09G2300/00—Aspects of the constitution of display devices
- G09G2300/08—Active matrix structure, i.e. with use of active elements, inclusive of non-linear two terminal elements, in the pixels together with light emitting or modulating elements
- G09G2300/0809—Several active elements per pixel in active matrix panels
- G09G2300/0833—Several active elements per pixel in active matrix panels forming a linear amplifier or follower
- G09G2300/0838—Several active elements per pixel in active matrix panels forming a linear amplifier or follower with level shifting
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G09—EDUCATION; CRYPTOGRAPHY; DISPLAY; ADVERTISING; SEALS
- G09G—ARRANGEMENTS OR CIRCUITS FOR CONTROL OF INDICATING DEVICES USING STATIC MEANS TO PRESENT VARIABLE INFORMATION
- G09G2300/00—Aspects of the constitution of display devices
- G09G2300/08—Active matrix structure, i.e. with use of active elements, inclusive of non-linear two terminal elements, in the pixels together with light emitting or modulating elements
- G09G2300/0809—Several active elements per pixel in active matrix panels
- G09G2300/0842—Several active elements per pixel in active matrix panels forming a memory circuit, e.g. a dynamic memory with one capacitor
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G09—EDUCATION; CRYPTOGRAPHY; DISPLAY; ADVERTISING; SEALS
- G09G—ARRANGEMENTS OR CIRCUITS FOR CONTROL OF INDICATING DEVICES USING STATIC MEANS TO PRESENT VARIABLE INFORMATION
- G09G2300/00—Aspects of the constitution of display devices
- G09G2300/08—Active matrix structure, i.e. with use of active elements, inclusive of non-linear two terminal elements, in the pixels together with light emitting or modulating elements
- G09G2300/0876—Supplementary capacities in pixels having special driving circuits and electrodes instead of being connected to common electrode or ground; Use of additional capacitively coupled compensation electrodes
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G09—EDUCATION; CRYPTOGRAPHY; DISPLAY; ADVERTISING; SEALS
- G09G—ARRANGEMENTS OR CIRCUITS FOR CONTROL OF INDICATING DEVICES USING STATIC MEANS TO PRESENT VARIABLE INFORMATION
- G09G2310/00—Command of the display device
- G09G2310/02—Addressing, scanning or driving the display screen or processing steps related thereto
- G09G2310/0235—Field-sequential colour display
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G09—EDUCATION; CRYPTOGRAPHY; DISPLAY; ADVERTISING; SEALS
- G09G—ARRANGEMENTS OR CIRCUITS FOR CONTROL OF INDICATING DEVICES USING STATIC MEANS TO PRESENT VARIABLE INFORMATION
- G09G2360/00—Aspects of the architecture of display systems
- G09G2360/18—Use of a frame buffer in a display terminal, inclusive of the display panel
Definitions
- the invention relates to the field of imaging displays, in particular, the invention relates to circuits for controlling light modulators incorporated into imaging displays.
- Displays built from mechanical light modulators are an attractive alternative to displays based on liquid crystal technology.
- Mechanical light modulators are fast enough to display video content with good viewing angles and with a wide range of color and grey scale. Mechanical light modulators have been successful in projection display applications.
- Direct-view displays using mechanical light modulators have not yet demonstrated sufficiently attractive combinations of brightness and low power.
- Such direct-view displays can be manufactured using a array of MEMS-based light modulators.
- the invention relates to a direct-view display that includes an array of pixels formed on a transparent substrate and a control matrix for controlling the array of pixels.
- Each of pixels in the array of pixels includes a MEMS-based light modulator with first and second opposing actuators for controlling the state of the light-modulator.
- Suitable MEMS-based light modulators include shutter-based light modulators and light-tap based modulators.
- the control matrix includes a number of features for each pixel.
- the control matrix includes a write-enabling switch for enabling the pixel to respond to a data voltage and a data switch for selectively controlling actuation of one or both of the opposing actuators in the pixel.
- control matrix includes one and only one data voltage interconnect for setting a desired state of the light modulator to form an image by controlling the data switch.
- the same data voltage interconnect is shared among a number of pixels in a column of the array.
- the control matrix also includes a voltage inverter circuit.
- the voltage inverter circuit in various implementations, is a p-mos inverter circuit, an n-mos inverter circuit, and a CMOS inverter circuit.
- the voltage inverter circuit in some instances is a level shifting inverter. In other instances, the voltage inverter circuit is a transition sharpening inverter or a switching inverter.
- the control matrix includes a cross-coupled inverter for each pixel.
- the cross-coupled inverter in one embodiment electrically couples the first and second actuators to one another.
- the cross-coupled inverter comprises a level shifting inverter.
- each pixel includes a flip flop circuit.
- the flip flop electrically connects the first and second actuators of the pixel to one another.
- the flip flop stores light modulator control instructions.
- Light modulator instructions in some embodiments may also be stored by a cross-coupled inverter included in the control matrix for each pixel.
- the first and second actuators force the shutters of the light modulators relative to an aperture.
- the aperture may be formed in a layer of material on the substrate.
- the layer of material in which the apertures are formed is a transparent substrate other than the substrate on which the light modulators are formed.
- control matrix includes a global actuation interconnect that is electrically connected to pixels in at least two rows and at least two columns of the array of pixels.
- the global actuation interconnect causes substantially simultaneous actuation of the pixels to which it is connected.
- the global actuation interconnect is electrically connected to, and thereby controls, a discharge transistor included in each pixel of the array.
- the control matrix includes a first voltage actuation interconnect.
- the first voltage actuation interconnect is distinct from the data voltage interconnect and is electrically connected to the first actuator.
- the first actuation voltage interconnect provides a voltage sufficient to actuate the first actuator.
- the control matrix includes another switch, other than the data switch for regulating the application of the voltage provided via the first actuation voltage interconnect, for each pixel in the array.
- the data switch in certain embodiments, is a transistor that selectively controls the discharge of the voltage provided by the first actuation voltage interconnect.
- Each pixel may also have be electrically connected to a common voltage interconnect in the control matrix that provides a bias voltage to the pixels to which it is connected.
- the control matrix includes a second actuation voltage interconnect.
- the second actuation voltage interconnect is distinct from both the data voltage interconnect and the first actuation voltage interconnect.
- the second actuation voltage interconnect provides a voltage sufficient to actuate the second actuators of the pixels to which it is connected.
- the application of the voltage provided by the second actuation voltage interconnect to the second actuator of a pixel is controlled by the pixel's data switch.
- the second actuation voltage interconnect directly connects a display drive to the second actuators of pixels in the array.
- the voltage provided by the second actuation voltage interconnect is insufficient to actuate the second actuator if a voltage greater than a maintenance voltage is applied to the first actuator.
- control matrix include an actuation voltage interconnect that is directly electrically connected to one of the actuators of pixels in multiple rows and in multiple columns of the array of pixels.
- the actuation voltage interconnect provides a voltage sufficient to actuate the actuators to which it is connecting barring an opposing voltage being applied to the actuators that oppose the actuators to which the shared actuation voltage interconnect connects.
- the invention relates to a direct-view display apparatus that includes voltage regulators that substantially limits variation in a voltage applied across the actuators in the display that would otherwise be caused by movement of portions of the actuators.
- voltage variation is considered substantially limited if, during actuation of an actuator, the voltage across the actuator varies less than 20% from the voltage needed to initiate actuation of the actuator.
- voltage variation is considered substantially limited if, during actuation of an actuator, the voltage across the actuator varies less than 10% from the voltage needed to initiate actuation of the actuator.
- voltage variation is considered substantially limited if, during actuation of an actuator, the voltage across the actuator varies less than 5% from the voltage needed to initiate actuation of the actuator.
- the direct-view display apparatus includes an array of pixels formed on a transparent substrate. Each pixel includes a MEMS-based light modulator. Suitable MEMS-based light modulators include shutter-based light modulators, light-tap based light modulators, and electrowetting-based light modulators. The MEMS-based light modulators include at least one electrostatic actuator for changing the state of the light modulator.
- the direct-view display apparatus also includes a control matrix.
- the control matrix is connected to the substrate and includes, for each pixel, a write-enabling interconnect, a data voltage interconnect, and a data switch.
- the write-enable interconnect of a pixel enables the pixel to respond to a data voltage applied via the data voltage interconnect.
- the data switch of a pixel electrically connects to a corresponding data voltage interconnect. Voltages applied to the pixel's data voltage interconnect thereby control the state of the pixel's light modulator.
- the voltage regulators are display drivers that include DC voltage sources.
- the display drivers are connected to light modulators in the array by actuation voltage interconnects that are distinct from the data voltage interconnects.
- the actuation voltage interconnect electrically connects directly to pixel actuators.
- the actuation voltage interconnect electrically connects to pixel actuators through a switch, other than the data switch, included in the control matrix for each pixel.
- the actuation voltage interconnect provides a substantially constant voltage throughout operation of the display. In other embodiments, the voltage on the actuation voltage interconnect varies during operation as a result of variation in display driver output.
- each pixel includes its own voltage regulator.
- the voltage regulator is a capacitor in electrical communication with the electrostatic actuator.
- the invention in a third aspect, relates to a direct-view display apparatus that includes an array of MEMS-based light modulators formed on a transparent substrate.
- the display apparatus includes a control matrix formed on the substrate.
- the control matrix includes a CMOS circuit for each pixel in the display.
- the invention in a fourth aspect, relates to a direct-view display apparatus that includes a bank-wise addressing feature.
- the display apparatus includes a transparent substrate, upon which an array of light modulators are formed.
- Suitable light modulators include, without limitation, shutter-based light modulators, electrowetting-based light modulators, and light-tap based light modulators.
- the array is organized into rows and columns. The rows are divided into at least two sets of rows. Each row in a set of rows is associated with a corresponding row in another set of rows. The associated rows are collectively referred to as a “group of associated rows.”
- the light modulators include an actuator for controlling the state of the light modulator.
- the display apparatus also includes a control matrix connected to the substrate and the light modulators.
- the control matrix For each group of associated rows in the array, the control matrix includes an electrical connection shared among the pixels of the group of associated rows that enables the group of associated rows to be actuated to an addressed state at substantially the same time. These electrical connections allow each group of associated rows to be actuated at a different times.
- the control matrix includes, for each column in the array, a single write enable switch and a single data store capacitor per set of rows.
- the display apparatus includes, for each group of associated rows, a second distinct electrical connection shared among the pixels of the associated rows. This second electrical connection provides an actuation voltage to the light modulators in the pixels to reset the pixels to an initial state.
- the display apparatus includes a charge interconnect that connects to pixels in multiple rows and in multiple columns. This charge interconnect provides an actuation voltage to the actuators in the pixels to drive the light modulators into the addressed state.
- FIG. 1A is an isometric view of display apparatus, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 1B is a block diagram of the a display apparatus, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 2 is an isometric view of a shutter assembly suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIGS. 3A and 3B are isometric views of a dual-actuated shutter assembly suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 4A is a top view of an array of shutter assemblies suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 4B is a cross sectional view of an illustrative non-shutter-based light modulator suitable for inclusion in various embodiments of the invention.
- FIG. 4C is a cross sectional view of a second illustrative non-shutter-based light modulator suitable for inclusion in various embodiments of the invention.
- FIG. 5A is a conceptual diagram of a control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 5B is an isometric view of an array of pixels incorporating the control matrix of FIG. 5A and the shutter assemblies of FIG. 2 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 6 is a diagram of a second control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 7 is a diagram of a third control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 8 is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix of FIG. 7 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 9 is a diagram of a fourth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 10 is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix of FIG. 9 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 11 is a diagram of a fifth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 12 is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix of FIG. 11 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 13 is a diagram of a sixth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 14 is a diagram of a seventh control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 15 is a diagram of an eighth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 16A is a diagram of a ninth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 16B is a diagram of a tenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 16C is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix of FIG. 16B , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 17 is a diagram of an eleventh control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 18 is a diagram of a twelfth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 19 is a diagram of a thirteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 20 is a diagram of a fourteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention
- FIG. 21 is a diagram of a fifteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 22 is a diagram of a sixteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 23 is a diagram of a seventeenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 24 is a diagram of an eighteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus of FIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 25 is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix of FIG. 24 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 26 is a schematic diagram of yet another suitable control matrix for inclusion in the display apparatus, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 27 is a schematic diagram of another control matrix suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- FIG. 28 includes three charts of voltage variations across portions of MEMS actuators that may result during actuation, according to various embodiments of the invention.
- FIG. 1A is an isometric view of a display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- the display apparatus 100 includes a plurality of light modulators, in particular, a plurality of shutter assemblies 102 a - 102 d (generally “shutter assemblies 102 ”) arranged in rows and columns.
- shutter assemblies 102 a and 102 d are in the open state, allowing light to pass.
- Shutter assemblies 102 b and 102 c are in the closed state, obstructing the passage of light.
- the display apparatus 100 can be utilized to form an image 104 for a projection or backlit display, if illuminated by lamp 105 .
- the apparatus 100 may form an image by reflection of ambient light originating from the front of the apparatus.
- the display apparatus 100 is a direct-view display in which light modulated by the shutter assemblies 102 is introduced through a backlight and is directed to a viewer without projection onto an intervening screen.
- each shutter assembly 102 corresponds to a pixel 106 in the image 104 .
- the display apparatus 100 may utilize a plurality of shutter assemblies to form a pixel 106 in the image 104 .
- the display apparatus 100 may include three color-specific shutter assemblies 102 . By selectively opening one or more of the color-specific shutter assemblies 102 corresponding to a particular pixel 106 , the display apparatus 100 can generate a color pixel 106 in the image 104 .
- the display apparatus 100 includes two or more shutter assemblies 102 per pixel 106 to provide grayscale in an image 104 .
- a “pixel” corresponds to the smallest picture element defined by the resolution of image.
- the term “pixel” refers to the combined mechanical and electrical components utilized to modulate the light that forms a single pixel of the image.
- Each shutter assembly 102 includes a shutter 108 and an aperture 109 .
- the shutter 108 is positioned such that it allows light to pass through the aperture 109 towards a viewer.
- the shutter 108 is positioned such that it obstructs the passage of light through the aperture 109 .
- the aperture 109 is defined by an opening patterned through a reflective or light-absorbing material in each shutter assembly 102 .
- the display apparatus also includes a control matrix connected to the substrate and to the shutter assemblies for controlling the movement of the shutters.
- the control matrix includes a series of electrical interconnects (e.g., interconnects 110 , 112 , and 114 ), including at least one write-enable interconnect 110 (also referred to as a “scan-line interconnect”) per row of pixels, one data interconnect 112 for each column of pixels, and one common interconnect 114 providing a common voltage to all pixels, or at least pixels from both multiple columns and multiples rows in the display apparatus 100 .
- V we the write-enable interconnect 110 for a given row of pixels prepares the pixels in the row to accept new shutter movement instructions.
- the data interconnects 112 communicate the new movement instructions in the form of data voltage pulses.
- the data voltage pulses applied to the data interconnects 112 directly contribute to an electrostatic movement of the shutters.
- the data voltage pulses control switches (also referred to as “data switches”), e.g., transistors or other non-linear circuit elements that control the application of separate actuation voltages, which are typically higher in magnitude than the data voltages, to the shutter assemblies 102 . The application of these actuation voltages then results in the electrostatic movement of the shutters 108 .
- FIG. 1B is a block diagram 150 of the display apparatus 100 .
- the display apparatus 100 includes a plurality of scan drivers 152 (also referred to as “write enabling voltage sources”) and a plurality of data drivers 154 (also referred to as “data voltage sources”).
- the scan drivers 152 apply write enabling voltages to scan-line interconnects 110 .
- the data drivers 154 apply data voltages to the data interconnects 112 .
- the data drivers 154 are configured to provide analog data voltages to the shutter assemblies, especially where the gray scale of the image 104 is to be derived in analog fashion.
- the shutter assemblies 102 are designed such that when a range of intermediate voltages is applied through the data interconnects 112 there results a range of intermediate open states in the shutters 108 and therefore a range of intermediate illumination states or gray scales in the image 104 .
- the data drivers 154 are configured to apply only a reduced set of 2, 3, or 4 digital voltage levels to the control matrix. These voltage levels are designed to set, in digital fashion, either an open state or a closed state to each of the shutters 108 .
- the scan drivers 152 and the data drivers 154 are connected to digital controller circuit 156 (also referred to as the “controller 156 ”).
- the controller includes a display interface 158 which processes incoming image signals into a digital image format appropriate to the spatial addressing and the gray scale capabilities of the display.
- the pixel location and gray scale data of each image is stored in a frame buffer 159 so that the data can be fed out as needed to the data drivers 154 .
- the data is sent to the data drivers 154 in mostly serial fashion, organized in predetermined sequences grouped by rows and by image frames.
- the data drivers 154 can include series to parallel data converters, level shifting, and for some applications digital to analog voltage converters.
- All of the drivers e.g., scan drivers 152 , data drivers 154 , actuation driver 153 and global actuation driver 155 ) for different display functions are time-synchronized by a timing-control 160 in the controller 156 .
- Timing commands coordinate the illumination of red, green and blue lamps 162 , 164 , and 166 via lamp drivers 168 , the write-enabling and sequencing of specific rows of the array of pixels, the output of voltages from the data drivers 154 , and for the output of voltages that provide for shutter actuation.
- the controller 156 determines the sequencing or addressing scheme by which each of the shutters 108 in the array can be re-set to the illumination levels appropriate to a new image 104 .
- New images can 104 be set at periodic intervals. For instance, for video displays, the color images 104 or frames of the video are refreshed at frequencies ranging from 10 to 300 Hertz.
- the setting of an image frame is synchronized with the illumination of a backlight such that alternate image frames are illuminated with an alternating series of colors, such as red, green, and blue.
- the image frames for each respective color is referred to as a color sub-frame.
- the field sequential color method if the color sub-frames are alternated at frequencies in excess of 20 Hz, the human brain will average the alternating frame images into the perception of an image having a broad and continuous range of colors.
- the controller 156 can control the addressing sequence and/or the time intervals between image frames to produce images 104 with appropriate gray scale.
- the process of generating varying levels of grayscale by controlling the amount of time a shutter 108 is open in a particular frame is referred to as time division gray scale.
- the controller 156 determines the time period or the fraction of time within each frame that a shutter 108 is allowed to remain in the open state, according to the illumination level or gray scale desired of that pixel.
- the frame time is split into, for instance, 15 equal time-duration sub-frames according to the illumination levels appropriate to a 4-bit binary gray scale.
- the controller 156 then sets a distinct image into each of the 15 sub-frames.
- the brighter pixels of the image are left in the open state for most or all of the 15 sub-frames, and the darker pixels are set in the open state for only a fraction of the sub-frames.
- the controller circuit 156 alters the duration of a series of sub-frames in proportion to the bit-level significance of a coded gray scale word representing an illumination value. That is, the time durations of the sub-frames can be varied according to the binary series 1, 2, 4, 8 . . . .
- the shutters 108 for each pixel are then set to either the open or closed state in a particular sub-frame according to the bit value at a corresponding position within the binary word for its intended gray level.
- a number of hybrid techniques are available for forming gray scale which combine the time division techniques described above with the use of either multiple shutters 108 per pixel or via the independent control of backlight intensity. These techniques are described further below.
- Addressing the control matrix i.e., supplying control information to the array of pixels, is, in one implementation, accomplished by a sequential addressing of individual lines, sometimes referred to as the scan lines or rows of the matrix.
- V we to the write-enable interconnect 110 for a given scan line and selectively applying data voltage pulses V d to the data interconnects 112 for each column
- the control matrix can control the movement of each shutter 108 in the write-enabled row.
- the control matrix can complete the set of movement instructions to each pixel in the display apparatus 100 .
- control matrix applies V we to the write-enable interconnects 110 of multiple rows of pixels simultaneously, for example, to take advantage of similarities between movement instructions for pixels in different rows of pixels, thereby decreasing the amount of time needed to provide movement instructions to all pixels in the display apparatus 100 .
- the rows are addressed in a non-sequential, e.g., in a pseudo-randomized order, in order to minimize visual artifacts that are sometimes produced, especially in conjunction with the use of a coded time division gray scale.
- the array of pixels and the control matrices that control the pixels incorporated into the array may be arranged in configurations other than rectangular rows and columns.
- the pixels can be arranged in hexagonal arrays or curvilinear rows and columns.
- scan-line shall refer to any plurality of pixels that share a write-enabling interconnect.
- FIG. 2 is diagram of an illustrative shutter assembly 200 suitable for incorporation into the display apparatus 100 of FIG. 1 .
- the shutter assembly 200 includes a shutter 202 coupled to an actuator 204 .
- the actuator 204 is formed from two separate compliant electrode beam actuators 205 , as described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035, filed on Oct. 14, 2005.
- the shutter 202 couples on one side to the actuators 205 .
- the actuators 205 move the shutter transversely over a surface in a plane of motion which is substantially parallel to the surface.
- the opposite side of the shutter couples to a spring 207 which provides a restoring force opposing the forces exerted by the actuator 204 .
- Each actuator 205 includes a compliant load beam 206 connecting the shutter 202 to a load anchor 208 .
- the load anchors 208 along with the compliant load beams 206 serve as mechanical supports, keeping the shutter 202 suspended proximate to the surface.
- the surface includes one or more apertures 211 for admitting the passage of light.
- the load anchors 208 physically connect the compliant load beams 206 and the shutter 202 to the surface and electrically connect the load beams 206 to a bias voltage, in some instances, ground.
- Each actuator 204 also includes a compliant drive beam 216 positioned adjacent to each load beam 206 .
- the drive beams 216 couple at one end to a drive beam anchor 218 shared between the drive beams 216 .
- the other end of each drive beam 216 is free to move.
- Each drive beam 216 is curved such that it is closest to the load beam 206 near the free end of the drive beam 216 and the anchored end of the load beam 206 .
- a display apparatus incorporating the shutter assembly 200 applies an electric potential to the drive beams 216 via the drive beam anchor 218 .
- a second electric potential may be applied to the load beams 206 .
- the resulting potential difference between the drive beams 216 and the load beams 206 pulls the free ends of the drive beams 216 towards the anchored ends of the load beams 206 , and pulls the shutter ends of the load beams 206 toward the anchored ends of the drive beams 216 , thereby driving the shutter 202 transversely towards the drive anchor 218 .
- the compliant members 206 act as springs, such that when the voltage across the beams 206 and 216 potential is removed, the load beams 206 push the shutter 202 back into its initial position, releasing the stress stored in the load beams 206 .
- a shutter assembly such as shutter assembly 200 , that incorporates a passive restoring force mechanism is generally referred to herein as an elastic shutter assembly.
- a number of elastic restoring mechanisms can be built into or in conjunction with electrostatic actuators, the compliant beams illustrated in shutter assembly 200 providing just one example.
- Elastic shutter assemblies can be constructed such that in an unactivated, or relaxed state, the shutters are either opened or closed. For illustrative purposes, it is assumed below that the elastic shutter assemblies described herein are constructed to be closed in their relaxed state.
- the shutter assembly may either be controlled in a analog or digital fashion.
- the beams have a strongly non-linear or divergent curvature (beams diverging with more than a second order curvature)
- the application of an analog actuation voltage across drive beams 216 and the load beams 206 results in a predetermined incremental displacement of the shutter 202 .
- the magnitude of shutter 202 displacement can be varied by applying different magnitude voltages across the drive beams 216 and the load beams 206 .
- Shutter assemblies 200 including more curved beams are therefore used to implement analog gray scale processes.
- the application of a voltage across the drive beams 216 and the load beams 206 results in shutter displacement if the voltage is greater than a threshold voltage (V at ).
- V at a threshold voltage
- Application of a voltage equaling or exceeding V at results in the maximum shutter displacement. That is, if the shutter 202 is closed absent the application of a voltage equaling or exceeding the threshold, application of any voltage equaling or exceeding V at fully opens the shutter.
- Such shutter assemblies are utilized for implementing time division and/or digital area division gray scale processes in various embodiments of the display apparatus 100 .
- FIGS. 3A and 3B are isometric views of a second shutter assembly 300 suitable for use in the display apparatus 100 .
- FIG. 3A is a view of the second shutter assembly 300 in an open state.
- FIG. 3B is a view of the second shutter assembly 300 in a closed state.
- Shutter assembly 300 is described in further detail in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035, referenced above.
- shutter assembly 300 includes actuators 302 and 304 on either side of a shutter 306 . Each actuator 302 and 304 is independently controlled.
- a first actuator, a shutter-open actuator 302 serves to open the shutter 306 .
- a second actuator, the shutter-close actuator 304 serves to close the shutter 306 .
- Both actuators 302 and 304 are preferably compliant beam electrode actuators.
- the actuators 302 and 304 open and close the shutter 306 by driving the shutter 306 substantially in a plane parallel to a surface 307 over which the shutter is suspended.
- the shutter 306 is suspended over the surface at via anchors 308 attached to the actuators 302 and 304 .
- the inclusion of supports attached to both ends of the shutter 306 along its axis of movement reduces out of plane motion of the shutter 306 and confines the motion substantially to the desired plane of motion.
- the surface 307 includes at least one aperture 309 for admitting the passage of light through the surface 307 .
- FIG. 4A is a top view of an array 400 of shutter assemblies 402 suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 .
- Each shutter assembly 402 includes a shutter 404 , a load beam 406 , and two drive beams 408 .
- the shutter assemblies 402 modulate light by transversely driving their corresponding shutters 404 such that the shutters 404 selectively interfere with light passing through apertures in a surface over which the shutters 404 are driven.
- a voltage is applied across the load beam 406 and one of the drive beams 408 .
- a first electric potential is applied to the selected drive beam and a second electric potential is applied to the load beam 406 and to the shutter 404 .
- the first and second electric potentials may be of the same polarity or they may be of opposite polarities. They also may have the same magnitude or they may have different magnitudes. Either potential may also be set to ground.
- the difference between the first and second potentials must equal or exceed an actuation threshold voltage V at .
- V at is reached by applying voltages of substantially different magnitudes to the selected drive beam and the load beam.
- V at is 40V
- the display apparatus 100 may apply 30V to the drive beam and ⁇ 10V to the load beam, resulting in a potential difference of 40V.
- P the voltage source
- V the voltage of the source
- C the total capacitance seen by the source.
- the total capacitance has several additive components, including the capacitance that exists between the load beam and drive beam, the source-drain capacitance of transistors along an interconnect line between the voltage source and the actuator (particularly for those transistors whose gates are closed), the capacitance between the interconnect line and its surroundings, including neighboring shutter assemblies and/or crossover lines, and the capacitance between the load or drive beams and their surroundings, including neighboring shutter assemblies or the display package. Since the load beam 406 is electrically coupled to the shutter 404 , the capacitance of the load beam 406 includes the capacitance of the shutter 404 .
- the capacitance between the load beam and its surroundings can represent a significant fraction of the total capacitance seen by the voltage source. Furthermore, because of the difference in area of the combined load beam 406 and shutter 404 and the area of the drive beam 408 is significant, the capacitance between the load beam and its surroundings is typically much larger than that between the drive beam and its surroundings. As a result, the CV 2 power loss experienced by voltage sources connected to either the drive or the load beams will be significantly different even if the range of their voltage excursions were to be the same.
- the actuator i.e., the load beam
- a voltage source that either does not change in voltage significantly with respect to ground or package potential, or to a voltage source that does not change voltage with the highest frequencies required by the drive system.
- the voltage difference between the drive beam and the ground or case potential represents at least half if not most of the 40 volts.
- the dashed line overlaid on the shutter assembly array 400 depicts the bounds of a single pixel 410 .
- the pixel 410 includes two shutter assemblies 402 , each of which may be independently controlled.
- a display apparatus incorporating the shutter assembly array 400 can provide three levels of gray scale per pixel using area division gray scale. More particularly, the pixel could be driven into the following states: both shutter assemblies closed; one shutter assembly opened and one shutter assembly closed; or both shutter assemblies open. Thus, the resulting image pixel can be off, at half brightness, or at full brightness.
- a display apparatus could provide yet another level of gray scale using only area division gray scale.
- the shutter assemblies 200 , 300 and 402 of FIGS. 2 , 3 and 4 A can be made bi-stable. That is, the shutters can exist in at least two equilibrium positions (e.g. open or closed) with little or no power required to hold them in either position. More particularly, the shutter assembly 300 can be mechanically bi-stable. Once the shutter of the shutter assembly 300 is set in position, no electrical energy or holding voltage is required to maintain that position. The mechanical stresses on the physical elements of the shutter assembly 300 can hold the shutter in place.
- the shutter assemblies 200 , 300 , and 402 can also be made electrically bi-stable.
- an electrically bi-stable shutter assembly there exists a range of voltages below the actuation voltage of the shutter assembly, which if applied to a closed actuator (with the shutter being either open or closed), hold the actuator closed and the shutter in position, even if an opposing force is exerted on the shutter.
- the opposing force may be exerted by a spring attached to an opposite end of the shutter, such as spring 207 in shutter assembly 200 , or the opposing force may be exerted by an opposing actuator.
- the minimum voltage needed to maintain a shutter's position against such an opposing force is referred to as a maintenance voltage V m .
- the equilibrium position of the shutter will be determined by the combined effect of the voltage differences across each of the actuators.
- the electrical potentials of all three terminals must be considered to determine the equilibrium forces on the shutter.
- a set of logic rules can describe the stable states, and can be used to develop reliable addressing or digital control schemes for the shutter. These logic rules are as follows:
- V s be the electrical potential on the shutter or load beam.
- V o be the electrical potential on the shutter-open drive beam.
- V c be the electrical potential on the shutter-close drive beam.
- V m be the maintenance voltage.
- V at be the actuation threshold voltage, i.e., the voltage necessary to actuate an actuator absent the application of V m to an opposing drive beam.
- V max be the maximum allowable potential for V o and V c .
- V m ⁇ V at ⁇ V max Then, assuming V o and V c remain below V max :
- the shutter will not move, i.e. it will hold in either the open or the closed state, whichever position was established by the last actuation event.
- condition of rule 2 makes it possible to include a global actuation function into an addressing scheme.
- a shutter voltage which provides beam voltage differences that are at least the maintenance voltage
- the absolute values of the shutter open and shutter closed potentials can be altered or switched in the midst of an addressing sequence over wide voltage ranges (even where voltage differences exceed V at ) with no danger of unintentional shutter motion.
- condition of rules 3 and 4 are those that are generally targeted during the addressing sequence to ensure the bi-stable actuation of the shutter.
- the maintenance voltage difference, V m can be designed or expressed as a certain fraction of the actuation threshold voltage, V at .
- the maintenance voltage can exist in a range between 20% and 80% of V at . This helps ensure that charge leakage or parasitic voltage fluctuations in the system do not result in a deviation of a set holding voltage out of its maintenance range—a deviation which could result in the unintentional actuation of a shutter.
- an exceptional degree of bi-stability or hysteresis can be provided, with V m existing over a range of 2% to 98% of V at . In these systems, however, care must be taken to ensure that an electrode voltage condition of V ⁇ V m can be reliably obtained within the addressing and actuation time available.
- FIG. 4B is a cross sectional view of a light tap-based light modulator 450 , suitable for inclusion in various ones of the control matrices described below.
- a light tap works according to a principle of frustrated total internal reflection. That is, light 452 is introduced into a light guide 454 , in which, without interference, light 452 is for the most part unable to escape the light guide 454 through its front or rear surfaces due to total internal reflection.
- the light tap 450 includes a tap element 456 that has a sufficiently high index of refraction that, in response to the tap element 456 contacting the light guide 454 , light 452 impinging on the surface of the light guide adjacent the tap element 456 escapes the light guide 454 through the tap element 458 towards a viewer, thereby contributing to the formation of an image.
- the tap element 456 is formed as part of beam 458 of flexible, transparent material. Electrodes 460 coat portions one side of the beam 458 . Opposing electrodes 460 are disposed on a cover plate 464 positioned adjacent the layer 458 on the opposite side of the light guide 454 . By applying a voltage across the electrodes 460 , the position of the tap element 456 relative to the light guide 454 can be controlled to selectively extract light 452 from the light guide 454 .
- the light tap 450 is only one example of a non-shutter-based MEMS modulator suitable for control by the control matrices described herein.
- Other forms of non-shutter-based MEMS modulators could likewise be controlled by various ones of the control matrices described herein without departing from the scope of the invention.
- FIG. 4C is a cross sectional view of a second illustrative non-shutter-based light modulator suitable for inclusion in various embodiments of the invention
- FIG. 4C is a cross sectional view of an electrowetting-based light modulation array 470 .
- the light modulation array 470 includes a plurality of electrowetting-based light modulation cells 472 a - 472 d (generally “cells 472 ”) formed on an optical cavity 474 .
- the light modulation array 470 also includes a set of color filters 476 corresponding to the cells 472 .
- Each cell 472 includes a layer of water (or other transparent conductive or polar fluid) 478 , a layer of light absorbing oil 480 , a transparent electrode 482 (made, for example, from indium-tin oxide) and an insulating layer 484 positioned between the layer of light absorbing oil 480 and the transparent electrode 482 .
- a transparent electrode 482 made, for example, from indium-tin oxide
- an insulating layer 484 positioned between the layer of light absorbing oil 480 and the transparent electrode 482 .
- the electrode takes up a portion of a rear surface of a cell 472 .
- the remainder of the rear surface of a cell 472 is formed from a reflective aperture layer 486 that forms the front surface of the optical cavity 474 .
- the reflective aperture layer 486 is formed from a reflective material, such as a reflective metal or a stack of thin films forming a dielectric mirror.
- a reflective material such as a reflective metal or a stack of thin films forming a dielectric mirror.
- an aperture is formed in the reflective aperture layer 486 to allow light to pass through.
- the electrode 482 for the cell is deposited in the aperture and over the material forming the reflective aperture layer 486 , separated by another dielectric layer.
- the remainder of the optical cavity 474 includes a light guide 488 positioned proximate the reflective aperture layer 486 , and a second reflective layer 490 on a side of the light guide 488 opposite the reflective aperture layer 486 .
- a series of light redirectors 491 are formed on the rear surface of the light guide, proximate the second reflective layer.
- the light redirectors 491 may be either diffuse or specular reflectors.
- One of more light sources 492 inject light 494 into the light guide 488 .
- an additional transparent substrate is positioned between the light guide 490 and the light modulation array 470 .
- the reflective aperture layer 486 is formed on the additional transparent substrate instead of on the surface of the light guide 490 .
- a voltage to the electrode 482 of a cell causes the light absorbing oil 480 in the cell to collect in one portion of the cell 472 .
- the light absorbing oil 480 no longer obstructs the passage of light through the aperture formed in the reflective aperture layer 486 (see, for example, cells 472 b and 472 c ).
- Light escaping the backlight at the aperture is then able to escape through the cell and through a corresponding color (for example, red, green, or blue) filter in the set of color filters 476 to form a color pixel in an image.
- the electrode 482 is grounded, the light absorbing oil 480 covers the aperture in the reflective aperture layer 486 , absorbing any light 494 attempting to pass through it.
- the area under which oil 480 collects when a voltage is applied to the cell 472 constitutes wasted space in relation to forming an image. This area cannot pass light through, whether a voltage is applied or not, and therefore, without the inclusion of the reflective portions of reflective apertures layer 486 , would absorb light that otherwise could be used to contribute to the formation of an image. However, with the inclusion of the reflective aperture layer 486 , this light, which otherwise would have been absorbed, is reflected back into the light guide 490 for future escape through a different aperture.
- FIG. 5A is a conceptual diagram of a control matrix 500 suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 for addressing an array of pixels.
- FIG. 5B is an isometric view of a portion of an array of pixels including the control matrix 500 .
- Each pixel 501 includes an elastic shutter assembly 502 , such as shutter assembly 200 , controlled by an actuator 503 .
- the control matrix 500 is fabricated as a diffused or thin-film-deposited electrical circuit on the surface of a substrate 504 on which the shutter assemblies 502 are formed.
- the control matrix 500 includes a scan-line interconnect 506 for each row of pixels 501 in the control matrix 500 and a data-interconnect 508 for each column of pixels 501 in the control matrix 500 .
- Each scan-line interconnect 506 electrically connects a write-enabling voltage source 507 to the pixels 501 in a corresponding row of pixels 501 .
- Each data interconnect 508 electrically connects an data voltage source, (“Vd source”) 509 to the pixels 501 in a corresponding column of pixels.
- Vd source data voltage source
- the data voltage V d provides the majority of the energy necessary for actuation.
- the data voltage source 509 also serves as an actuation voltage source.
- the control matrix 500 For each pixel 501 or for each shutter assembly in the array, the control matrix 500 includes a transistor 510 and a capacitor 512 .
- the gate of each transistor is electrically connected to the scan-line interconnect 506 of the row in the array in which the pixel 501 is located.
- the source of each transistor 510 is electrically connected to its corresponding data interconnect 508 .
- the shutter assembly 502 includes an actuator with two electrodes. The two electrodes have significantly different capacitances with respect to the surroundings.
- the transistor connects the data interconnect 508 to the actuator electrode having the lower capacitance. More particularly the drain of each transistor 510 is electrically connected in parallel to one electrode of the corresponding capacitor 512 and to the lower capacitance electrode of the actuator.
- the two electrodes of the actuator in the shutter assembly 502 have significantly different capacitances.
- the drain of the transistor 510 electrically connects to the electrode having the lower capacitance.
- the other electrode of the capacitor 512 and the higher capacitance electrode of the actuator in shutter assembly 502 are connected to a common or ground potential.
- the pixel 501 forgoes a capacitor 512 which is distinct from the shutter assembly 502 and instead relies on the capacitance inherent in the shutter assembly 502 in the pixel 501 to store the voltage needed to achieve and maintain the shutter assembly 502 state.
- the control matrix 500 write-enables each row in the array in sequence by applying V we to each scan-line interconnect 506 in turn.
- V we For a write-enabled row, the application of V we to the gates of the transistors 510 of the pixels 501 in the row allows the flow of current through the data interconnects 508 through the transistors to apply a potential to the actuator of the shutter assembly 502 . While the row is write-enabled, data voltages V d are selectively applied to the data interconnects 508 .
- the data voltage applied to each data interconnect 508 is varied in relation to the desired brightness of the pixel 501 located at the intersection of the write-enabled scan-line interconnect 506 and the data interconnect 508 .
- the data voltage is selected to be either a relatively low magnitude voltage (i.e., a voltage near ground) or to meet or exceed V at (the actuation threshold voltage).
- the actuator in the corresponding shutter assembly 502 actuates, opening the shutter in that shutter assembly 502 .
- the voltage applied to the data interconnect 508 remains stored in the capacitor 512 of the pixel even after the control matrix 500 ceases to apply V we to a row.
- the control matrix 500 can be manufactured through use of the following sequence of processing steps:
- an aperture layer 550 is formed on a substrate 504 . If the substrate 504 is opaque, such as silicon, then the substrate 504 serves as the aperture layer 550 , and aperture holes 554 are formed in the substrate 504 by etching an array of holes through the substrate 504 . If the substrate 504 is transparent, such as glass, then the aperture layer 550 may be formed from the deposition of a light blocking layer on the substrate 504 and etching of the light blocking layer into an array of holes.
- the aperture holes 554 can be generally circular, elliptical, polygonal, serpentine, or irregular in shape. As described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/218,690, filed on Sep.
- the aperture layer 550 can act as a mirror surface which recycles non-transmitted light back into an attached backlight for increased optical efficiency.
- Reflective metal films appropriate for providing light recycling can be formed by a number of vapor deposition techniques including sputtering, evaporation, ion plating, laser ablation, or chemical vapor deposition.
- Metals that are effective for this reflective application include, without limitation, Al, Cr, Au, Ag, Cu, Ni, Ta, Ti, Nd, Nb, Si, Mo and/or alloys thereof. Thicknesses in the range of 30 nm to 1000 nm are sufficient.
- an intermetal dielectric layer is deposited in blanket fashion over the top of the aperture layer metal 550 .
- a first conducting layer is deposited and patterned on the substrate. This conductive layer can be patterned into the conductive traces of the scan-line interconnect 506 . Any of the metals listed above, or conducting oxides such as indium tin oxide, can have sufficiently low resistivity for this application. A portion of the scan line interconnect 506 in each pixel is positioned to so as to form the gate of a transistor 510 .
- Intermetal dielectric layer is deposited in blanket fashion over the top of the first layer of conductive interconnects, including that portion that forms the gate of the transistor 510 .
- Intermetal dielectrics sufficient for this purpose include SiO 2 , Si 3 N 4 , and Al 2 O 3 with thicknesses in the range of 30 nm to 1000 nm.
- a layer of amorphous silicon is deposited on top of the intermetal dielectric and then patterned to form the source, drain and channel regions of a thin film transistor active layer.
- this semiconducting material can be polycrystalline silicon.
- a second conducting layer is deposited and patterned on top of the amorphous silicon.
- This conductive layer can be patterned into the conductive traces of the data interconnect 508 .
- the same metals and/or conducting oxides can be used as listed above. Portions of the second conducting layer can also be used to form contacts to the source and drain regions of the transistor 510 .
- Capacitor structures such as capacitor 512 can be built as plates formed in the first and second conducting layers with the intervening dielectric material.
- a passivating dielectric is deposited over the top of the second conducting layer.
- a sacrificial mechanical layer is deposited over the top of the passivation layer. Vias are opened into both the sacrificial layer and the passivation layer such that subsequent MEMS shutter layers can make electrical contact and mechanical attachment to the conducting layers below.
- a MEMS shutter layer is deposited and patterned on top of the sacrificial layer.
- the MEMS shutter layer is patterned with shutters 502 as well as actuators 503 and is anchored to the substrate 504 through vias that are patterned into the sacrificial layer.
- the pattern of the shutter 502 is aligned to the pattern of the aperture holes 554 that were formed in the first aperture layer 550 .
- the MEMS shutter layer may be composed of a deposited metal, such as Au, Cr or Ni, or a deposited semiconductor, such as polycrystalline silicon or amorphous silicon, with thicknesses in the range of 300 nanometers to 10 microns.
- the sacrificial layer is removed such that components of the MEMS shutter layer become free to move in response to voltages that are applied across the actuators 503 .
- the sidewalls of the actuator 503 electrodes are coated with a dielectric material to prevent shorting between electrodes with opposing voltages.
- the reflective aperture layer 550 of step 1 can be combined into the first conducting layer. Gaps are patterned into this conducting layer to provide for electrically conductive traces within the layer, while most of the pixel area remains covered with a reflective metal.
- the transistor 510 source and drain terminals can be placed on the first conducting layer while the gate terminals are formed in the second conducting layer.
- the semiconducting amorphous or polycrystalline silicon is placed directly below each of the first and second conducting layers.
- vias can be patterned into the intermetal dielectric so that metal contacts can be made to the underlying semiconducting layer.
- the shutter assembly 502 along with the control matrix 500 , can be fabricated on a separate substrate from the one on which the aperture layer 550 is formed.
- the substrate on which the control matrix 500 and shutter assembly 500 are formed is aligned with the substrate 504 on which the aperture layer 550 is formed such that the shutters align with their corresponding aperture holes 554 .
- FIG. 6 is a diagram of a second control matrix 600 suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 for addressing an array of pixels 602 .
- the pixels 602 in the control matrix 600 forgo the use of a transistor and capacitor, as are included in control matrix 500 , in favor of a metal-insulator-metal (“MIM”) diode 604 .
- the control matrix 600 includes a scan-line interconnect 606 for each row of pixels 602 in the control matrix 600 and a data interconnect 607 for each column of pixels in the control matrix 600 .
- Each scan-line interconnect 606 electrically connects to one terminal of the MIM diode 604 of each pixel 602 in its corresponding row of pixels 602 .
- the other terminal of the MIM diode 604 in a pixel 602 electrically connects to one of the two electrodes of a shutter assembly 608 , such as shutter assembly 200 , in the pixel 602 .
- the MIM diode 604 acts as a non-linear switch element which prevents current from flowing to the shutter assembly 609 unless the voltage presented between the scan line interconnect 606 and the data line interconnect 607 exceeds a threshold voltage V diode . Therefore, if voltage pulses provided by the data line interconnect 607 do not exceed V diode , such data pulses will not effect that actuation of shutter assemblies 608 connected along the data line.
- a write-enabling voltage V we is applied to a scan line interconnect 606 such that a voltage difference in excess of V diode appears between the scan line interconnect 606 and any of the several data line interconnects 607 that cross the scan line interconnect 606 , then the shutters at the intersection of the that scan line interconnect 606 and those data line interconnects 607 will receive their charge and can be actuated.
- the data voltage applied to each data interconnect 607 is varied in relation to the desired brightness of the pixel 602 located at the intersection of the write-enabled scan-line interconnect 606 and the data interconnect 607 .
- the data voltage is selected to be either close to V we (i.e., such that little or no current flows through the diode 604 ) or high enough such that V we - ⁇ V diode will meet or exceed V at (the actuation threshold voltage).
- the MIM diode 604 can be placed between the shutter assembly 608 and the data line interconnect 607 .
- the method of operation is the same as described above.
- two MIM diodes are employed, each connected to a separate and adjacent scan line.
- One electrode of the shutter assembly is connected to each of the MIM diodes on the side opposite of their respective scan lines such that the voltage appearing on the shutter electrode is almost 1 ⁇ 2 of the voltage difference between the two scan lines. In this fashion it is easier to fix the potential of one of the electrodes of the actuator to a known zero or common potential.
- the two electrodes of the shutter assembly 608 in the pixel 602 have significantly different capacitances with respect to the ground or case potential.
- the higher capacitance electrode is preferably connected to the scan line interconnect 606 (optionally, as shown, with a diode connected between shutter 608 and the scan line interconnect 606 ), since the scan line typically requires smaller voltage changes (with respect to ground) than are typically required of the data line interconnect 607 .
- the data interconnect 607 electrically connects to the lower-capacitance electrode of the shutter assembly 608 .
- FIG. 7 is a diagram of a third control matrix 700 for controlling pixels 702 incorporating shutter assemblies 703 with both open and close actuators, such as shutter assemblies 300 and 402 .
- the control matrix 700 includes scan-line interconnect 704 per row of pixels 702 in the control matrix 700 and two data interconnects 706 a and 706 b addressing each column of pixels 702 in the control matrix 700 .
- One of the data interconnects is a shutter-open interconnect 706 a and the other data interconnect is a shutter-close interconnect 706 b.
- the pixel 702 includes two transistor-capacitor pairs, one pair for each data-interconnect 706 a and 706 b addressing the pixel.
- the gates of both transistors in the pixel 702 electrically couple to the scan-line interconnect 704 corresponding to the row of the control matrix 700 in which the pixel 702 is located.
- the source of one of the transistors, the shutter-open transistor 708 a electrically connects to the shutter-open data-interconnect 706 a of the column in which the pixel 702 is located.
- the drain of the shutter-open transistor 708 a electrically connects, in parallel, to one electrode of one of the capacitors, the shutter-open capacitor 710 a , and to one electrode of the shutter-open actuator of the shutter assembly 703 of the pixel.
- the other electrode of the shutter-open capacitor 710 a electrically connects to ground or to a bias interconnect set to a common voltage among the pixels 702 .
- the source of the other transistor in the pixel 702 electrically connects to the shutter-close data interconnect 706 b of the column in which the pixel 702 is located.
- the drain of the shutter-close transistor 708 b electrically connects, in parallel, to the other of the capacitors in the pixel, the shutter-close capacitor 710 b , and to one of the electrodes of the shutter-close actuator of the shutter assembly 703 .
- Both the shutter-open actuator and the shutter-close actuator of the shutter assembly 703 include two electrodes. One electrode in each actuator has a significantly higher capacitance than the other.
- the drains of the shutter-open and the shutter-close transistors electrically connect to the lower-capacitance electrodes of their corresponding actuators.
- the control matrix of FIG. 7 employs n-channel transistors. Other embodiments are possible that employ p-channel MOS transistors.
- the transistors 708 a and 708 b can be replaced by MIM diodes or other non-linear circuit elements or switches.
- the capacitors 710 a and 710 b can be removed altogether, their function replaced by the effective capacitance of the shutter-open and shutter-closed actuators.
- a separate pair of shutter-open data interconnects and shutter-closed data interconnects, along with associated transistors and capacitors, can be provided for each shutter within the pixel.
- FIG. 8 is flow chart of a method 800 of addressing the pixels 702 controlled by the control matrix 700 of FIG. 7 to form an image frame.
- the steps carried out to address a single image frame are referred to collectively as a “frame addressing cycle.”
- the method begins by write-enabling the first scan line in the display (step 802 ).
- the control matrix 700 applies V we , (e.g., +45V for nMOS transistors or ⁇ 45V for pMOS transistors), to the scan line interconnect 704 in the control matrix 700 corresponding to the first row in the control matrix and grounds the other scan-line interconnects 704 .
- V we e.g., +45V for nMOS transistors or ⁇ 45V for pMOS transistors
- the control matrix 700 then writes data to each pixel 702 in the write-enabled scan line (decision block 804 to step 812 ).
- the data corresponds to the desired states of the shutter assemblies 703 in those pixels 702 .
- the data writing process (decision block 804 to step 812 ) is described below in relation to a single pixel 702 in a selected column in the write-enabled scan line.
- the control matrix 700 also writes data in the same fashion to the remaining pixels 702 in the write-enabled scan line.
- V d is selected to raise the voltage across the electrodes of the shutter-open actuator in the shutter assembly 703 to equal or exceed the voltage necessary for actuation, V at .
- the control matrix 700 grounds the shutter-close interconnect 706 b of the column (step 808 ).
- the control matrix 700 applies the data voltage V d to the shutter-close interconnect 706 b (step 810 ) and grounds the shutter-open interconnect 706 a of the column (step 812 ). Once the voltage across the electrodes of the desired actuator builds up to V at , the actuator, if not previously in the desired position, actuates (step 814 ), moving the shutter in the shutter assembly 703 to the desired position.
- the control matrix 700 grounds the scan-line interconnect 704 (step 814 ) and write-enables the next scan line (step 816 ). The process repeats until all pixels 702 in the control matrix 700 are addressed.
- a backlight to which the control matrix is affixed is turned off. Then, after all scan lines in the control matrix 700 have been addressed, the backlight is turned back on. Synchronizing the switching of the backlight off and on with the beginning and end of a period during which a frame is addressed improves the color purity of the resultant image since then the backlight is on only when all pixels are already set to their correct image state.
- An actuation event is determined by noting the voltage differences that appear across the shutter-open actuator and the shutter closed actuator. For consistent actuation, generally one of these voltage differences will be kept close to zero, or at least below a certain maintenance voltage V m , while the absolute value of the other voltage difference will exceed the actuation voltage. Consistent with the actuation conditions described with respect to FIGS. 2 , 3 , and 4 A, the polarities of applied voltages, such as V d , can be either negative or positive, and the voltage applied to the common potential (indicated as “ground” in FIG. 7 or at step 812 ), can be any voltage either positive or negative.
- polarity reversal can be accomplished by maintaining the common electrode of all shutters 703 at a potential close to zero while reversing the polarity of the data voltage, V d .
- polarity reversal can be accomplished by setting the common voltage to V common , where V common is equal to or greater than V at , and then providing a voltage source such that the data voltage either alternates between V common and 2*V at or between zero and V common .
- control matrices 500 and 600 Similar advantageous use of polarity reversals and the use of non-zero common voltages can be applied to the control matrices 500 and 600 .
- the flow chart of method 800 is drawn for the case where only digital information is written into an image frame, i.e. where the shutters are intended to be either open or closed.
- a similar method of image frame addressing can be employed for the provision of gray scale images built upon loading analog data through data interconnects 706 a and 706 b .
- intermediate voltages are intended to produce only partial openings of the shutters 703 .
- the voltages applied across the shutter-open actuators will tend to move the shutters in directions opposite to the motion induced by voltages across the shutter-closed actuators.
- pairs of complementary voltages that, when applied simultaneously across these two actuators, will result in controlled and pre-determined states of partial shutter opening.
- voltages loaded into the interconnects at steps 806 or 810 are complementary. That is, if V d is loaded into one of the interconnects, then the other interconnect is usually grounded. Changing the state of the shutter assembly 703 (e.g. from closed to open) is conceptually, then, a matter of transferring the charge stored on one actuator over to its opposing actuator.
- the frame addressing method 800 can provide a step where the data line interconnects 706 a and 706 b are shorted together within the voltage source electronics for a brief period between steps 802 and 804 . For the brief period in which these interconnects are shorted they will share the stored charge, so at least a fraction of the previous charge becomes available on whichever of the data line interconnects is to be brought back into its fully charged state.
- FIG. 9 is another illustrative control matrix 900 suitable for addressing an array of pixels in display device 100 .
- the control matrix 900 is similar to the control matrix 700 . That is, the control matrix 900 includes a scan-line interconnect 904 for each row of pixels in the control matrix 900 and two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 906 a and a shutter-close interconnect 906 b , for each column of pixels 902 in the control matrix.
- each pixel in the control matrix 900 includes a shutter open-transistor (or optionally a diode or varistor) 908 a , a shutter-close transistor (or optionally a diode or varistor) 908 b , a shutter-open capacitor 910 a , a shutter-close actuator 910 b , and a shutter assembly 912 .
- the shutter assembly is either mechanically and/or electrically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 900 includes an additional controllable interconnect, a global actuation interconnect 914 .
- the global actuation interconnect 914 substantially simultaneously provides about the same voltage (a “common voltage”) to pixels 902 in at least two rows and two columns of the control matrix 900 .
- the global actuation interconnect 914 provides a common voltage to all pixels 902 in the control matrix 900 .
- the higher capacitance electrode of the actuators of the shutter assemblies 912 in each pixel 902 in the control matrix 900 electrically connect to the global actuation interconnect 914 instead of to ground.
- the inclusion of the global actuation interconnect 914 enables the near simultaneous actuation of pixels 902 in multiple rows of the control matrix 900 .
- all actuators that actuate to set a given image frame e.g., all shutters that move
- the use of a global actuation process temporally decouples the writing of data to a pixel 902 from the actuation the shutter assembly 912 in the pixel 902 .
- the global actuation feature incorporated into the control matrix 900 takes advantage of the bi-stability of the shutter assemblies 912 in the control matrix 900 .
- Actuating an electrically bi-stable shutter assembly requires that two conditions be satisfied simultaneously, that the absolute value of voltage across one electrode exceeds V at , while the absolute value of the voltage across the other electrode is less than a maintenance voltage V m .
- V m a maintenance voltage
- the shutter-open actuator of an electrically bi-stable shutter assembly has a V at of 40V.
- the application of 10V maintenance voltage across the electrodes of the shutter-close actuator may keep the shutter of the shutter assembly in a closed position even when 60V is applied across the electrodes of the shutter-open actuator.
- a ⁇ 10V bias potential is applied between the higher-capacitance electrodes of all shutter assemblies and ground via the global common interconnect, while the ground potential is applied to one of the actuation electrodes, then a data voltage of +40V can be applied to the lower-capacitance electrodes of selected actuators in the shutter assemblies, thereby yielding a +50V potential difference across those actuators, without causing the actuators to actuate.
- the voltage across the electrodes of the selected actuators is reduced to +40V while the voltage across the opposing actuator is removed.
- +40V still equals the actuation voltage of the actuator and no maintenance voltage is keeping the opposing actuator in position, the selected actuators all move in concert. Another example is described in further detail below in relation to FIG. 10 .
- FIG. 10 is flow chart of a method 1000 of addressing an image frame using the control matrix 900 of FIG. 9 .
- the method begins by setting the global common interconnect 914 to a maintenance voltage V m , e.g., 1 ⁇ 2 V at (step 1001 ) with respect to ground.
- V m maintenance voltage
- the control matrix 900 write-enables the first scan line in the display (step 1002 ).
- the control matrix 900 applies V we , e.g., +45V, to a first scan-line interconnect 904 in the control matrix 900 and grounds the other scan-line interconnects 904 .
- the control matrix 900 then writes data to each pixel 902 in the write-enabled scan line corresponding to the desired states of those pixels in the next image frame (decision block 1004 to step 1012 ).
- the data writing process is described below in relation to a single pixel 902 in a selected column in the write-enabled scan line.
- the control matrix 900 also writes data in the same fashion to the remaining pixels 902 in the write-enabled scan line.
- the control matrix 900 applies a data voltage, V d , to the shutter-open interconnect of the selected column (step 1006 ).
- V d is selected such that before the application of a global actuation voltage, V ag , to the global common interconnect 914 , the voltage across the shutter-open actuator in the pixel 902 remains insufficient to overcome the bias applied to the shutter-close actuator, but such that after the application of V ag to the global common interconnect 914 , the voltage across the electrodes of the shutter-open actuator is sufficient for the shutter-open actuator to actuate. For example, if V at equals 40V, V m equals 20V, and V ag equals ground, then V d is selected to be greater than or equal to 40V, but less than the potential that would overcome V m .
- the control matrix 900 applies V d to the shutter-open interconnect 906 a of the selected column (step 1006 )
- the control matrix 900 grounds the shutter-close interconnect 906 b of the column (step 1008 ).
- control matrix 900 applies the data voltage V d to the shutter-close interconnect 906 b (step 1010 ) and grounds the shutter-open interconnect 906 a of the column (step 1012 ).
- the control matrix 900 After the control matrix 900 writes data to the pixels 902 in the write-enabled scan line in steps 1006 - 1012 , the control matrix 900 grounds the currently write-enabled scan-line interconnect 904 (step 1014 ) and write-enables the next scan line (step 1016 ). The process repeats until all pixels 902 in the control matrix 900 are addressed (see decision block 1015 ). After all pixels in the control matrix 900 are addressed (see decision block 1015 ), the control matrix 900 applies the global common voltage V ag to the global common interconnect (step 1018 ), thereby resulting in a near simultaneous global actuation of the shutter assemblies 912 in the control matrix 900 .
- the global common interconnect serves as a global actuation interconnect.
- the method 1000 may also include the synchronization of a backlight with shutter actuation.
- the backlight can be kept on for a larger percentage of the time a display is in operation, therefore yielding a brighter display for the same level of driving power in a backlight.
- a backlight is synchronized such that it is off when ever the shutters in one row of a control matrix are set for one image frame while shutters in other rows of the control matrix are set for a different image frame.
- control matrices that do not employ global actuation for every frame of video, the backlight is turned off during the entire data writing process (approximately 500 microseconds to 5 milliseconds), as each row of pixels actuates as it is addressed.
- the backlight can remain on while the data writing process takes place because no pixels change state until after all the data has been written.
- the backlight is only turned off (if at all), during the much shorter time beginning after the last scan line is written to, and ending a sufficient time after the global actuation voltage is applied for the pixels to have changed states (approximately 10 microseconds to 500 microseconds).
- An actuation event in the method 1000 is determined by noting the voltage differences that appear across the shutter-open actuator and the shutter closed actuator. Consistent with the actuation conditions described with respect to FIGS. 2 , 3 , and 4 A, the polarities of applied voltages, such as V d , can be either negative or positive, and the voltage applied to the global common interconnect can be any voltage either positive or negative.
- polarity reversal can be accomplished by reversing the signs of most of the potentials employed in Method 1000, with the exception of the write-enable voltage.
- voltages similar to those used in Method 1000 can be applied but with a complementary logic. Table 1 shows the differences between the nominal voltage assignments as described above for method 1000 and the voltages which could be applied in order to achieve polarity reversal on the electrodes of the shutter assemblies. In the first case, called Polarity Reversal Method 1, the voltages which appear across actuator electrodes are merely reversed in sign.
- V d instead of applying V d to the shutter-open electrode, for instance, ⁇ V d would be applied.
- a voltage shift should be employed (both gate voltages shifting down by an amount V d ). These gate voltage shifts ensure that the nMOS transistors operate correctly with the new voltages on the data interconnects.
- Table 1 also shows a second method, Polarity Reversal Method 2, which allows the use of similar voltages (without having to reverse signs on any interconnect drivers), but still achieves polarity reversal across all actuators. This is accomplished by driving the global actuation interconnect to the higher voltage, V d , instead of toward ground as in Method 1000 in order to move selected shutters.
- the sequence of voltage changes in Polarity Reversal Method 2 is similar to that of Method 1000, except that a complementary logic is now employed at step 1004 when assigning voltages to the actuators of each pixel.
- this Method 2 if the shutter is to be closed, then the shutter-open interconnect would be brought up to the potential V d , while the shutter-closed interconnect would be grounded.
- the potential across the shutter-open actuator would be near to zero (certainly less than V m ), while the potential across the shutter-closed actuator would be ⁇ V d , sufficient to actuate the shutter to the closed position and with a polarity that is the reverse of what was applied in Method 1000.
- the shutter-closed interconnect would be brought up to the potential Vd while the shutter-open interconnect is grounded.
- the control matrix 900 can alternate between the voltages used in Method 1000 and that used with the above Polarity Reversal Methods in every frame or on some other periodic basis. Over time, the net potentials applied across the actuators on shutter assemblies 1408 by the charge interconnect 1406 and the global actuation interconnect 1416 average out to about 0V.
- Actuation methods can also be applied to single-sided or elastic shutter assemblies, such as with shutter assemblies 502 in control matrix 500 . Such single-sided applications will be illustrated in conjunction with FIG. 14 below.
- FIG. 11 is a diagram of another control matrix 1100 suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 .
- the control matrix 1100 includes a series of scan-line interconnects 1104 , with one scan-line interconnect 1104 corresponding to each row of pixels 1102 in the control matrix 1100 .
- the control matrix 1100 includes a single data interconnect 1106 for each column of pixels 1102 in the control matrix.
- the control matrix 1100 is suitable for controlling elastic shutter assemblies 1108 , such as shutter assembly 200 .
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 1108 in the control matrix 1100 have one higher-capacitance electrode and one lower-capacitance electrode.
- the control matrix 1100 includes a charge interconnect 1110 (also labeled as V(at)) and a charge trigger interconnect 1112 (also labeled as C-T).
- the charge interconnect 11100 and the charge trigger interconnect 1112 may be shared among all pixels 1102 in the control matrix 1100 , or some subset thereof. For example, each column of pixels 1100 may share a common charge interconnect 1110 and a common charge trigger interconnect 1112 .
- the following description assumes the incorporation of a globally shared charge interconnect 1110 and a globally common charge trigger interconnect 1112 .
- Each pixel 1102 in the control matrix 1100 includes two transistors, a charge trigger switch transistor 1114 and a discharge switch transistor 1116 .
- the gate of the charge trigger switch transistor 1114 is electrically connected to the charge trigger interconnect 1112 of the control matrix 1100 .
- the drain of the charge trigger switch transistor 1114 is electrically connected to the charge interconnect 1110 .
- the charge interconnect 1110 receives a DC voltage sufficient to actuate the actuators of the shutter assembly 1108 in each pixel 1102 , absent the application of any bias voltage to the scan line interconnect 1104 .
- the source of the charge trigger switch transistor 1114 is electrically connected to the lower capacitance electrode of the actuator in the shutter assembly 1108 in the pixel 1102 and to the drain of the discharge switch transistor 1116 .
- the gate of the discharge switch transistor 1116 is electrically connected to the data interconnect 1106 of the column of the control matrix 1100 in which the pixel 1102 is located.
- the source of the discharge switch transistor 1116 is electrically connected to the scan-line interconnect 1104 of the row of the control matrix 1100 in which the pixel 1102 is located.
- the higher-capacitance electrode of the actuator in the shutter assembly 1108 is also electrically connected to the scan-line interconnect 1104 of row corresponding to the pixel. Alternately, the higher capacitance electrode can be connected to a separate ground or common electrode.
- FIG. 12 is a flow chart of a method 1200 of addressing the pixels incorporated into a control matrix, such as control matrix 1100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- control matrix 1100 actuates all unactuated actuators of the shutter assemblies 1108 incorporated into the control matrix 1100 , such that all shutter assemblies 1108 are set to the same position (open or closed) (steps 1202 - 1204 ).
- the control matrix 1100 applies a charge trigger voltage, e.g., 45V, to the charge trigger interconnect 1112 , activating the charge trigger switch transistors 1114 of the pixels (step 1202 ).
- a charge trigger voltage e.g., 45V
- the electrodes of the actuators incorporated into the shutter assemblies 1108 of the pixels 1108 serve as capacitors for storing the voltage V at supplied over the charge interconnect 1110 , e.g., 40V.
- the control matrix 1100 continues to apply the charge trigger voltage (step 1202 ) for a period of time sufficient for all actuators to actuate, and then the control matrix 1100 grounds the charge trigger switch transistor 1114 (step 1204 ).
- the control matrix 1100 applies a bias voltage V b , e.g., 10V with respect to ground, to all scan-line interconnects 1104 in the control matrix 1100 (step 1206 ).
- the control matrix 1100 then proceeds with the addressing of each pixel 1102 in the control matrix, one row at a time (steps 1208 - 1212 ). To address a particular row, the control matrix 1100 write-enables a first scan line by grounding the corresponding scan-line interconnect 1104 (step 1208 ). Then, at decision block 1210 , the control matrix 1100 determines for each pixel 1102 in the write-enabled row whether the pixel 1102 needs to be switched out of its initial frame position. For example, if at step 1202 , all shutters are opened, then at decision block 1210 , it is determined whether each pixel 1102 in the write-enabled row is to be closed.
- the control matrix 1100 applies a data voltage, for example 5V, to the data interconnect 1106 corresponding to the column in which that pixel 1102 is located (step 1212 ).
- a data voltage for example 5V
- the scan-line interconnect 1104 for the write-enabled row is grounded (step 1208 )
- the application of the data voltage V d to the data interconnect 1106 of the column results in a potential difference between the gate and the source of the discharge switch transistor 1116 of the correct sign and magnitude to open the channel of the transistor 1116 .
- the charge stored in the shutter assembly actuator can be discharged to ground through the scan line interconnect 1104 .
- the restoring force or spring in the shutter assembly 1108 forces the shutter into its relaxed position, closing the shutter. If at decision block 1210 , it is determined that no state change is necessary for a pixel 1102 , the corresponding data interconnect 1106 is grounded.
- the relaxed position in this example is defined as the shutter-closed position
- alternative shutter assemblies can be provided in which the relaxed state is a shutter-open position. In these alternative cases, the application of data voltage V d , at step 1212 , would result in the opening of the shutter.
- the data voltage V d can be significantly less than the actuation voltage V at (e.g., 5V vs. 40V). Since the actuation voltage V at is applied once a frame, whereas the data voltage V d may be applied to each data interconnect 1106 as may times per frame as there are rows in the control matrix 1100 , control matrices such as control matrix 1100 may save a substantial amount of power in comparison to control matrices which require a data voltage to be high enough to also serve as the actuation voltage.
- the bias voltage V b applied to their corresponding scan-line interconnects 1104 keeps the potential at their discharge transistor 1116 sources greater than the potentials at their discharge transistor 1116 gate terminals, even when a data voltage V d is applied to the data interconnect 1106 of their corresponding columns.
- FIG. 11 assumes the use of n-channel MOS transistors. Other embodiments are possible that employ p-channel transistors, in which case the relative signs of the bias potentials V b and V d would be reversed.
- the discharge switch transistor 1116 can be replaced by a set of two or more transistors, for instance if the control matrix 1100 were to be built using standard CMOS technology the discharge switch transistor could be comprised of a complementary pair of nMOS and pMOS transistors.
- the method 1200 assumes digital information is written into an image frame, i.e. where the shutters are intended to be either open or closed. Using the circuit of control matrix 1100 , however, it is also possible to write analog information into the shutter assemblies 1108 . In this case, the grounding of the scan line interconnects is provided for only a short and fixed amount of time and only partial voltages are applied through the data line interconnects 1106 . The application of partial voltages to the discharge switch transistor 1116 , when operated in a linear amplification mode, allows for only the partial discharge of the electrode of the shutter assembly 1108 and therefore a partial opening of the shutter.
- the control matrix 1100 selectively applies the data voltage to the remaining columns of the control matrix 1100 at the same time. After all pixels have achieved their intended states (step 1214 ), the control matrix 1100 reapplies V b to the selected scan-line interconnect and selects a subsequent scan-line interconnect (step 1216 ). After all scan-lines have been addressed, the process begins again. As with the previously described control matrices, the activity of an attached backlight can be synchronized with the addressing of each frame.
- FIG. 13 is a diagram of another control matrix 1300 suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- the control matrix 1300 is similar to control matrix 1100 , though pixels 1302 in the control matrix 1300 include charge diodes 1304 as opposed to charge trigger switch transistors 1114 , and the control matrix 1300 lacks a charge trigger interconnect 1112 .
- the control matrix 1300 includes one data interconnect 1306 for each column in the control matrix 1300 and one scan-line interconnect 1308 for each row in the control matrix 1300 , and a discharge transistor 1309 .
- the control matrix 1300 also includes a charge interconnect 1310 (also labeled as V(at)) similar to that incorporated into control matrix 1100 .
- the control matrix 1300 includes a actuation voltage source electrically connected to the charge interconnect 1310 .
- the actuation voltage source supplies pulses of voltage at the beginning of each frame addressing cycle, allowing current to flow into the shutter assemblies 1314 of the pixels 1302 in the control matrix 1300 and thereby actuating any unactuated actuators in the shutter assemblies 1314 .
- all of the pixels 1302 in the control matrix 1300 are in the same state, open or closed.
- the charge diode 1304 prevents the voltage stored in the shutter assemblies 1314 to be dissipated via the charge interconnect 1310 .
- the control matrix 1300 can be controlled using a method similar to the pixel addressing method 1200 . Instead of applying a voltage to the charge trigger interconnect 1112 at step 1202 , the actuation voltage source supplies a voltage pulse having duration and magnitude sufficient to open any closed shutter assemblies.
- the higher-capacitance electrode of shutter assemblies 1108 and 1314 be connected to the scan line interconnects 1104 and 1308 , while the lower-capacitance electrode be connected through transistor 1114 or through diode 1304 to the charge interconnects 1112 or 1310 .
- the voltage changes driven onto the shutter electrodes through the charge interconnects will generally be higher in magnitude than those experienced through the scan line interconnects.
- FIG. 14 is a diagram of a control matrix 1400 suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 .
- the control matrix 1400 includes the components of control matrix 1300 , i.e., scan-line interconnects 1402 , data-interconnects 1404 , and a charge interconnect 1406 .
- the pixels 1408 in the control matrix 1400 include a charge diode 1410 , a shutter assembly 1412 , and discharge transistor 1414 .
- Control matrix 1400 also includes a global actuation interconnect 1416 for providing global actuation of the pixels 1408 in the control matrix 1400 , using a method similar to that described in relation to FIGS. 9 and 10 .
- the control matrix also includes an optional capacitor 1418 , which is connected in parallel with the source and drain of the discharge transistor 1414 .
- the capacitor helps maintain a stable voltage at one electrode of shutter assembly 1412 despite voltage changes which might be applied on the other electrode through the global actuation interconnect 1416
- the interconnect 1416 is shared among pixels 1408 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array.
- the global actuation interconnect if used in a mode similar to polarity reversal method 2 of Table 1, may be employed to ensure a 0V DC average mode of operation in addition to providing an actuation threshold voltage.
- the control matrix alternates between control logics.
- the control matrix 1400 opens the shutter assemblies 1412 of all pixels in the control matrix 1400 by storing V at across the electrodes of the shutter assembly 1412 actuator.
- the control matrix 1400 then applies a bias voltage to lock the shutter assemblies 1412 in the open state.
- Control matrix 1400 applies a bias voltage, e.g., 1 ⁇ 2 V at , which is greater than V m , via the global actuation interconnect 1416 . Then, to change the state of a shutter assembly 1412 , when the row of pixels 1408 in which the shutter assembly 1412 is located is write-enabled, the control matrix 1400 discharges the stored V at in the shutter assembly 1412 . The maintenance voltage keeps the shutter assembly 1412 open until the global actuation interconnect 1416 is grounded.
- a bias voltage e.g., 1 ⁇ 2 V at
- the control matrix changes the voltage applied to the global actuation interconnect 1416 from 1 ⁇ 2 V at to V at .
- the control matrix 1400 discharges the stored V at from shutter assemblies that are to remain open, as opposed to those that are closed.
- the control matrix 1400 can alternate between the control logics every frame or on some other periodic basis. Over time, the net potentials applied across the actuators of the shutter assemblies 1408 by the charge interconnect 1406 and the global actuation interconnect 1416 average out to 0V.
- FIG. 15 is a diagram of still another suitable control matrix 1500 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- the control matrix 1500 is similar to the control matrix 1100 of FIG. 11 .
- Control matrix 1500 includes a data interconnect 1502 for each column of pixels 1504 in the control matrix 1500 and a scan-line interconnect 1506 for each row of pixels 1504 in the control matrix 1500 .
- the control matrix 1500 includes a common charge trigger interconnect 1508 and a common charge interconnect 1510 .
- the pixels 1504 in the control matrix 1500 each include an elastic shutter assembly 1511 , a charge trigger switch transistor 1512 and a discharge switch transistor 1514 , as described in FIG. 11 .
- Control matrix 1500 also incorporates a global actuation interconnect 1516 and its corresponding functionality described in FIG. 9 in relation to control matrix 900 .
- Control matrix 1500 also incorporates an optional voltage stabilizing capacitor 1517 which is connected in parallel with the source and drain of discharge switch transistor 1514 .
- Each pixel 1504 of control matrix 1500 also includes a third transistor, a write-enable transistor 1518 , and a data store capacitor 1520 .
- the scan-line interconnect 1506 for a row of pixels 1504 connects to the gates of the write-enable transistor 1518 incorporated into each pixel 1504 in the row.
- the data interconnects 1502 for the columns of the control matrix 1500 electrically connect to the source terminals of the write-enable transistors 1518 of the pixels 1504 in the column.
- the drain of the write-enable transistors 1518 in each pixel 1504 electrically connect in parallel to the data store capacitor 1520 and the gate terminal of the discharge trigger transistor 1514 of the respective pixels 1504 .
- the operation of the control matrix 1500 includes elements in common with each of the methods 1000 and 1200 .
- a voltage is applied to the charge trigger interconnect 1508 and the charge interconnect 1510 of the control matrix 1500 to build up a potential, V at , on one shutter assembly 1511 actuator electrode of each pixel 1504 in the control matrix 1500 to open any closed shutter assemblies 1511 .
- V at a potential
- Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, except instead of performing the write-enable as a grounding of corresponding scan-line interconnects as was done with respect to FIGS.
- the control matrix 1500 applies a write-enabling voltage V we to the scan-line interconnect 1506 corresponding to each row. While a particular row of pixels 1504 is write-enabled, the control matrix 1500 applies a data voltage to each data interconnect 1508 of the control matrix 1500 corresponding to a column that incorporates a pixel 1502 in the write-enabled row that is to be closed.
- the application of V we to the scan-line interconnect 1506 for the write-enabled row turns on the write-enable transistors 1518 of the pixels 1504 in the corresponding scan line.
- the voltages applied to the data interconnects 1502 are thereby allowed to be stored on the data store capacitors 1520 of the respective pixels 1504 .
- the discharge switch transistor 1514 is activated, allowing the charge applied to the corresponding shutter assembly 1511 via the charge trigger switch transistor 1514 to discharge.
- the discharge of the larger voltage, V at stored in the shutter assembly 1511 , however, can take more time than is needed to store the relatively small data voltage on the data store capacitor 1520 .
- the discharge and the mechanical actuation process can continue even after the control matrix 1500 grounds the scan-line interconnect 1506 , thereby isolating the charge stored on the capacitor 1520 from its corresponding data interconnect 1502 .
- control matrix 1500 regulates the discharge switch 1514 (for controlling application of the actuation voltage V at on shutter assembly 1511 ) by means of data voltage which is stored on the capacitor 1520 , instead of requiring real time communication with signals on the data interconnect 1502 .
- the storage capacitor 1520 and write-enable transistor 1518 can be replaced with alternative data memory circuits, such as a DRAM or SRAM circuits known in the art.
- the charge on the electrodes of shutter assembly 1511 when discharged, does not flow to ground by means of the scan line interconnect that corresponds to pixel 1504 . Instead the source of the discharge switch transistor 1514 is connected to the scan line interconnect 1522 of the pixel in the row below it.
- the scan line interconnects 1522 in control matrix 1500 are held at or near to the ground potential; they can thereby function as effective sinks for discharge currents in neighboring rows.
- the control matrix 1500 also includes the capability for global actuation, the process or method of which is similar to that described in FIG. 10 .
- the shutters in discharged pixels 1504 are kept in position due to the application of a maintenance voltage V m , e.g., 1 ⁇ 2 V at , to the global actuation interconnect 1516 .
- V m maintenance voltage
- the control matrix 1500 grounds the global actuation interconnect 1516 , thereby releasing the shutters of all discharged shutter assemblies 1511 substantially in unison.
- FIG. 16A is a diagram of still another suitable control matrix 1600 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- the control matrix 1600 is similar to the control matrix 1500 of FIG. 15 .
- Control matrix 1600 includes a data interconnect 1602 for each column of pixels 1604 in the control matrix 1600 , a scan-line interconnect 1606 for each row of pixels 1604 in the control matrix 1600 .
- the control matrix 1600 includes a common charge trigger interconnect 1608 , a common charge interconnect 1610 , and a global actuation interconnect 1612 .
- the pixels 1604 in the control matrix 1600 each include an elastic shutter assembly 1614 , a charge trigger switch transistor 1616 , a discharge switch transistor 1617 , a write-enable transistor 1618 , and a data store capacitor 1620 as described in FIG. 15 .
- the control matrix 1600 also includes a shutter common interconnect 1622 which is distinct from the global actuation interconnect 1612 . These interconnects 1612 and 1622 are shared among pixels 1604 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array.
- control matrix 1600 performs the same functions as those of control matrix 1500 , but by different means or methods. Most particularly, the method for accomplishing global actuation in control matrix 1600 is unique from that performed in control matrices 900 , 1400 , or 1500 . In the previous methods, the global actuation interconnect was connected to one electrode of the shutter assembly, and applying a maintenance voltage V m to it prevented shutter actuation. In control matrix 1600 , however, the global actuation interconnect 1612 is connected to the source of the discharge switch transistor 1617 . Maintaining the global actuation interconnect 1612 at a potential significantly above that of the shutter common interconnect 1622 prevents the turn-on of any of the discharge switch transistors 1617 , regardless of what charge is stored on capacitor 1620 .
- Global actuation in control matrix 1600 is achieved by bringing the potential on the global actuation interconnect 1612 to the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 1622 , making it possible for those discharge switch transistors 1617 s to turn-on in accordance to the whether a data voltage has been stored on capacitor 1620 or not.
- Control matrix 1600 does not depend on electrical bi-stability in the shutter assembly 1614 in order to achieve global actuation.
- Applying partial voltages to the data store capacitor 1620 allows partial turn-on of the discharge switch transistor 1617 during the time that the global actuation interconnect 1612 is brought to its actuation potential. In this fashion, an analog voltage is created on the shutter assembly 1614 , for providing analog gray scale.
- control matrix 1600 in contrast to control matrix 1500 , the higher-capacitance electrode of the actuators in the shutter assemblies 1614 electrically connect to the shutter common interconnect 1622 , instead of the global actuation interconnect 1612 .
- the control matrix alternates between two control logics as described in relation to control matrix 1400 of FIG. 14 .
- the control matrix 1600 switches the voltage applied to the shutter common interconnect 1622 to either ground or V at , depending on the selected control logic, instead of switching the global actuation voltage applied to the global actuation interconnect, as is done by control matrix 1400 .
- a simple diode and/or an MIM diode can be substituted for the charge trigger transistor 1616 to perform the switching or charge loading function for each pixel in the array.
- FIG. 16B is yet another suitable control matrix 1640 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 1640 controls an array of pixels 1642 that include elastic shutter assemblies.
- the control matrix 1640 includes a single data interconnect 1648 for each column of pixels 1642 in the control matrix.
- the control matrix 1640 is suitable for controlling elastic shutter assemblies 1644 , such as shutter assembly 200 .
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 1644 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 1640 includes a scan-line interconnect 1646 for each row of pixels 1642 in the control matrix 1640 .
- the control matrix 1640 further includes a charge interconnect 1650 , and a global actuation interconnect 1654 , and a shutter common interconnect 1655 .
- These interconnects 1650 , 1654 and 1655 are shared among pixels 1642 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 1650 , 1654 , and 1655 are shared among all pixels 1642 in the control matrix 1640 .
- Each pixel 1642 in the control matrix includes a shutter charge transistor 1656 , a shutter discharge transistor 1658 , a shutter write-enable transistor 1657 , and a data store capacitor 1659 , as described in FIGS. 16A and 19 .
- Control matrix 1640 also incorporates an optional voltage stabilizing capacitor 1652 which is connected in parallel with the source and drain of discharge switch transistor 1658 .
- the charging transistor 1656 is wired with a different circuit connection to the charge interconnect 1650 .
- Control matrix 1640 does not include a charge trigger interconnect which is shared among pixels. Instead, the gate terminals of the charging transistor 1656 are connected directly to the charge interconnect 1650 , along with the drain terminal of transistor 1656 .
- the charging transistors 1656 operate essentially as diodes, they can pass a current in only 1 direction. Their function in the charging circuit becomes equivalent to that of diode 1410 in control circuit 1400 of FIG. 14 .
- the control matrix 1640 applies a voltage pulse to the charge interconnect 1650 , allowing current to flow through charging transistor 1656 and into the shutter assemblies 1644 of the pixels 1642 .
- each of the shutter electrodes of shutter assemblies 1644 will be in the same voltage state.
- the potential of charge interconnect 1650 is reset to zero, and the charging transistors 1656 will prevent the charge stored in the shutter assemblies 1644 from being dissipated through charge interconnect 1650 .
- the charge interconnect 1650 transmits a pulsed voltage equal to or greater than V at , e.g., 40V.
- Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, as was described with respect to control matrix 1500 of FIG. 15 .
- the control matrix 1640 applies a data voltage to the data interconnect 1648 corresponding to each column of pixels 1642 in the control matrix 1640 .
- the application of V we to the scan-line interconnect 1646 for the write-enabled row turns on the write-enable transistor 1657 of the pixels 1642 in the corresponding scan line.
- the voltages applied to the data interconnect 1648 is thereby caused to be stored on the data store capacitor 1659 of the respective pixels 1642 .
- control matrix 1640 the global actuation interconnect 1654 is connected to the source of the shutter discharge switch transistor 1658 . Maintaining the global actuation interconnect 1654 at a potential significantly above that of the shutter common interconnect 1655 prevents the turn-on of the discharge switch transistor 1658 , regardless of what charge is stored on the capacitor 1659 .
- Global actuation in control matrix 1640 is achieved by bringing the potential on the global actuation interconnect 1654 to ground or to substantially the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 1655 , enabling the discharge switch transistor 1658 to turn-on in accordance to the whether a data voltage has been stored on capacitor 1659 . Control matrix 1640 , therefore, does not depend on electrical bi-stability in the shutter assembly 1644 in order to achieve global actuation.
- Applying partial voltages to the data store capacitor 1659 allows partial turn-on of the discharge switch transistor 1658 during the time that the global actuation interconnect 1654 is brought to its actuation potential. In this fashion, an analog voltage is created on the shutter assembly 1644 , for providing analog gray scale.
- FIG. 16C An alternative method of addressing pixels in control matrix 1640 is illustrated by the method 1670 shown in FIG. 16C .
- the method 1670 proceeds in three general steps. First the matrix is addressed row by row by storing data into the data store capacitors 1659 . Next all actuators are actuated (or reset) simultaneously (step 1688 ) be applying a voltage V at to the charge interconnect 1650 . And finally the image is set in a global actuation step 1692 by selectively activating transistors 1658 by means of the global actuation interconnect 1654 .
- the frame addressing cycle of method 1670 begins when a voltage V off is applied to the global actuation interconnect 1654 (step 1672 ).
- the voltage V off on interconnect 1654 is designed to ensure that the discharge transistor 1658 will not turn on regardless of whether a voltage has been stored on capacitor 1659 .
- the control matrix 1640 then proceeds with the addressing of each pixel 1642 in the control matrix, one row at a time (steps 1674 - 1684 ). To address a particular row, the control matrix 1640 write-enables a first scan line by applying a voltage V we to the corresponding scan-line interconnect 1646 (step 1674 ). Then, at decision block 1676 , the control matrix 1640 determines for each pixel 1642 in the write-enabled row whether the pixel 1642 needs to be open or closed. For example, if at the reset step 1688 all shutters are to be (temporarily) closed, then at decision block 1676 it is determined for each pixel 1642 in the write-enabled row whether or not the pixel is to be (subsequently) opened.
- the control matrix 1640 applies a data voltage V d , for example 5V, to the data interconnect 1648 corresponding to the column in which that pixel 1642 is located (step 1678 ).
- the voltage V d applied to the data interconnect 1648 is thereby caused to be stored by means of a charge on the data store capacitor 1659 of the selected pixel 1642 (step 1679 ).
- the corresponding data interconnect 1648 is grounded (step 1680 ).
- the relaxed position in this example is defined as the shutter-open position, alternative shutter assemblies can be provided in which the relaxed state is a shutter-closed position. In these alternative cases, the application of data voltage V d , at step 1678 , would result in the closing of the shutter.
- the application of V we to the scan-line interconnect 1646 for the write-enabled row turns on all of the write-enable transistors 1657 for the pixels 1642 in the corresponding scan line.
- the control matrix 1640 selectively applies the data voltage to all columns of a given row in the control matrix 1640 at the same time while that row has been write-enabled. After all data has been stored on capacitors 1659 in the selected row (steps 1679 and 1681 ), the control matrix 1640 grounds the selected scan-line interconnect (step 1682 ) and selects a subsequent scan-line interconnect for writing (step 1685 ). After the information has been stored in the capacitors for all the rows in control matrix 1640 , the decision block 1684 is triggered to begin the global actuation sequence.
- the actuation sequence begins at step 1686 of method 1670 , with the application of an actuation voltage V at , e.g. 40 V, to the charge interconnect 1650 .
- V at an actuation voltage
- the control matrix 1640 continues to apply the voltage V at (step 1686 ) for a period of time sufficient for all actuators to actuate into an initial state (step 1688 ).
- step 1688 acts to reset and close all actuators.
- Alternatives to the method 1670 are possible, however, in which the reset step 1688 acts to open all shutters.
- the control matrix grounds the charge interconnect 1650 .
- a voltage at least greater than a maintenance voltage V m , remains stored across the capacitor 1652 , thereby holding the shutters in position.
- the electrodes on the actuators in shutter assembly 1644 provide a capacitance which also stores a charge after the charge interconnect 1650 has been grounded, useful for those embodiments in which capacitor 1652 is not included.
- the data stored in capacitors 1659 can now be utilized to set an image in control matrix 1640 by selectively opening the specified shutter assemblies (steps 1692 and 1694 ).
- the potential on the global actuation interconnect 1654 is set to substantially the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 1655 (step 1692 ).
- Step 1692 makes it possible for the discharge switch transistor 1658 to turn-on in accordance to whether a data voltage has been stored on capacitor 1659 .
- the charge which was stored on the actuator of shutter assembly 1644 is now allowed to dissipate through the global actuation interconnect 1654 .
- step 1694 therefore, selected shutters are discharged through transistor 1658 and allowed to return by means of a restoring force or spring into their relaxed position.
- a discharge into the relaxed position means that the selected shutter assemblies 1644 are placed in their open position.
- the transistor 1658 remains closed at step 1694 , no discharge will occur and the shutter assembly 1644 remains closed.
- step 1672 To set an image in a subsequent video frame, the process begins again at step 1672 .
- step 1670 all of the shutters are closed simultaneously during the time between step 1688 and step 1694 , a time in which no image information can be presented to the viewer.
- the method 1670 is designed to minimize this dead time (or reset time) by making use of data store capacitors 1659 and global actuation interconnect 1654 to provide timing control over the transistors 1658 .
- step 1672 all of the data for a given image frame can be written to the capacitors 1659 during the addressing sequence (steps 1674 - 1685 ), without any immediate actuation effect on the shutter assemblies.
- the shutter assemblies 1644 remain locked in the positions they were assigned in the previous image frame until addressing is complete and they are uniformly actuated or reset at step 1688 .
- the global actuation step 1692 allows the simultaneous transfer of data out of the data store capacitors 1659 so that all shutter assemblies can be brought into their next addressed image state at the same time.
- the activity of an attached backlight can be synchronized with the addressing of each frame.
- a command to turn the illumination off can be given between step 1684 and step 1686 .
- the illumination can then be turned-on again after step 1694 .
- a lamp with one color can be turned off after step 1684 while a lamp with either the same or a different color is turned on after step 1694 .
- the data voltage V d can be significantly less than the actuation voltage V at (e.g., 5V vs. 40V). Since the actuation voltage V at is applied once a frame, whereas the data voltage V d may be applied to each data interconnect 1648 as may times per frame as there are rows in the control matrix 1640 , control matrices such as control matrix 1640 may save a substantial amount of power in comparison to control matrices which require a data voltage to be high enough to also serve as the actuation voltage.
- FIG. 16B assumes the use of n-channel MOS transistors.
- Other embodiments are possible that employ p-channel transistors, in which case the relative signs of the bias potentials V at and V d would be reversed.
- the method 1670 assumes digital information is written into an image frame, i.e. where the shutters are intended to be either open or closed.
- the circuit of control matrix 1640 it is also possible to write analog information into the shutter assemblies 1644 .
- the grounding of the scan line interconnects is provided for only a short and fixed amount of time and only partial voltages are applied through the data line interconnects 1648 .
- the application of partial voltages to the discharge switch transistor 1658 when operated in a linear amplification mode, allows for only the partial discharge of the electrode of the shutter assembly 1644 and therefore a partial opening of the shutter.
- control matrix 1640 In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the shutter assembly 1644 , the control matrix alternates between two control logics, as described in relation to control matrix 1400 of FIG. 14 .
- the control matrix 1640 closes the shutter assemblies 1644 of all pixels in the control matrix 1640 by storing V at across the electrodes of the shutter assembly 1644 actuator. The potential on the shutter common interconnect 1655 is held at ground.
- the potential of the shutter common interconnect 1655 is set instead to the actuation voltage V at .
- steps 1686 and 1688 where the voltage on the charge interconnect 1650 is set to V at , all shutters are instead allowed to relax to their open position. Therefore, in the second control logic, the control matrix 1640 discharges the stored V at from shutter assemblies that are to be closed, as opposed to those that are to remain open.
- global actuation is achieved by setting the global actuation interconnect 1654 to ground.
- the control matrix 1640 can alternate between the control logics every frame or on some other periodic basis. Over time, the net potentials applied to the shutter assemblies 1644 by the charge interconnect 1650 and the shutter common interconnect 1655 average out to 0V.
- FIG. 17 is still a further suitable control matrix 1700 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 1700 controls an array of pixels 1702 that include elastic shutter assemblies 1704 .
- the control matrix 1700 preferably includes shutter assemblies that are not bi-stable, so that the shutter assemblies 1704 are better controlled in an analog fashion. That is, the application of a particular voltage to the actuator of one of the shutter assemblies 1704 results in a known incremental shutter displacement.
- Control matrix 1700 includes one scan-line interconnect 1706 for each row of pixels 1702 in the control matrix 1700 and one data interconnect 1708 for each column of pixels 1702 in the control matrix 1700 .
- the control matrix 1700 also includes a charge interconnect 1710 , a charge trigger interconnect 1712 , and a discharge trigger interconnect 1714 . These interconnects 1710 , 1712 , and 1714 are shared amongst all or a subset of the pixels 1702 in the control matrix 1700 .
- Each pixel 1702 in the control matrix 1700 includes four transistors, a charge trigger transistor 1716 , a grayscale transistor 1718 , a discharge transistor 1720 , and a write-enable transistor 1722 .
- the gate of the charge trigger transistor 1716 electrically connects to the charge trigger interconnect 1712 . Its drain electrically connects to the charge interconnect 1710 , and its source electrically connects to the grayscale transistor 1718 .
- the gate of the grayscale transistor 1718 electrically connects, in parallel, to a data store capacitor 1724 and the write-enable transistor 1722 .
- the source of the grayscale transistor 1718 electrically connects to the discharge transistor 1720 .
- the gate of the discharge transistor 1720 electrically connects to the discharge interconnect 1714 , and its source is grounded. Referring back to the write-enabling transistor 1722 , its gate electrically connects to its corresponding scan-line interconnect 1706 , and its drain electrically connects to its corresponding data interconnect 1708 .
- the control matrix 1700 can be utilized to provide analog gray scale to the display apparatus 100 .
- the control matrix 1700 applies a voltage to the discharge trigger interconnect 1714 , turning on the discharge transistor 1720 . Any voltage stored in the actuators of the shutter assemblies 1704 in the pixels 1702 is discharged, releasing the shutters in the shutter assemblies 1704 to their rest positions.
- the control matrix 1700 then grounds the discharge trigger interconnect 1714 .
- the control matrix 1700 in sequence applies a write-enabling voltage V we to each scan-line interconnect 1706 , turning on the write-enabling transistors 1722 of the pixels 1702 in each corresponding row of the control matrix 1700 .
- the control matrix 1700 applies voltage pulses to each of the data-interconnects 1708 to indicate the desired brightness of each pixel 1702 in the write-enabled row of pixels 1702 .
- the control matrix then applies a voltage to the charge trigger interconnect 1712 which turns on the charge trigger transistor 1716 so that all electrodes can be charged and all pixels actuated simultaneously.
- Brightness of a pixel 1702 is determined by the duration or the magnitude of the voltage pulse applied to its corresponding data interconnect 1708 . While the voltage pulse is applied to the data interconnect 1708 of the pixel, current flows through the write-enabling transistor 1722 , building up a potential on the data store capacitor 1724 . The voltage on the capacitor 1724 is used to control the opening of the conducting channel in the grayscale transistor 1718 . This channel remains open so long as the gate-to-source voltage exceeds a certain threshold voltage. Eventually, during the charging cycle, the potential on the electrode of shutter assembly 1704 will rise to match the potential stored on the capacitor 1724 , at which point the grayscale transistor will turn off.
- the actuation voltage stored on the shutter assembly can be made to vary in proportion to the analog voltage stored on capacitor 1724 .
- the resulting electrode voltage causes an incremental displacement of the shutter in the shutter assembly 1704 proportional to the resultant voltage.
- the shutter remains displaced from its rest position until the discharge trigger interconnect 1714 is powered again at the end of the frame addressing cycle.
- a simple diode and/or an MIM diode can be substituted for the charge trigger transistor 1716 to perform the switching or charge loading function for each pixel in the array.
- FIG. 18 is yet another suitable control matrix 1800 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 1800 controls an array of pixels 1802 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 1804 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators).
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 1804 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 1800 includes a scan-line interconnect 1806 for each row of pixels 1802 in the control matrix 1800 .
- the control matrix 1800 also includes two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 1808 a and a shutter-close interconnect 1808 b , for each column of pixels 1802 in the control matrix 1800 .
- the control matrix 1800 further includes a charge interconnect 1810 , a charge trigger interconnect 1812 , and a global actuation interconnect 1814 . These interconnects 1810 , 1812 , and 1814 are shared among pixels 1802 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 1810 , 1812 , and 1814 are shared among all pixels 1802 in the control matrix 1800 .
- Each pixel 1802 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 1816 , a shutter-open discharge transistor 1818 , a shutter-close charge transistor 1820 , and a shutter-close discharge transistor 1822 .
- the control matrix also incorporates two voltage stabilizing capacitors 1824 , which are connected, one each, in parallel with the source and drain of the discharge transistors 1818 and 1822 .
- V m a maintenance voltage
- the maintenance voltage locks the shutter assemblies 1804 into their current states until a global actuation is initiated at the end of the frame addressing cycle.
- the control matrix 1800 then applies a voltage to the charge trigger interconnect 1812 , turning on the shutter-open and shutter-close transistors 1816 and 1820 of the pixels 1802 in the control matrix 1800 .
- the charge interconnect 1810 in one implementation, carries a DC voltage equal to or greater than V at , e.g., 40V.
- the control matrix 1800 write-enables a row of pixels 1802 by grounding its corresponding scan-line interconnect 1806 .
- the control matrix 1800 then applies a data voltage, V d , e.g., 5V, to either the shutter-open interconnect 1808 a or the shutter-close interconnect 1808 b corresponding to each column of pixels 1802 in the control matrix 1800 . If V d is applied to the shutter-closed interconnect 1808 b of a column, the voltage stored on the shutter-close actuator of the corresponding shutter assembly 1804 is discharged via the shutter-close discharge transistor 1822 .
- V d data voltage
- V d is applied to the shutter-open interconnect 1808 a of a column
- the voltage stored on the shutter-open actuator of the corresponding shutter assembly 1804 is discharged via the shutter-open discharge transistor 1818 .
- only one of the actuators, either the shutter-closed actuator or the shutter-open actuator is allowed to be discharged for any given shutter assembly in the array.
- the control matrix 1800 globally actuates the pixels 1802 by changing the potential on the global actuation interconnect 1814 from V m to ground. The change in voltage releases the actuators from their locked in state to switch to their next state, if needed. If the global actuation interconnect were to be replaced with a constant voltage ground or common interconnect, i.e. if the global actuation method is not utilized with the control matrix 1800 , then the voltage stabilizing capacitors 1824 may not be necessary.
- a simple diode and/or an MIM diode can be substituted for both the shutter-open charge transistor 1816 and the shutter-close charge transistor 1820 .
- shutter assembly 1804 it is possible to take advantage of the bi-stable nature of shutter assembly 1804 and substitute a resistor for both the shutter-open charge transistor 1816 and the shutter-close charge transistor 1820 .
- a resistor When operated with a resistor, one relies on the fact that the RC charging time constant associated with the resistor and the capacitance of the actuator in the shutter assembly 1804 can be much greater in magnitude than the time necessary for discharging the actuator through either the shutter-open discharge transistor 1818 or the shutter-close discharge transistor 1822 .
- the correct voltage differences can be established across the actuators of the shutter assembly 1804 and the shutter assembly can be caused to actuate.
- the shutter assembly 1804 will not re-actuate since either or both of the actuators now effectively holds the appropriate maintenance voltage, i.e., a voltage greater than V m .
- FIG. 19 is yet another suitable control matrix 1900 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 1900 controls an array of pixels 1902 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 1904 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators).
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 1904 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 1900 includes a scan-line interconnect 1906 for each row of pixels 1902 in the control matrix 1900 .
- the control matrix 1900 also includes two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 1908 a and a shutter-close interconnect 1908 b , for each column of pixels 1902 in the control matrix 1900 .
- the control matrix 1900 further includes a charge interconnect 1910 , a charge trigger interconnect 1912 , and a global actuation interconnect 1914 , and a shutter common interconnect 1915 .
- These interconnects 1910 , 1912 , 1914 and 1915 are shared among pixels 1902 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 1910 , 1912 , 1914 and 1915 are shared among all pixels 1902 in the control matrix 1900 .
- Each pixel 1902 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 1916 , a shutter-open discharge transistor 1918 , a shutter-open write-enable transistor 1917 , and a data store capacitor 1919 as described in FIG. 16A .
- Each pixel 1902 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor 1920 , and a shutter-close discharge transistor 1922 , a shutter-close write-enable transistor 1927 , and a data store capacitor 1929 .
- the control matrix 1900 applies a voltage to the charge trigger interconnect 1912 , turning on the shutter-open and shutter-close transistors 1916 and 1920 of the pixels 1902 in the control matrix 1900 .
- the charge interconnect 1910 in one implementation, carries a DC voltage equal to or greater than V at , e.g., 40V.
- Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, as was described with respect to control matrix 1500 of FIG. 15 .
- the control matrix 1900 applies a data voltage to either the shutter-open interconnect 1908 a or the shutter-close interconnect 1908 b corresponding to each column of pixels 1902 in the control matrix 1900 .
- the application of V we to the scan-line interconnect 1906 for the write-enabled row turns on both of the write-enable transistors 1917 and 1927 of the pixels 1902 in the corresponding scan line.
- the voltages applied to the data interconnects 1908 a and 1908 b are thereby allowed to be stored on the data store capacitors 1919 and 1929 of the respective pixels 1902 .
- only one of the actuators either the shutter-closed actuator or the shutter-open actuator, is allowed to be discharged for any given shutter assembly in the array.
- control matrix 1900 the global actuation interconnect 1914 is connected to the source of the both the shutter-open discharge switch transistor 1918 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 1922 . Maintaining the global actuation interconnect 1914 at a potential significantly above that of the shutter common interconnect 1915 prevents the turn-on of any of the discharge switch transistors 1918 or 1922 , regardless of what charge is stored on the capacitors 1919 and 1929 .
- Global actuation in control matrix 1900 is achieved by bringing the potential on the global actuation interconnect 1914 to the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 1915 , making it possible for the discharge switch transistors 1918 or 1922 to turn-on in accordance to the whether a data voltage has been stored on ether capacitor 1919 or 1920 . Control matrix 1900 , therefore, does not depend on electrical bi-stability in the shutter assembly 1904 in order to achieve global actuation.
- control matrix alternates between two control logics as described in relation to control matrix 1600 of FIG. 16A .
- control matrix 1300 of FIG. 13 simple MIM diodes or varistors can be substituted for the charge trigger transistor 1616 to perform the switching or charge loading function for each pixel in the array. Also, as in control matrix 1800 of FIG. 18 it is possible to substitute a resistor for both the shutter-open charge transistor 1916 and the shutter-close charge transistor 1920 .
- FIG. 20 is yet another suitable control matrix 2000 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 2000 controls an array of pixels 2002 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2004 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators).
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 2004 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 2000 includes a scan-line interconnect 2006 for each row of pixels 2002 in the control matrix 2000 .
- the control matrix 2000 also includes two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 2008 a and a shutter-close interconnect 2008 b , for each column of pixels 2002 in the control matrix 2000 .
- the control matrix 2000 further includes a charge interconnect 2010 , and a global actuation interconnect 2014 , and a shutter common interconnect 2015 . These interconnects 2010 , 2014 and 2015 are shared among pixels 2002 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 2010 , 2014 and 2015 are shared among all pixels 2002 in the control matrix 2000 .
- Each pixel 2002 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 2016 , a shutter-open discharge transistor 2018 , a shutter-open write-enable transistor 2017 , and a data store capacitor 2019 as described in FIGS. 16A and 19 .
- Each pixel 2002 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor 2020 , and a shutter-close discharge transistor 2022 , a shutter-close write-enable transistor 2027 , and a data store capacitor 2029 .
- Control matrix 2000 also incorporates two voltage stabilizing capacitors 2031 and 2033 which connect on one side to the sources of the discharge switch transistors 2018 and 2022 , respectively, and on the other side to the shutter common interconnect 2015 .
- control matrix 2000 does not include a charge trigger interconnect which is shared among pixels. Instead, the gate terminals of both charging transistors 2016 and 2020 are connected directly to the charge interconnect 2010 , along with the drain terminal of transistors 2016 and 2020 .
- the charging transistors operate essentially as diodes, i.e., they can pass a current in only 1 direction. Their function in the charging circuit becomes equivalent to that of diode 1410 in control circuit 1400 of FIG. 14 .
- the control matrix 2000 applies a voltage pulse to the charge interconnect 2010 , allowing current to flow through charging transistors 2016 and 2020 and into the shutter assemblies 2004 of the pixels 2002 .
- each of the shutter open and shutter closed electrodes of shutter assemblies 2004 will be in the same voltage state.
- the potential of charge interconnect 2010 is reset to zero, and the charging transistors 2016 and 2020 will prevent the charge stored in the shutter assemblies 2004 from being dissipated through charge interconnect 2010 .
- the charge interconnect 2010 transmits a pulsed voltage equal to or greater than V at , e.g., 40V.
- Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, as was described with respect to control matrix 1500 of FIG. 15 .
- the control matrix 2000 applies a data voltage to either the shutter-open interconnect 2008 a or the shutter-close interconnect 2008 b corresponding to each column of pixels 2002 in the control matrix 2000 .
- the application of V we to the scan-line interconnect 2006 for the write-enabled row turns on both of the write-enable transistors 2017 and 2027 of the pixels 2002 in the corresponding scan line.
- the voltages applied to the data interconnects 2008 a and 2008 b are thereby caused to be stored on the data store capacitors 2019 and 2029 of the respective pixels 2002 .
- only one of the actuators either the shutter-closed actuator or the shutter-open actuator, is caused to be discharged for any given shutter assembly in the array.
- control matrix 2000 the global actuation interconnect 2014 is connected to the source of the both the shutter-open discharge switch transistor 2018 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 2022 . Maintaining the global actuation interconnect 2014 at a potential significantly above that of the shutter common interconnect 2015 prevents the turn-on of any of the discharge switch transistors 2018 or 2022 , regardless of what charge is stored on the capacitors 2019 and 2029 .
- Global actuation in control matrix 2000 is achieved by bringing the potential on the global actuation interconnect 2014 to substantially the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 2015 , making it possible for the discharge switch transistors 2018 or 2022 to turn-on in accordance to whether a data voltage has been stored on ether capacitor 2019 or 2029 . Control matrix 2000 , therefore, does not depend on electrical bi-stability in the shutter assembly 2004 in order to achieve global actuation.
- control matrix 2000 In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the shutter assembly 2004 , the control matrix 2000 alternates between two control logics, as described in relation to control matrix 1600 of FIG. 16A .
- FIG. 21 is yet another suitable control matrix 2100 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 2100 controls an array of pixels 2102 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2104 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators).
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 2104 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 2100 includes a scan-line interconnect 2106 for each row of pixels 2102 in the control matrix 2100 . Despite the fact that shutter assemblies 2104 are dual-actuator shutter assemblies, the control matrix 2100 only includes a single data interconnect 2108 .
- the control matrix 2100 further includes a charge interconnect 2110 , and a global actuation interconnect 2114 , and a shutter common interconnect 2115 . These interconnects 2110 , 2114 and 2115 are shared among pixels 2102 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 2110 , 2114 , and 2115 are shared among all pixels 2102 in the control matrix 2100 .
- Each pixel 2102 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 2116 , a shutter-open discharge transistor 2118 , a shutter-open write-enable transistor 2117 , and a data store capacitor 2119 , as described in FIGS. 16A and 19 .
- Each pixel 2102 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor 2120 , a shutter-close discharge transistor 2122 , and a data store capacitor 2129 .
- control matrix 2100 includes a data load transistor 2135 and a data discharge transistor 2137 .
- Control matrix 2100 also incorporates two voltage stabilizing capacitors 2131 and 2133 which connect on one side to the sources of the discharge switch transistors 2118 and 2122 , respectively, and on the other side to the shutter common interconnect 2115 .
- the charging transistors 2116 and 2120 are wired similarly to that of the charging transistors in control matrix 2000 of FIG. 20 . That is, the gate terminals of both charging transistors 2116 and 2120 are connected directly to the charge interconnect 2110 , along with the drain terminal of transistors 2116 and 2120 . Their function in the charging circuit becomes equivalent to that of diode 1410 in control circuit 1400 of FIG. 14 .
- the control matrix 2100 applies a voltage pulse to the charge interconnect 2110 , allowing current to flow through charging transistors 2116 and 2120 and into the shutter assemblies 2104 of the pixels 2102 .
- each of the shutter open and shutter closed electrodes of shutter assemblies 2104 will be in the same voltage state.
- the potential of charge interconnect 2110 is reset to zero, and the charging transistors 2116 and 2120 will prevent the charge stored in the shutter assemblies 2104 from being dissipated through charge interconnect 2110 .
- the charge interconnect 2110 transmits a pulsed voltage equal to or greater than V at , e.g., 40V.
- Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, as was described with respect to control matrix 1500 of FIG. 15 .
- the control matrix 2100 applies a data voltage to the data interconnect 2108 .
- the application of V we to the scan-line interconnect 2106 for the write-enabled row turns on the write-enable transistor 2117 of the pixels 2102 in the corresponding scan line.
- the voltages applied to the data interconnect 2108 is thereby caused to be stored on the data store capacitor 2119 of the respective pixels 2102 .
- the same V we that is applied to the write enable transistor 2117 is applied simultaneously to both the gate and the drain of data load transistor 2135 , which allows current to pass through the data load transistor 2135 depending on whatever voltage is stored on capacitor 2129 .
- the combination of transistors 2135 and 2137 functions essentially as an inverter with respect to the data stored on capacitor 2119 .
- the source of data load transistor 2135 is connected to the drain of data discharge transistor 2137 and simultaneously to an electrode of the data store capacitor 2129 .
- the gate of data discharge transistor 2137 is connected to an electrode of data store capacitor 2119 .
- the voltage stored on capacitor 2129 therefore, becomes the complement or inverse of the voltage stored on data store capacitor 2119 . For instance, if the voltage on the data store capacitor 2119 is V on , then the data discharge transistor 2137 can switch on and the voltage on the data store capacitor 2129 can become zero. Conversely, if the voltage on data store capacitor 2119 is zero, then the data discharge transistor 2137 will switch off and the voltage on the data store capacitor 2129 will remain at its pre-set voltage V we .
- control matrix 2100 the global actuation interconnect 2114 is connected to the source of the shutter-open discharge switch transistor 2118 , the shutter-close discharge transistor 2122 , and the data discharge transistor 2137 . Maintaining the global actuation interconnect 2114 at a potential significantly above that of the shutter common interconnect 2115 prevents the turn-on of any of the discharge switch transistors 2118 , 2122 and 2137 , regardless of what charge is stored on the capacitors 2119 .
- Global actuation in control matrix 2100 is achieved by bringing the potential on the global actuation interconnect 2114 to substantially the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 2115 .
- all three of the transistors 2118 , 2122 , and 2137 can change their state, depending on what data voltage has been stored on capacitor 2119 . Because of the operation of the inverter 2135 and 2137 , only one of the discharge transistors 2118 or 2122 can be on at any one time, ensuring proper actuation of shutter assembly 2104 . The presence of the inverter 2135 and 2137 helps to obviate the need for a separate shutter-close data interconnect.
- control matrix 2100 In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the shutter assembly 2104 , the control matrix 2100 alternates between two control logics as described in relation to control matrix 1600 of FIG. 16A .
- FIG. 22 is yet another suitable control matrix 2200 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 2200 controls an array of pixels 2202 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2204 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators).
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 2204 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 2200 includes a scan-line interconnect 2206 for each row of pixels 2202 in the control matrix 2200 .
- the control matrix 2200 also includes two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 2208 a and a shutter-close interconnect 2208 b , for each column of pixels 2202 in the control matrix 2200 .
- the control matrix 2200 further includes a charge interconnect 2210 , a global actuation interconnect 2214 , and a shutter common interconnect 2215 . These interconnects 2210 , 2214 and 2215 are shared among pixels 2202 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 2210 , 2214 and 2215 are shared among all pixels 2202 in the control matrix 2200 .
- Each pixel 2202 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 2216 , a shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 , a shutter-open write-enable transistor 2217 , and a data store capacitor 2219 as described in FIGS. 16A and 19 .
- Each pixel 2202 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor 2220 , and a shutter-close discharge transistor 2222 , a shutter-close write-enable transistor 2227 , and a data store capacitor 2229 .
- the control matrix 2200 makes use of two complementary types of transistors, both p-channel and n-channel transistors. It is therefore referred to as a complementary MOS control matrix or a CMOS control matrix.
- the charging transistors 2216 and 2220 are of the pMOS type while the discharge transistors 2218 and 2222 are of the nMOS type.
- the types of transistors can be reversed, for example nMOS transistors can be used for the charging transistors and pMOS transistors can be used for the discharge transistors. (The symbol for a pMOS transistor includes an arrow that points into the channel region, the symbol for an nMOS transistor includes an arrow that points away from the channel region.)
- the CMOS control matrix 2200 does not incorporate and does not require any voltage stabilizing capacitors, such as 2031 and 2033 from control matrix 2000 of FIG. 20 .
- Control matrix 2200 does not include a charge trigger interconnect (such as charge trigger interconnect 1912 in control matrix 1900 of FIG. 19 ).
- the charging transistors 2216 and 2220 are wired with different circuit connections between the charge interconnect 2210 and the shutter assembly 2204 .
- the source of each of transistors 2216 and 2220 are connected to the charge interconnect 2210 .
- the gate of shutter-close charge transistor 2220 is connected to the drain of a shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 and simultaneously to the shutter-open actuator of the corresponding shutter assembly 2204 .
- the gate of shutter-open charge transistor 2216 is connected to the drain of a shutter-close discharge transistor 2222 and simultaneously to the shutter-close actuator of the corresponding shutter assembly 2204 .
- the drain of shutter-close charge transistor 2220 is connected to the drain of a shutter-close discharge transistor 2222 and simultaneously to the shutter-close actuator of the corresponding shutter assembly 2204 .
- the drain of shutter-open charge transistor 2216 is connected to the drain of a shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 and simultaneously to the shutter-open actuator of the corresponding shutter assembly 2204 .
- control matrix 2200 is distinct from that of the circuits already discussed, in particular from control matrices 1800 , 1900 , and 2000 of FIGS. 18 , 19 and 20 , respectively, which have generally employed the charging sequence described in control method 1200 of FIG. 12 .
- control method 1200 as applied to control matrix 1900 , an actuation voltage is first applied to each side of the shutter assembly 1902 , or applied simultaneously to the shutter-open actuator and the shutter-closed actuators of shutter assembly 1902 . Later, as part of the global actuation sequence, either one actuator or the other in shutter assembly 1902 is caused to discharge in accordance to whether a data voltage was stored on ether capacitor 1919 or 1929 .
- the operation of control matrix 2200 does not require a distinct or initializing charging sequence.
- the charge interconnect 2210 is maintained at a steady DC voltage equal to the actuation voltage V at , e.g. at 40 volts.
- the control matrix 2200 operates as a logical flip-flop, which has only two stable states.
- the shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 is on, the shutter-closed discharge transistor 2222 is off, the shutter-open charge transistor 2216 is off, and the shutter-close charge transistor 2220 is on.
- the shutter-open actuator is discharged or set to the same potential as the global actuation interconnect 2214 , while the shutter-closed actuator is held at the actuation voltage V at .
- the shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 is off, the shutter-closed discharge transistor 2222 is on, the shutter-open charge transistor 2216 is on, and the shutter-close charge transistor 2220 is off.
- the shutter-closed actuator is discharged or set to the same potential as the global actuation interconnect 2214 , while the shutter-closed actuator is held at the actuation voltage V at .
- the cross-coupling of transistors 2216 , 2218 , 2220 , and 2222 helps to ensure that if any one of these 4 transistors is on—then only the two states described above can result as a stable state.
- the flip-flop can also be used to store pixel addressing data.
- both the shutter-open and shutter-close actuators of shutter assembly 2204 are connected to the output stage of a corresponding CMOS inverter.
- These inverters can be labeled as the shutter open inverter which comprises transistors 2216 and 2218 and the shutter close inverter which comprises transistors 2220 and 2222 .
- the flip-flop operation of the switching circuit is formed from the cross-coupling of the two inverters.
- These inverters are also known as level shifting inverters since the input voltages, from data store capacitors 2219 and 2229 , are lower than the output voltages, i.e. the V at which is supplied to the actuators.
- control matrix 2200 The two stable actuation states of control matrix 2200 are associated with substantially zero current flow between the charge interconnect 2210 and the global actuation interconnect 2214 , an important power savings. This is achieved because the shutter-open charge transistor 2216 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 2218 are made from different transistor types, pMOS or nMOS, while the shutter-close charge transistor 2220 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 2222 are also made from the different transistor types, pMOS and nMOS.
- control matrix 2200 allows for a constant voltage actuation of the shutter assembly 2204 , without the need for voltage stabilizing capacitors, such as capacitor 2031 or 2033 in control matrix 2000 of FIG. 20 . This is because one of the charging transistors 2216 or 2220 remains on throughout the actuation event, allowing the corresponding actuator to maintain a low impedance connection to the DC supply of the interconnect 2210 throughout the actuation event.
- the control matrix 2200 applies a write enable voltage to each scan-line interconnect 2206 in sequence. While a particular row of pixels 2202 is write-enabled, the control matrix 2200 applies a data voltage to either the shutter-open interconnect 2208 a or the shutter-close interconnect 2208 b corresponding to each column of pixels 2202 in the control matrix 2200 .
- the application of V, to the scan-line interconnect 2206 for the write-enabled row turns on both of the write-enable transistors 2217 and 2227 of the pixels 2202 in the corresponding scan line.
- the voltages applied to the data interconnects 2208 a and 2208 b are thereby caused to be stored on the data store capacitors 2219 and 2229 of the respective pixels 2202 .
- the actuators either the shutter-closed actuator or the shutter-open actuator, is caused to be discharged for any given shutter assembly in the array.
- control matrix 2200 the global actuation interconnect 2214 is connected to the source of the both the shutter-open discharge switch transistor 2218 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 2222 . Maintaining the global actuation interconnect 2214 at a potential significantly above that of the shutter common interconnect 2215 prevents the turn-on of any of the discharge switch transistors 2218 or 2222 , regardless of what charge is stored on the capacitors 2219 and 2229 .
- Global actuation in control matrix 2200 is achieved by bringing the potential on the global actuation interconnect 2214 to substantially the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 2215 , making it possible for the discharge switch transistors 2218 or 2222 to turn-on in accordance to whether a data voltage has been stored on either capacitor 2219 or 2222 .
- the state of the transistors Upon setting the global actuation interconnect to the same potential as the shutter common interconnect, the state of the transistors will either remain unchanged from its stable state as it was set at the last actuation event, or it will switch to the alternate stable state, in accordance to whether a data voltage has been stored on either capacitor 2219 or 2222 .
- the voltage stored on capacitors 2219 or 2229 is not necessarily the same as the actuation voltage as applied to the charge interconnect 2210 . Therefore some optional specifications on the transistors can help to reduce any transient switching currents in control matrix 2200 . For instance, it may be preferable to increase the ratio of width to length in the discharge transistors 2218 and 2222 as compared to the charge transistors 2216 and 2220 .
- the ratio of width to length for the discharge transistors may vary between 1 to 10 while the ratio of length to width for the charge transistors may vary between 0.1 and 1.
- control matrix 2200 In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the shutter assembly 2204 , the control matrix 2200 alternates between two control logics as described in relation to control matrix 1600 of FIG. 16A .
- FIG. 23 is yet another suitable control matrix 2300 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 2300 controls an array of pixels 2302 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2304 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators).
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 2304 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 2300 includes a scan-line interconnect 2306 for each row of pixels 2302 in the control matrix 2300 .
- the control matrix 2300 only includes a single data interconnect 2308 .
- the control matrix 2300 further includes a charge interconnect 2310 , and a global actuation interconnect 2314 , and a shutter common interconnect 2315 .
- These interconnects 2310 , 2314 and 2315 are shared among pixels 2302 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 2310 , 2314 and 2315 are shared among all pixels 2302 in the control matrix 2300 .
- Each pixel 2302 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor Q 16 , a shutter-open discharge transistor Q 18 , a shutter-open write-enable transistor Q 17 , and a data store capacitor C 19 , as described in FIGS. 16A and 19 .
- Each pixel 2302 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor Q 20 , and a shutter-close discharge transistor Q 22 , and a shutter-close write-enable transistor Q 27 .
- the control matrix 2300 makes use of two complementary types of transistors, both p-channel and n-channel transistors. It is therefore referred to as a complementary MOS control matrix or a CMOS control matrix.
- the charging transistors Q 16 and Q 20 are of the pMOS type, while the discharge transistors Q 18 and Q 22 are of the nMOS type.
- the types of transistors employed in control matrix 2300 can be reversed, for example nMOS transistors can be used for the charging transistors and pMOS transistors can be used for the discharge transistors.
- the control matrix 2300 includes a level shifting inverter 2332 , comprised of transistors Q 31 and Q 33 ; it includes a transition-sharpening inverter 2336 , comprised of transistors Q 35 and Q 37 ; and it includes a switching inverter 2340 , comprised of transistors Q 39 and Q 41 .
- Each of these inverters is comprised of complementary pairs of transistors (i.e., nMOS coupled with pMOS).
- the sources of transistors Q 33 , Q 37 , and Q 41 are connected to a V dd supply interconnect 2334 .
- the sources of transistors Q 31 , Q 35 , and Q 39 are connected to the global actuation interconnect 2314 .
- the CMOS control matrix 2300 does not incorporate and does not require any voltage stabilizing capacitors, such as 2031 and 2033 from control matrix 2000 of FIG. 20 .
- Control matrix 2300 does not include a charge trigger interconnect (such as charge trigger interconnect 1912 of FIG. 19 ).
- the transistors Q 16 , Q 18 , Q 20 , and Q 22 are cross connected and operate as a flip flop.
- the sources of both transistors Q 16 and Q 20 are connected directly to charge interconnect 2310 , which is held at a DC potential equal to the actuation voltage V at , e.g. at 40 volts.
- the sources of both transistors Q 18 and Q 22 are connected to the global actuation interconnect 2314 .
- control matrix 2300 does not require a distinct charging sequence or any variation or pulsing of the voltage from charge interconnect 2310 .
- the flip-flop switching circuit can be recognized as the cross coupling of two inverters, namely a shutter open inverter (transistors Q 16 and Q 18 ) and a shutter close inverter (transistors Q 20 and Q 22 ).
- the flip-flop circuit formed by transistors Q 16 , Q 18 , Q 20 , and Q 22 is associated with substantially zero DC current flow, and therefore forms a low power voltage switching circuit. This is achieved because of the use of complementary (CMOS) transistor types.
- CMOS complementary
- control matrix 2300 allows for a constant voltage actuation of the shutter assembly 2304 , without the need for voltage stabilizing capacitors, such as capacitor 2031 or 2033 in control matrix 2000 of FIG. 20 . This is because one of the charging transistors Q 16 or Q 20 remains on throughout the actuation event, allowing the corresponding actuator to maintain a low impedance connection to the DC supply of the interconnect 2210 throughout the actuation event.
- the control matrix 2300 applies a write enable voltage to each scan-line interconnect 2306 in sequence. While a particular row of pixels 2302 is write-enabled, the control matrix 2300 applies a data voltage to the data interconnect 2308 .
- the application of V, to the scan-line interconnect 2306 for the write-enabled row turns on the write-enable transistor Q 17 of the pixels 2302 in the corresponding scan line.
- the voltages applied to the data interconnect 2308 is thereby caused to be stored on the data store capacitor 2319 of the respective pixels 2302 .
- the level shifting inverter 2332 outputs a voltage V dd (derived from supply interconnect 2334 ), e.g. 8 volts, which is provisionally supplied to the input of the transition sharpening inverter 2336 , depending on the voltage state of capacitor C 19 .
- the transition-sharpening inverter 2336 outputs the inverse or complement of its input from the voltage leveling inverter 2332 , and supplies that complement voltage to both the switching inverter 2340 , as well as to the gate of transistor Q 22 .
- the switching inverter 2340 ensures that only one of the discharge transistors Q 18 or Q 22 can be on at any one time, thereby ensuring proper actuation of shutter assembly 2304 .
- the presence of the switching inverter 2340 obviates the need for a separate shutter-close data interconnect.
- the level shifting inverter 2332 requires only a low voltage input (e.g. 3 volts) and outputs a complement which is shifted to the higher voltage of V dd (e.g. 8 volts). For instance, if the voltage on capacitor C 19 is 3 volts, then the output voltage from inverter 2332 will be close to zero, while if the voltage on capacitor C 19 is close to zero, then the output from the inverter 2332 will be at V dd (e.g. 8 volts). The presence of the level shifting inverter, therefore, provides several advantages. A higher voltage (e.g. 8 volts) is supplied as a switch voltage to discharge transistors Q 18 and Q 22 .
- V dd e.g. 8 volts
- interconnect 2334 which is a DC supply and which only needs to provide enough current to charge the gate capacitance on various transistors in the pixel.
- the power required to drive the supply interconnect 2334 will, therefore, be only a minor contributor to the power required to drive shutter assembly 2304 .
- the data voltage, supplied by data interconnect 2308 and stored on capacitor C 19 can be less than 5 volts (e.g. 3 volts) and the power associated with AC voltage variations on interconnect 2308 will be substantially reduced.
- the transition-sharpening inverter 2336 helps to reduce the switching time or latency between voltage states as output to the discharge transistor Q 22 and to the switching inverter 2340 . Any reduction in switching time on the inputs to the CMOS switching circuit (Q 16 through Q 22 ) helps to reduce the transient switching currents experienced by that circuit.
- CMOS switching circuit with transistors Q 16 through Q 22 , the CMOS switching inverter 2340 , and the CMOS level shifting inverter 2332 makes the control matrix 2300 an attractive low power method for driving an array of shutter assemblies 2304 .
- Reliable actuation of even dual-actuator shutter assemblies, such as shutter assembly 2304 is achieved with the use of only a single storage capacitor, C 19 , in each pixel.
- control matrix 2300 the global actuation interconnect 2314 is connected to the source of transistors Q 31 , Q 35 , Q 39 , Q 18 , and Q 22 . Maintaining the global actuation interconnect 2314 at a potential significantly above that of the shutter common interconnect 2315 prevents the turn-on of any of the transistors Q 31 , Q 35 , Q 39 , Q 18 , and Q 22 , regardless of what charge is stored on the capacitor C 19 .
- Global actuation in control matrix 2300 is achieved by bringing the potential on the global actuation interconnect 2314 to substantially the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 2315 . During the time that the global actuation is so activated, all of the transistors Q 31 , Q 35 , Q 39 , Q 18 , and Q 22 have the opportunity to change their state, depending on what data voltage has been stored on capacitor C 19 .
- the voltage supplied by supply interconnect 2334 , V dd is not necessarily the same as the actuation voltage V at , as supplied by the charge interconnect 2310 . Therefore, some optional specifications on transistors Q 16 through Q 22 can help to reduce the transient switching currents in control matrix 2300 . For instance it may be preferable to increase the width to length ratio in the discharge transistors Q 18 and Q 22 as compared to the charge transistors Q 16 and Q 20 .
- the ratio of width to length for the discharge transistors may vary between 1 and 10 while the ratio of length to width for the charge transistors may vary between 0.1 and 1.
- the width to length ratio between level shifting transistors Q 31 and Q 33 should be similarly differentiated. For instance, the ratio of width to length for transistor Q 31 may vary between 1 and 10 while the ratio of width to length for transistor Q 33 may vary between 0.1 and 1.
- control matrix 2300 In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the shutter assembly 2304 , the control matrix 2300 alternates between two control logics as described in relation to control matrix 1600 of FIG. 16A .
- control matrix 2300 Alternative embodiments to control matrix 2300 are also possible.
- the level shifting inverters 2332 and the transition sharpening inverter 2336 can be removed from the circuit as long as the voltage supplied by the data interconnect 2308 is high enough to switch the flip-flop circuit reliably.
- this required switching voltage may be as high as 8 volts, the power dissipation for such a simplified circuit is expected to increase by comparison to control matrix 2300 .
- the simplified circuit would, however, require less real estate and could therefore be packed to higher pixel densities.
- control matrix 2300 the pre-charge circuit from control matrices 2000 and 2100 of FIGS. 20 and 21 , respectively, can be substituted into control matrix 2300 , in place of transistors Q 16 , Q 18 , Q 20 , and Q 22 .
- the transition sharpening inverter 2336 would no longer be necessary.
- both types of transistors would still be beneficial in the level shifting inverter 2332 and in the switching inverter 2340 . This circuit would thereby exhibit power dissipation advantages by comparison to control matrix 2100 of FIG. 21 .
- FIG. 24 is yet another suitable control matrix 2440 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 2440 controls an array of pixels 2442 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2444 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators).
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 2444 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- Control matrix 2440 is substantially the same as control matrix 1640 of FIG. 16B , except for three changes.
- a dual-actuator shutter assembly 2444 is utilized instead of the elastic shutter assembly 1644 , a new common drive interconnect 2462 is added, and there is no voltage stabilizing capacitor, such as capacitor 1652 , in control matrix 2440 .
- the common drive interconnect 2462 is electrically connected to the shutter-open actuator of the shutter assembly 2444 .
- control matrix 2440 includes only a single data interconnect 2448 for each column of pixels 2442 in the control matrix.
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 2444 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 2440 includes a scan-line interconnect 2446 for each row of pixels 2442 in the control matrix 2440 .
- the control matrix 2440 further includes a charge interconnect 2450 , a global actuation interconnect 2454 , and a shutter common interconnect 2455 .
- the interconnects 2450 , 2454 , 2455 , and 2462 are shared among pixels 2442 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 2450 , 2454 , 2455 , and 2462 are shared among all pixels 2442 in the control matrix 2440 .
- Each pixel 2442 in the control matrix includes a shutter charge transistor 2456 , a shutter discharge transistor 2458 , a shutter write-enable transistor 2457 , and a data store capacitor 2459 as described in FIGS. 16A and 19 .
- the drain of the shutter discharge transistor is connected to the shutter-close actuator of the shutter assembly 2444 .
- the charging transistor 2456 is wired with a different circuit connection to the charge interconnect 2450 .
- Control matrix 2440 does not include a charge trigger interconnect which is shared among pixels. Instead, the gate terminals of the charging transistor 2456 are connected directly to the charge interconnect 2450 , along with the drain terminal of transistor 2456 .
- the charging transistors operate essentially as diodes, i.e., they can pass a current in only 1 direction. Their function in the charging circuit becomes equivalent to that of diode 1410 in control circuit 1400 of FIG. 14 .
- a method of addressing and actuating the pixels in control matrix 2440 is illustrated by the method 2470 shown in FIG. 25 .
- the method 2470 proceeds in three general steps. First the matrix is addressed row by row by storing data into the data store capacitors 2459 . Next all actuators are actuated (or reset) simultaneously (step 2488 ) in part by applying a voltage V at to the charge interconnect 2450 . And finally the image is set in steps 2492 - 2494 by a) selectively activating transistors 2458 by means of the global actuation interconnect 2454 and b) changing the potential difference between the common drive interconnect 2462 and the shutter common interconnect 2455 so as to be greater than an actuation voltage V at .
- control matrix 2440 can operate between two control logics—which provide a periodic polarity reversal and thereby ensure a 0V DC average operation across the shutter assemblies 2442 .
- control method 2470 For reasons of clarity the details for control method 2470 are described next with respect to only the first control logic.
- this first control logic the potential of the shutter common interconnect 2455 is maintained at all times near to the ground potential.
- a shutter will be held in either the open or closed states by applying a voltage V at directly across either or both of the charge interconnect 2450 or the common drive interconnect 2462 .
- the shutter common interconnect is held at the voltage V at , and an actuated state will be maintained by maintaining either or both of the charge interconnect 2450 or the common drive interconnect 2462 at ground.
- the frame addressing cycle of method 2470 begins when a voltage V off is applied to the global actuation interconnect 2454 (step 2472 ).
- the voltage V off on interconnect 2454 is designed to ensure that the discharge transistor 2458 will not turn on regardless of whether a voltage has been stored on capacitor 2459 .
- the control matrix 2440 then proceeds with the addressing of each pixel 2442 in the control matrix, one row at a time (steps 2474 - 2484 ). To address a particular row, the control matrix 2440 write-enables a first scan line by applying a voltage V we to the corresponding scan-line interconnect 2446 (step 2474 ). Then, at decision block 2476 , the control matrix 2440 determines for each pixel 2442 in the write-enabled row whether the pixel 2442 needs to be open or closed. For example, if at the reset step 2488 all shutters are to be (temporarily) closed, then at decision block 2476 it is determined for each pixel 2442 in the write-enabled row whether or not the pixel is to be (subsequently) opened.
- the control matrix 2440 applies a data voltage V d , for example 5V, to the data interconnect 2448 corresponding to the column in which that pixel 2442 is located (step 2478 ).
- the voltage V d applied to the data interconnect 2448 is thereby caused to be stored by means of a charge on the data store capacitor 2459 of the selected pixel 2442 (step 2479 ).
- the corresponding data interconnect 2448 is grounded (step 2480 ).
- the temporary (or reset) position after step 2488 in this example is defined as the shutter-close position
- alternative shutter assemblies can be provided in which the reset position after 2488 is a shutter-open position. In these alternative cases, the application of data voltage V d , at step 2478 , would result in the opening of the shutter.
- the application of V we to the scan-line interconnect 2446 for the write-enabled row turns on all of the write-enable transistors 2457 for the pixels 2442 in the corresponding scan line.
- the control matrix 2440 selectively applies the data voltage to all columns of a given row in the control matrix 2440 at the same time while that row has been write-enabled. After all data has been stored on capacitors 2459 in the selected row (steps 2479 and 2481 ), the control matrix 2440 grounds the selected scan-line interconnect (step 2482 ) and selects a subsequent scan-line interconnect for writing (step 2485 ). After the information has been stored in the capacitors for all the rows in control matrix 2440 , the decision block 2484 is triggered to begin the global actuation sequence.
- the actuation sequence begins at step 2486 of method 2470 , with the application of an actuation voltage V at , e.g. 40 V, to the charge interconnect 2450 .
- V at e.g. 40 V
- the voltage V at is now imposed simultaneously across all of the shutter-close actuators of all the shutter assemblies 2444 in control matrix 2440 .
- step 2487 the potential on the common drive interconnect 2462 is grounded.
- a grounded common drive interconnect 2462 reduces the voltage drop across all of the shutter-open actuators of all shutter assemblies 2444 to a value substantially below the maintenance voltage V m .
- step 2488 acts to reset and close all actuators into an initial state.
- the reset step 2488 acts to open all shutters.
- the common drive interconnect 2462 would be electrically connected to the shutter-closed actuator of all shutter assemblies 2444 .
- the control matrix grounds the charge interconnect 2450 .
- the electrodes on the shutter-close actuators in shutter assembly 2444 provide a capacitance which stores a charge after the charge interconnect 2450 has been grounded and the charging transistor 2456 has been turned off. The stored charge acts to maintain a voltage in excess of the maintenance voltage V m across the shutter-close actuator.
- the data stored in capacitors 2459 can now be utilized to set an image in control matrix 2440 by selectively opening the specified shutter assemblies (steps 2492 - 2494 ).
- the potential on the global actuation interconnect 2454 is set to ground (step 2492 ).
- Step 2492 makes it possible for the discharge switch transistor 2458 to turn-on in accordance to whether a data voltage has been stored on capacitor 2459 .
- the charge which was stored on the shutter-close actuator of shutter assembly 2444 is now allowed to dissipate through the global actuation interconnect 2454 .
- the voltage on the common drive interconnect 2462 is returned to the actuation voltage V at , or is set such that the potential difference between the common drive interconnect 2462 and the shutter common interconnect 2455 is greater than an actuation voltage V at .
- the conditions for selective actuation of the pixels have now been set. For those pixels in which a charge (or voltage V d ) has been stored on capacitor 2459 , the voltage difference across the shutter-close actuator will now be less than the maintenance voltage V m while the voltage across the shutter-open actuator (which is tied to the common drive 2462 ) will at V at . These selected shutters will now be caused to open at step 2494 .
- each shutter is in its addressed state, i.e., the position dictated by the data voltages applied during the addressing and actuating method 2470 .
- the process begins again at step 2472 .
- the positions of the steps 2486 and 2487 in the sequence can be switched, so that step 2487 occurs before step 2486 .
- step 2470 all of the shutters are closed simultaneously during the time between step 2488 and step 2494 , a time in which no image information can be presented to the viewer.
- the method 2470 is designed to minimize this dead time (or reset time), by making use of data store capacitors 2459 and global actuation interconnect 2454 to provide timing control over the transistors 2458 .
- step 2472 all of the data for a given image frame can be written to the capacitors 2459 during the addressing sequence (steps 2474 - 2485 ), without any immediate actuation effect on the shutter assemblies.
- the shutter assemblies 2444 remain locked in the positions they were assigned in the previous image frame until addressing is complete and they are uniformly actuated or reset at step 2488 .
- the global actuation step 2492 allows the simultaneous transfer of data out of the data store capacitors 2459 so that all shutter assemblies can be brought into their next image state at the same time.
- the activity of an attached backlight can be synchronized with the addressing of each frame.
- a command to turn the illumination off can be given between step 2484 and step 2486 .
- the illumination can then be turned-on again after step 2494 .
- a lamp with one color can be turned off after step 2484 while a lamp with either the same or a different color is turned on after step 2494 .
- the data voltage V d can be significantly less than the actuation voltage V at (e.g., 5V vs. 40V). Since the actuation voltage V at is applied once a frame, whereas the data voltage V d may be applied to each data interconnect 2448 as may times per frame as there are rows in the control matrix 2440 , control matrices such as control matrix 2440 may save a substantial amount of power in comparison to control matrices which require a data voltage to be high enough to also serve as the actuation voltage.
- FIG. 24 assumes the use of n-channel MOS transistors. Other embodiments are possible that employ p-channel transistors, in which case the relative signs of the bias potentials V at and V d would be reversed.
- control matrix alternates between two control logics as described with respect to control method 1000 of FIG. 10 , or with respect to control matrix 1400 of FIG. 14 .
- the two control logics provide a periodic polarity reversal and thereby ensure a 0V DC average operation across the shutter assemblies 2442 .
- To achieve polarity reversal in the second control logic several of the voltage assignments illustrated and described with respect to method 2470 of FIG. 25 are changed, although the sequencing of the control steps remains the same.
- the potential on the shutter common interconnect 2455 is maintained at a voltage near to V at (instead of near ground as was the case in the first control logic).
- the data interconnect 2448 is grounded instead of taken to V d .
- the data interconnect is taken to the voltage V d .
- Step 2486 remains the same, but at step 2487 the common drive interconnect is set to the actuation voltage V at in the second control logic instead of to ground.
- each of the shutter common interconnect 2455 , the common drive interconnect 2462 , and the charge interconnect 2450 are set to the same voltage V at .
- the image setting sequence then continues with grounding of the global actuation interconnect 2454 at step 2492 —which has the effect in this second logic of closing only those shutters for which a voltage V d was stored across the capacitor 2459 .
- the common drive interconnect 2462 is grounded. This has the effect of actuating and opening any shutters that were not otherwise actuated at step 2492 .
- the logical state expressed at step 2494 therefore, is reversed in the second control logic, and the polarities are also effectively reversed.
- any of the control matrices 1100 , 1300 , 1400 , 1500 , or 1700 which were illustrated through the use of single-actuated or elastic shutter assemblies, can be adapted advantageously for use with a dual-actuated shutter assembly such as 1904 by reproducing the control circuit in mirror fashion for each of the open and closed actuators.
- the data supplied to the data-open interconnects and the data-closed interconnects will often be complementary, i.e. If a logical “1” is supplied to the data-open interconnect then a logical “0” will typically be supplied to the data closed interconnect.
- the control matrices can be modified to replace the transistors with varistors.
- control matrix keeps track of the prior position of each pixel and only applies positions to the data interconnects corresponding to a pixel if the state of the pixel for the next image frame is different than the prior position.
- the pixels include mechanically bi-stable shutter assemblies instead of just electrically bi-stable shutter assemblies.
- the charge trigger transistors can be replaced with resistors and the charge trigger interconnect can be omitted from the control matrix, as described above in relation to FIG. 18 .
- the dual control logic used by control matrix 1400 may also be utilized in other implementations of control matrix 1800 .
- FIG. 26 is a schematic diagram of yet another suitable control matrix 2640 for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 2640 controls an array of pixels 2642 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2644 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators).
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 2004 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- Control matrix 2640 is substantially the same as control matrix 2440 , with two changes: a charge trigger interconnect 2652 has been added and a pMOS transistor has been substituted for the charging transistor 2656 instead of the nMOS transistor as was indicated at 2456 .
- the control matrix 2640 utilizes a dual-actuator shutter assembly 2644 along with a common drive interconnect 2662 .
- the common drive interconnect 2662 is electrically connected to the shutter-open actuator of the shutter assembly 2644 .
- the control matrix 2640 includes only a single data interconnect 2648 for each column of pixels 2642 in the control matrix.
- the control matrix 2640 includes a scan-line interconnect 2646 for each row of pixels 2642 in the control matrix 2640 .
- the control matrix 2640 further includes a charge interconnect 2650 , a charge trigger interconnect 2652 , a global actuation interconnect 2654 , and a shutter common interconnect 2655 .
- the interconnects 2650 , 2654 , 2655 , and 2662 are shared among pixels 2642 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), the interconnects 2650 , 2654 , 2655 , and 2662 are shared among all pixels 2642 in the control matrix 2640 .
- Each pixel 2642 in the control matrix includes a shutter charge transistor 2656 , a shutter discharge transistor 2658 , a shutter write-enable transistor 2657 , and a data store capacitor 2659 as described in FIGS. 16 and 18 .
- the drain of the shutter discharge transistor is connected to the shutter-close actuator of the shutter assembly 2644 .
- the control matrix 2640 makes use of two complementary types of transistors: both p-channel and n-channel transistors. It is therefore referred to as a complementary MOS control matrix or a CMOS control matrix. While the charging transistor 2656 is made of the pMOS type, the discharge transistor 2658 is made of the nMOS type of transistor. (In other implementations the types of transistors can be reversed, for example nMOS transistors can be used for the charging transistors and pMOS transistors can be used for the discharge transistors.) The use of a charge trigger interconnect along with the CMOS circuit helps to reduce the set of voltage variations required to achieve shutter actuation.
- the control circuit 2640 is wired to the charging transistor 2656 in a fashion similar to that of control matrix 1600 .
- Only the source of pMOS transistor 2656 is connected to the charge interconnect 2650 while the gate is connected to the charge trigger interconnect 2652 .
- the charge interconnect 2650 is maintained at a constant voltage equal to the actuation voltage V at .
- the charge trigger interconnect 2652 is maintained at the same voltage (V at ) as that of the charge interconnect whenever the charge transistor 2656 is to be held in the off state.
- the voltage on the charge trigger interconnect 2652 is reduced so that the voltage difference between charge interconnect 2650 and interconnect 2652 is greater than the threshold voltage of the transistor 2656 .
- Threshold voltages can vary in a range from 2 to 8 volts.
- both the charge interconnect 2650 and the charge trigger interconnect 2652 are held at a V at of 40 volts when the transistor 2656 is off.
- the voltage on the charge interconnect 2650 would remain at 40 volts while the voltage on the charge trigger interconnect 2652 is temporarily reduced to 35 volts. (If an nMOS transistor were to be used at the point of transistor 2656 , then the V at would be ⁇ 40 volts and a charge trigger voltage of ⁇ 35 volts would be sufficient to turn the transistor on.)
- a method for addressing and actuating pixels in control matrix 2640 is similar to that of method 2470 , with the following changes.
- the voltage on the charge trigger interconnect is reduced from V at to V at minus a threshold voltage. Similar to the operation of method 2470 all of the shutter-closed actuators then become charged at the same time, and at step 2488 all shutters will close while a constant voltage V at is maintained across the shutter close actuator.
- the charge interconnect 2650 is allowed to remain at V at while the transistor 2656 is turned off by returning the voltage on the charge trigger interconnect 2652 to V at . After the transistor 2656 is turned off, the actuation procedure proceeds to the global actuation step 2492 .
- the actuator charging process at step 2486 in method 2470 can be accomplished as described above for control matrix 2640 with nearly zero voltage change on the charge interconnect 2650 and only a minimal (threshold voltage) change required for the charge trigger interconnect 2652 . Therefore the energy required to repeatedly change the voltage from Vat to ground and back is saved in this control matrix. The power required to drive each actuation cycle is considerably reduced in control matrix 2640 as compared to control matrix 2440 .
- nMOS and pMOS transistor types can be applied to the charging transistors in control matrices 1500 , 1600 , 1700 , 1800 , 1900 , 2000 , 2100 , 2200 , and 2300 to reduce the power required for actuation.
- FIG. 27 is a schematic diagram of another control matrix 2740 suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus 100 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.
- Control matrix 2740 operates in a manner substantially similar to that of control matrix 2440 , except that some of the circuit elements are now shared between multiple shutter assemblies in the array of shutter assemblies.
- several of the common interconnects are wired into separate groups, such that each of these common interconnects are shared only amongst the pixels of their particular group.
- the control matrix 2740 includes an array of dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2744 . Similar to the control matrix 2440 , however, the control matrix 2740 includes only a single data interconnect 2748 for each column of pixels 2742 in the control matrix.
- the actuators in the shutter assemblies 2744 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable.
- the control matrix 2740 includes one scan-line interconnect 2746 which is shared amongst four consecutive rows of pixels 2742 in the array of pixels. Each pixel in the array is also connected to a global actuation interconnect, a common drive interconnect, a charge interconnect, and a shutter common interconnect. For the embodiment illustrated in FIG. 27 , however, the pixels are identified as members of four separate groups which are connected in common only to certain interconnects within their particular group.
- the pixels 2742 A for instance, are aligned along the first row and are members of the first group in control matrix 2740 . Each pixel in the group of pixels that include pixels 2742 A is connected to a global actuation interconnect 2754 A and a common drive interconnect 2762 A.
- the pixels 2742 B are aligned along the second row and are members of the second group in control matrix 2740 .
- Each pixel in the group of pixels 2742 B is connected to a global actuation interconnect 2754 B and a common drive interconnect 2762 B.
- the pixels 2742 C in the third row are members of the third group of pixels which are connected in common to global actuation interconnect 2754 C and common drive interconnect 2762 C.
- the pixels 2742 D in the third row are members of the third group of pixels which are connected in common to global actuation interconnect 2754 D and common drive interconnect 2762 D.
- the sequential pattern of rows including pixels 2742 A, 2742 B, 2742 C, and 2742 D is repeated for rows that continue both above and below the pixels illustrated in FIG. 27 .
- Each group of four rows includes a single scan line interconnect 2746 which is shared between the four rows.
- the global actuation interconnects 2754 A, 2754 B, 2754 C, and 2754 D are electrically independent of each other.
- a global actuation signal applied to the interconnect 2754 A may actuate all pixels 2742 A within that row of the array, as well as all pixels in similarly connected rows (that occur in every fourth row of the array).
- a global actuation signal applied to the interconnect 2754 A will not actuate any of the pixels in the other groups, e.g. it will not actuate the pixels 2742 B, 2742 C, or 2742 D.
- the common drive interconnects 2762 A, 2762 B, 2762 C, and 2762 D are electrically independent, connecting to all pixels within their particular group but not to any pixels outside of their group.
- the control matrix 2740 further includes a charge interconnect 2750 and a shutter common interconnect 2755 .
- the interconnects 2750 and 2755 are shared among pixels 2742 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described FIG. 27 ), the interconnects 2750 and 2755 are shared among all pixels 2742 in the control matrix 2740 .
- Each pixel 2742 in the control matrix includes a shutter charge transistor 2756 and a shutter discharge transistor 2758 .
- the charge transistor 2756 is connected between the charge interconnect 2750 and the shutter-closed actuator of shutter assemblies 2744 in each pixel.
- the shutter discharge transistor 2758 is connected between the shutter assembly 2744 and the particular global actuation interconnect 2754 A, 2754 B, 2754 C, or 2754 D assigned to its group.
- the common drive interconnects 2762 A, 2762 B, 2762 C, and 2762 D are electrically connected to the shutter-open actuators of the shutter assemblies 2744 within their particular groups.
- each data interconnect 2748 and each scan line interconnect 2746 Near to the intersection of each data interconnect 2748 and each scan line interconnect 2746 is a write-enable transistor 2757 , and a data store capacitor 2759 .
- the transistors 2757 and capacitor 2759 appear in each column but, like the scan line interconnect 2746 , they appear only once in every four rows. The function of these circuit elements is shared between the pixels in each of the four adjacent rows.
- a fan-out interconnect 2766 is used to connect the charge stored on the capacitor 2759 to the gates on each of the shutter discharge transistors 2758 within the column for the four adjacent rows.
- shutter assemblies 2744 is very similar to that described for control matrix 2440 in method 2470 .
- the difference is that, for control matrix 2740 , the addressing and actuating of the pixels is carried out independently and during separate time intervals for each of the four pixel groups 2742 A, 2742 B, 2742 C, and 2742 D.
- the addressing for the pixels in group 2742 A would proceed by applying Voff to the global actuation interconnect 2754 A and applying a write-enable voltage to each of the scan line interconnects 2746 in turn.
- control matrix 2740 the data is loaded for only one group of pixels at a time (e.g. the pixels 2742 A in group A) and the actuation proceeds by activating only the global actuation interconnect ( 2754 A) and the common drive interconnect ( 2762 A) for that particular group of pixels.
- the control matrix proceeds with the loading of data into the second group of pixels, e.g. 2742 B.
- the addressing of the second group of pixels (group B) proceeds by use of the same set of scan line interconnects 2746 , data interconnects 2748 , and data store capacitors 2759 as were employed for group A.
- the data stored in capacitors 2759 will only affect the actuation of the pixels 2742 B in group B, however, since this data can only be transferred to the shutter assemblies of their particular group after actuation by means of the global actuation interconnect for the group, 2754 B.
- each the four pixel groups is accomplished by means of the independent global actuation interconnects 2754 A, 2754 B, 2754 C, or 2754 D and independent common drive interconnects 2762 A, 2762 B, 2762 C, or 2762 D.
- the pixels in the array have been broken into four groups A, B, C, and D.
- Other embodiments are possible, however, in which the array can be broken into only 2 groups, into 3 groups, into 6 groups, or into 8 groups.
- the pixels of a group are connected in common to their own particular global actuation interconnect and common drive interconnect.
- the scan line interconnect, the write-enable transistor, and the data store capacitor would appear in every other row.
- the scan line interconnect, the write-enable transistor, and the data store capacitor would appear in every sixth row.
- the charge interconnect 2750 and shutter common interconnect 2755 are shared among pixels 2742 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array.
- the charge interconnects and shutter common interconnects can also be assigned and shared only among particular groups, such as groups A, B, C, and D.
- control matrix 2440 The sharing of actuation interconnects amongst distinct groups, and the sharing of scan line interconnects, write-enable transistors, and data store capacitors amongst adjacent rows has been described in an implementation particular to the control matrix 2440 . Similar sharing of pixel elements, however, can be adopted with respect to a number of other control matrices, such as control matrices 1400 , 1500 , 1600 , 1640 , 1700 , 1800 , 1900 , 2000 , 2100 , 2200 , 2300 , and 2640 .
- the MEMS-based light modulators used to form an image utilize electrostatic actuation, in which opposing capacitive members are drawn together during an actuation event.
- electrostatic actuation in which opposing capacitive members are drawn together during an actuation event.
- the force drawing the capacitive members will vary in relation to the voltage applied across the electrostatic members. If the charge stored on the actuator is held constant, then the voltage and thus the force attracting the capacitive members, may decrease as the capacitive beams draw closer together. For such actuators, it is desirable to maintain a substantially constant voltage across the capacitive members to maintain sufficient force to complete actuation.
- force is proportional to the strength of the electric field between the capacitive portions of the actuator, the electric field likewise being proportional to the amount of charge stored on the capacitive members.
- an elastic restoring force is present which increases as capacitive members draw together, it may be necessary to increase the stored charge on the members to complete the actuation.
- An increase in stored charge and therefore the force of actuation can be accomplished by connecting the actuator to a source of charge, i.e. a constant voltage source.
- Control matrix 1900 of FIG. 19 operates in conditions in which actuators are electrically isolated from a source of charge during actuation. Prior to actuation of either of the two actuators included in the pixel, charge yielding a voltage sufficient to initiate actuation of both actuators V at , absent a maintenance voltage, is stored directly on each actuator. The actuators are then isolated from external voltage sources. At a later date, the charge stored on one of the actuators is discharged. The non-discharged actuator then actuates based solely on the constant charge previously stored on the actuator.
- FIG. 28 includes three charts that illustrate the variations in electrostatic parameters that result from movement of portions of electrostatic actuators in various implementations of the invention.
- the chart labeled Case A in FIG. 28 illustrates the variations in parameters associated with the actuation of the actuator of a pixel from control matrix 1900 from an open position to a closed position.
- the initial voltage applied to the actuator is preferably high enough such that as the voltage decreases resulting from motion of portions of the actuator, the resulting voltage is still sufficient to fully actuate the actuator.
- a control matrix can incorporate a voltage regulator in electrical communication with the actuator during actuation of the actuator.
- the voltage regulator maintains a substantially constant voltage on the actuator during actuation.
- the voltage regulator substantially limits variations in voltage that would otherwise be caused by movement of portions of the actuators during actuation.
- Voltage regulators can be included in each pixel in a control matrix, for example, as stabilizing capacitors connected to the capacitive members of the actuators.
- Control matrices 500 , 700 , 900 , 1400 , 1500 , 1640 , 1800 , 2000 , and 2100 include such stabilizing capacitors.
- the impact of such a stabilizing capacitor is depicted in the chart labeled as Case B in FIG. 28 .
- charge stored on the stabilizing capacitor flows into the capacitive member maintaining a voltage equilibrium between the stabilizing capacitor and the actuator.
- the voltage on the actuator decreases, but less so than in control matrices without a stabilizing capacitor.
- the stabilizing capacitor is selected such that during actuation, the variation in the voltage on the actuator is limited to less than about 20% of V at .
- a higher capacitance capacitor is selected such that during actuation, the variation in the voltage on the actuator is limited to less than about 10% of V at .
- the stabilizing capacitor is selected such that during actuation, the variation in the voltage on the actuator is limited to less than about 5% of V at .
- display drivers may serve as voltage regulators.
- the display drivers output a DC actuation voltage.
- the voltage may be substantially constant throughout operation of the display apparatus in which it is incorporated.
- the application of the voltage output by the display drivers is regulated by transistors incorporated into each pixel in the control matrix.
- the display drivers switch between two substantially constant voltage levels according. In such implementations, no such transistors are needed.
- the pixels are connected to the display drivers by means of a voltage actuation interconnect.
- a voltage actuation interconnect such as interconnect 2662 , can be a global common interconnect, meaning that it connects to pixels in at least two rows and two columns of the array of pixels.
- Control matrices 600 , 1100 , 1300 , 1600 , 1700 , 1900 , 2200 , 2300 , 2440 , 2640 , and 2740 include voltage regulators in the form of connections to voltage sources. As illustrated in Case C of FIG. 28 , as the capacitive members of an electrostatic actuator connected to a voltage source draw together, the voltage across the capacitive members remains substantially constant. To maintain the constant voltage despite increasing capacitance, additional charge flows into the capacitive members as the capacitance of the actuator increases.
- the display apparatus 100 provides high-quality video images using relatively low power.
- the optical throughput efficiency of a shutter-based light valve can be an order of magnitude higher than afforded by liquid crystal displays, because there is no need for polarizers or color filters in the production of the image.
- a regenerative light guide can be designed which allows for 75% of the light produced in a backlight to be made available to a viewer.
- one method for producing video images in a shutter-based display is the use of field-sequential color.
- Color filters reduce the optical efficiency by >60% through absorption in the filters.
- Displays utilizing field sequential color instead use a backlight which produces pure red, green and blue light in an ordered sequence. A separate image is generated for each color. When the separate color images are alternated at frequencies in excess of 50 Hz, the human eye averages the images to produce the perception of a single image with a broad and continuous range of colors. Efficient backlights can now be produced that allow fast switching between pure colors from either light-emitting diode (LED) sources or electroluminescent sources.
- LED light-emitting diode
- control matrices illustrated in FIGS. 5 , 6 , 7 , 9 , 11 , 13 - 19 provide means for generating color-specific images (color sub-frame images), with accurate gray-tones, and the means for switching between color images in rapid fashion.
- Formation of accurate images with field-sequential color can be improved by synchronization between the backlight and the pixel addressing process, especially since it requires a finite period of time to switch or reset each pixel between the required states of each color sub-frame.
- the image controller may need to pause at each row or scan line of the display long enough for the mechanical switching or actuation to complete in each row. If the backlight were to broadly illuminate the whole display in a single color while the display controller was switching states, row by row, between 2 color images, then the resulting contrast would be confused.
- the number of unique colors available in the display is dependant in part on the levels of gray scale that are available within each of the three color images.
- Four principle methods of producing gray scale and combinations thereof are applicable to the transverse shutter displays.
- the first method of producing gray scale is an analog method, by which the shutters are caused to only partially obstruct an aperture in proportion to the application of a partial actuation voltage.
- Transverse shutters can be designed such that the percent of transmitted light is proportional to an actuation voltage, for instance through control of the shape of the actuation electrodes as described above in relation to FIG. 2 and in more detail in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035 referenced above.
- the display apparatus is equipped with a digital to analog converter such that the voltage delivered to the pixels is proportional to the intended gray scale level.
- the proportional voltage on each actuator is maintained throughout the period of an image frame such that the proportional shutter position is maintained throughout the illumination period.
- the optional use of a capacitor placed in parallel with the actuators in FIGS. 2 and 17 helps to ensure that, even though some charge may leak from the pixel during the time of illumination, the voltage does not change appreciably so as to alter the shutter position during the period of illumination.
- the analog gray scale has the advantage of requiring only 1 shutter in motion per pixel and the setting of only 1 image frame during the period of each color illumination.
- the data rates and addressing speeds for analog gray scale are therefore the least demanding amongst all alternative methods of gray scale.
- Transversely driven shutter assemblies as described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035 referenced above, can be built having actuation times in the range of 3 microseconds to 100 microseconds. Such rapid actuation makes possible the implementation of time division gray scale, wherein the contrast is achieved by controlling the relative on-times or duty cycles of the actuated shutters.
- a time division gray scale can be implemented using digital gray scale coding, in that control matrices incorporating bi-stable shutter assemblies recognize two states of shutter actuation, on or off. Gray scale is achieved by controlling the length of time a shutter is open.
- the switching times can be appreciated by assuming the case of a 60 Hz frame rate with field sequential color. Each color sub-frame is allotted 5.6 msec. If the available time interval were to be divided into 63 segments (6-bit gray scale per color), then the smallest increment of on-time for each image, known as the least significant bit time (LSB), would be 88 microseconds. If an image for the LSB time-bit were to be constructed and displayed using a global actuation scheme, then the actuation of all shutters would need to be completed in significantly less than the 88 microsecond LSB time. If the display is addressed in a row-by-row basis then the time available for reset at each row is considerably less.
- LSB least significant bit time
- the available actuation time can be less than 0.5 microseconds per row.
- a number of controller algorithms are possible for relaxing the time intervals required for addressing shutters in a row-by-row scheme (see for example N. A. Clark et al., Ferroelectrics, v. 46, p. 97 (2000)), but in any case the time required for shutter actuation in the 6-bit gray scale example is considerably less than 20 microseconds.
- a 6 bit binary time-division scheme (63 required time slots) can be reduced to a 5 bit time scheme (31 required time slots) by adding the availability of an additional gray scale bit in the spatial or area domain.
- the additional spatial bit can be accomplished with 2 shutters and apertures per pixel, especially if the shutters/apertures have unequal area.
- the number of required time bits can be reduced to 3 with the result still being an effective 64 levels of gray scale per color.
- contrast achieved through the illumination of the color image can be adjusted or given finer gray levels by means of altered intensity from the backlight. If the backlight is capable of fast response (as in the case of LED backlights), then contrast can be achieved by either altering the brightness of the backlight or the duration of its illumination.
- control matrix utilizes a global actuation scheme and that time division gray scale is accomplished through construction and display of distinct time-bit images illuminated for differing lengths of time.
- time division gray scale is accomplished through construction and display of distinct time-bit images illuminated for differing lengths of time.
- LSB longest
- 3 additional bits of gray scale can be added on top of a 4 bit time-division coding scheme by adding these short time-duration images accompanied by partial illumination. If the partial illumination bits are assigned to the smallest of the time slices, then a negligible loss of average projected brightness will result.
- the four principle means of gray scale are analog gray scale, time division gray scale, area division gray scale, and illumination gray scale. It should be understood that useful control schemes can be constructed by combinations of any of the above methods, for instance by combining the use of time division, area division and the use of partial illumination. Further divisions of gray scale are also available through interpolation techniques, also known as dither.
- Time domain dither includes the insertion of LSB time bits only in an alternating series of color frames.
- Spatial domain dither also known as half-toning, involves the control or opening of a specified fraction of neighboring pixels to produce localized areas with only partial brightness.
Landscapes
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Computer Hardware Design (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Theoretical Computer Science (AREA)
- Mechanical Light Control Or Optical Switches (AREA)
Abstract
The invention relates to methods and apparatus for forming images on a display utilizing a control matrix to control the movement of MEMs-based light modulators.
Description
- This application is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/607,715, filed Dec. 1, 2006 which claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/811,232, filed Jun. 5, 2006, and also is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. Nos. 11/326,696, 11/326,962, 11/326,900, and 11/326,784, all filed Jan. 6, 2006, and which claim the benefit of U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/676,053, filed Apr. 29, 2005, and U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/655,827, filed Feb. 23, 2005, and also is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035, filed Oct. 14, 2005, which is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/218,690, filed Sep. 2, 2005, which claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/676,053, filed Apr. 29, 2005, and U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 60/655,827, filed Feb. 23, 2005. Each of the above-identified applications is herein incorporated by reference in their entirety.
- In general, the invention relates to the field of imaging displays, in particular, the invention relates to circuits for controlling light modulators incorporated into imaging displays.
- Displays built from mechanical light modulators are an attractive alternative to displays based on liquid crystal technology. Mechanical light modulators are fast enough to display video content with good viewing angles and with a wide range of color and grey scale. Mechanical light modulators have been successful in projection display applications. Direct-view displays using mechanical light modulators have not yet demonstrated sufficiently attractive combinations of brightness and low power. There is a need in the art for fast, bright, low-powered mechanically actuated direct-view displays. Specifically there is a need for direct-view displays that can be driven at high speeds and at low voltages for improved image quality and reduced power consumption.
- Such direct-view displays can be manufactured using a array of MEMS-based light modulators. In one aspect, the invention relates to a direct-view display that includes an array of pixels formed on a transparent substrate and a control matrix for controlling the array of pixels. Each of pixels in the array of pixels includes a MEMS-based light modulator with first and second opposing actuators for controlling the state of the light-modulator. Suitable MEMS-based light modulators include shutter-based light modulators and light-tap based modulators. The control matrix includes a number of features for each pixel. For each pixel, the control matrix includes a write-enabling switch for enabling the pixel to respond to a data voltage and a data switch for selectively controlling actuation of one or both of the opposing actuators in the pixel. In addition, for each pixel, the control matrix includes one and only one data voltage interconnect for setting a desired state of the light modulator to form an image by controlling the data switch. In one embodiment, the same data voltage interconnect is shared among a number of pixels in a column of the array.
- In one embodiment, for each pixel, the control matrix also includes a voltage inverter circuit. The voltage inverter circuit, in various implementations, is a p-mos inverter circuit, an n-mos inverter circuit, and a CMOS inverter circuit. The voltage inverter circuit, in some instances is a level shifting inverter. In other instances, the voltage inverter circuit is a transition sharpening inverter or a switching inverter. In another embodiment, the control matrix includes a cross-coupled inverter for each pixel. The cross-coupled inverter, in one embodiment electrically couples the first and second actuators to one another. In another embodiment, the cross-coupled inverter comprises a level shifting inverter.
- In various embodiments, each pixel includes a flip flop circuit. In one embodiment, the flip flop electrically connects the first and second actuators of the pixel to one another. In another embodiment, the flip flop stores light modulator control instructions. Light modulator instructions, in some embodiments may also be stored by a cross-coupled inverter included in the control matrix for each pixel.
- In one embodiment in which the light modulators are shutter-based, the first and second actuators force the shutters of the light modulators relative to an aperture. The aperture may be formed in a layer of material on the substrate. In an alternative embodiment, the layer of material in which the apertures are formed is a transparent substrate other than the substrate on which the light modulators are formed.
- In another embodiment, the control matrix includes a global actuation interconnect that is electrically connected to pixels in at least two rows and at least two columns of the array of pixels. The global actuation interconnect causes substantially simultaneous actuation of the pixels to which it is connected. In one embodiment, the global actuation interconnect is electrically connected to, and thereby controls, a discharge transistor included in each pixel of the array.
- In still another embodiment, the control matrix includes a first voltage actuation interconnect. The first voltage actuation interconnect is distinct from the data voltage interconnect and is electrically connected to the first actuator. The first actuation voltage interconnect provides a voltage sufficient to actuate the first actuator. In another embodiment, the control matrix includes another switch, other than the data switch for regulating the application of the voltage provided via the first actuation voltage interconnect, for each pixel in the array. The data switch, in certain embodiments, is a transistor that selectively controls the discharge of the voltage provided by the first actuation voltage interconnect. Each pixel may also have be electrically connected to a common voltage interconnect in the control matrix that provides a bias voltage to the pixels to which it is connected.
- In a further embodiment, the control matrix includes a second actuation voltage interconnect. The second actuation voltage interconnect is distinct from both the data voltage interconnect and the first actuation voltage interconnect. The second actuation voltage interconnect provides a voltage sufficient to actuate the second actuators of the pixels to which it is connected. In one embodiment, the application of the voltage provided by the second actuation voltage interconnect to the second actuator of a pixel is controlled by the pixel's data switch. In another embodiment, the second actuation voltage interconnect directly connects a display drive to the second actuators of pixels in the array. In some embodiments, the voltage provided by the second actuation voltage interconnect is insufficient to actuate the second actuator if a voltage greater than a maintenance voltage is applied to the first actuator.
- In another embodiment, the control matrix include an actuation voltage interconnect that is directly electrically connected to one of the actuators of pixels in multiple rows and in multiple columns of the array of pixels. The actuation voltage interconnect provides a voltage sufficient to actuate the actuators to which it is connecting barring an opposing voltage being applied to the actuators that oppose the actuators to which the shared actuation voltage interconnect connects.
- According to another aspect, the invention relates to a direct-view display apparatus that includes voltage regulators that substantially limits variation in a voltage applied across the actuators in the display that would otherwise be caused by movement of portions of the actuators. In one embodiment, voltage variation is considered substantially limited if, during actuation of an actuator, the voltage across the actuator varies less than 20% from the voltage needed to initiate actuation of the actuator. In other embodiments, voltage variation is considered substantially limited if, during actuation of an actuator, the voltage across the actuator varies less than 10% from the voltage needed to initiate actuation of the actuator. In still another other embodiments, voltage variation is considered substantially limited if, during actuation of an actuator, the voltage across the actuator varies less than 5% from the voltage needed to initiate actuation of the actuator.
- The direct-view display apparatus includes an array of pixels formed on a transparent substrate. Each pixel includes a MEMS-based light modulator. Suitable MEMS-based light modulators include shutter-based light modulators, light-tap based light modulators, and electrowetting-based light modulators. The MEMS-based light modulators include at least one electrostatic actuator for changing the state of the light modulator.
- The direct-view display apparatus also includes a control matrix. The control matrix is connected to the substrate and includes, for each pixel, a write-enabling interconnect, a data voltage interconnect, and a data switch. The write-enable interconnect of a pixel enables the pixel to respond to a data voltage applied via the data voltage interconnect. The data switch of a pixel electrically connects to a corresponding data voltage interconnect. Voltages applied to the pixel's data voltage interconnect thereby control the state of the pixel's light modulator.
- In one embodiment, the voltage regulators are display drivers that include DC voltage sources. The display drivers are connected to light modulators in the array by actuation voltage interconnects that are distinct from the data voltage interconnects. In some embodiments, the actuation voltage interconnect electrically connects directly to pixel actuators. In other embodiments, the actuation voltage interconnect electrically connects to pixel actuators through a switch, other than the data switch, included in the control matrix for each pixel. In one embodiment, the actuation voltage interconnect provides a substantially constant voltage throughout operation of the display. In other embodiments, the voltage on the actuation voltage interconnect varies during operation as a result of variation in display driver output.
- In another embodiment, each pixel includes its own voltage regulator. In one particular embodiment, the voltage regulator is a capacitor in electrical communication with the electrostatic actuator.
- In a third aspect, the invention relates to a direct-view display apparatus that includes an array of MEMS-based light modulators formed on a transparent substrate. The display apparatus includes a control matrix formed on the substrate. The control matrix includes a CMOS circuit for each pixel in the display.
- In a fourth aspect, the invention relates to a direct-view display apparatus that includes a bank-wise addressing feature. The display apparatus includes a transparent substrate, upon which an array of light modulators are formed. Suitable light modulators include, without limitation, shutter-based light modulators, electrowetting-based light modulators, and light-tap based light modulators. The array is organized into rows and columns. The rows are divided into at least two sets of rows. Each row in a set of rows is associated with a corresponding row in another set of rows. The associated rows are collectively referred to as a “group of associated rows.” For each pixel in the array, the light modulators include an actuator for controlling the state of the light modulator.
- The display apparatus also includes a control matrix connected to the substrate and the light modulators. For each group of associated rows in the array, the control matrix includes an electrical connection shared among the pixels of the group of associated rows that enables the group of associated rows to be actuated to an addressed state at substantially the same time. These electrical connections allow each group of associated rows to be actuated at a different times. In one embodiment, the control matrix includes, for each column in the array, a single write enable switch and a single data store capacitor per set of rows. In another embodiment, the display apparatus includes, for each group of associated rows, a second distinct electrical connection shared among the pixels of the associated rows. This second electrical connection provides an actuation voltage to the light modulators in the pixels to reset the pixels to an initial state. In still another embodiment, the display apparatus includes a charge interconnect that connects to pixels in multiple rows and in multiple columns. This charge interconnect provides an actuation voltage to the actuators in the pixels to drive the light modulators into the addressed state.
- The foregoing discussion will be understood more readily from the following detailed description of the invention with reference to the following drawings:
-
FIG. 1A is an isometric view of display apparatus, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 1B is a block diagram of the a display apparatus, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 2 is an isometric view of a shutter assembly suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIGS. 3A and 3B are isometric views of a dual-actuated shutter assembly suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 4A is a top view of an array of shutter assemblies suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 4B is a cross sectional view of an illustrative non-shutter-based light modulator suitable for inclusion in various embodiments of the invention; -
FIG. 4C is a cross sectional view of a second illustrative non-shutter-based light modulator suitable for inclusion in various embodiments of the invention; -
FIG. 5A is a conceptual diagram of a control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 5B is an isometric view of an array of pixels incorporating the control matrix ofFIG. 5A and the shutter assemblies ofFIG. 2 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 6 is a diagram of a second control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 7 is a diagram of a third control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 8 is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix ofFIG. 7 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 9 is a diagram of a fourth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 10 is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix ofFIG. 9 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 11 is a diagram of a fifth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 12 is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix ofFIG. 11 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 13 is a diagram of a sixth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 14 is a diagram of a seventh control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 15 is a diagram of an eighth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 16A is a diagram of a ninth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 16B is a diagram of a tenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 16C is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix ofFIG. 16B , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 17 is a diagram of an eleventh control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 18 is a diagram of a twelfth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 19 is a diagram of a thirteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention -
FIG. 20 is a diagram of a fourteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 21 is a diagram of a fifteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 22 is a diagram of a sixteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 23 is a diagram of a seventeenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 24 is a diagram of an eighteenth control matrix suitable for controlling the shutter assemblies of the display apparatus ofFIG. 1 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 25 is a flow chart of a method of addressing the pixels of the control matrix ofFIG. 24 , according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 26 is a schematic diagram of yet another suitable control matrix for inclusion in the display apparatus, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; -
FIG. 27 is a schematic diagram of another control matrix suitable for inclusion in the display apparatus, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention; and -
FIG. 28 includes three charts of voltage variations across portions of MEMS actuators that may result during actuation, according to various embodiments of the invention. - To provide an overall understanding of the invention, certain illustrative embodiments will now be described, including apparatus and methods for displaying images. However, it will be understood by one of ordinary skill in the art that the systems and methods described herein may be adapted and modified as is appropriate for the application being addressed and that the systems and methods described herein may be employed in other suitable applications, and that such other additions and modifications will not depart from the scope hereof.
-
FIG. 1A is an isometric view of adisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention. Thedisplay apparatus 100 includes a plurality of light modulators, in particular, a plurality of shutter assemblies 102 a-102 d (generally “shutter assemblies 102”) arranged in rows and columns. In thedisplay apparatus 100,shutter assemblies Shutter assemblies display apparatus 100 can be utilized to form animage 104 for a projection or backlit display, if illuminated bylamp 105. In another implementation theapparatus 100 may form an image by reflection of ambient light originating from the front of the apparatus. Preferably, thedisplay apparatus 100 is a direct-view display in which light modulated by the shutter assemblies 102 is introduced through a backlight and is directed to a viewer without projection onto an intervening screen. - In the
display apparatus 100, each shutter assembly 102 corresponds to apixel 106 in theimage 104. In other implementations, thedisplay apparatus 100 may utilize a plurality of shutter assemblies to form apixel 106 in theimage 104. For example, thedisplay apparatus 100 may include three color-specific shutter assemblies 102. By selectively opening one or more of the color-specific shutter assemblies 102 corresponding to aparticular pixel 106, thedisplay apparatus 100 can generate acolor pixel 106 in theimage 104. In another example, thedisplay apparatus 100 includes two or more shutter assemblies 102 perpixel 106 to provide grayscale in animage 104. With respect to an image, a “pixel” corresponds to the smallest picture element defined by the resolution of image. With respect to structural components of thedisplay apparatus 100, the term “pixel” refers to the combined mechanical and electrical components utilized to modulate the light that forms a single pixel of the image. - Each shutter assembly 102 includes a
shutter 108 and anaperture 109. To illuminate apixel 106 in theimage 104, theshutter 108 is positioned such that it allows light to pass through theaperture 109 towards a viewer. To keep apixel 106 unlit, theshutter 108 is positioned such that it obstructs the passage of light through theaperture 109. Theaperture 109 is defined by an opening patterned through a reflective or light-absorbing material in each shutter assembly 102. - The display apparatus also includes a control matrix connected to the substrate and to the shutter assemblies for controlling the movement of the shutters. The control matrix includes a series of electrical interconnects (e.g., interconnects 110, 112, and 114), including at least one write-enable interconnect 110 (also referred to as a “scan-line interconnect”) per row of pixels, one
data interconnect 112 for each column of pixels, and onecommon interconnect 114 providing a common voltage to all pixels, or at least pixels from both multiple columns and multiples rows in thedisplay apparatus 100. In response to the application of an appropriate voltage (the “write-enabling voltage, Vwe”), the write-enableinterconnect 110 for a given row of pixels prepares the pixels in the row to accept new shutter movement instructions. The data interconnects 112 communicate the new movement instructions in the form of data voltage pulses. The data voltage pulses applied to the data interconnects 112, in some implementations, directly contribute to an electrostatic movement of the shutters. In other implementations, the data voltage pulses control switches (also referred to as “data switches”), e.g., transistors or other non-linear circuit elements that control the application of separate actuation voltages, which are typically higher in magnitude than the data voltages, to the shutter assemblies 102. The application of these actuation voltages then results in the electrostatic movement of theshutters 108. -
FIG. 1B is a block diagram 150 of thedisplay apparatus 100. In addition to the elements of thedisplay apparatus 100 described above, as depicted in the block diagram 150, thedisplay apparatus 100 includes a plurality of scan drivers 152 (also referred to as “write enabling voltage sources”) and a plurality of data drivers 154 (also referred to as “data voltage sources”). Thescan drivers 152 apply write enabling voltages to scan-line interconnects 110. Thedata drivers 154 apply data voltages to the data interconnects 112. In some embodiments of the display apparatus, thedata drivers 154 are configured to provide analog data voltages to the shutter assemblies, especially where the gray scale of theimage 104 is to be derived in analog fashion. In analog operation the shutter assemblies 102 are designed such that when a range of intermediate voltages is applied through the data interconnects 112 there results a range of intermediate open states in theshutters 108 and therefore a range of intermediate illumination states or gray scales in theimage 104. - In other cases the
data drivers 154 are configured to apply only a reduced set of 2, 3, or 4 digital voltage levels to the control matrix. These voltage levels are designed to set, in digital fashion, either an open state or a closed state to each of theshutters 108. - The
scan drivers 152 and thedata drivers 154 are connected to digital controller circuit 156 (also referred to as the “controller 156”). The controller includes adisplay interface 158 which processes incoming image signals into a digital image format appropriate to the spatial addressing and the gray scale capabilities of the display. The pixel location and gray scale data of each image is stored in aframe buffer 159 so that the data can be fed out as needed to thedata drivers 154. The data is sent to thedata drivers 154 in mostly serial fashion, organized in predetermined sequences grouped by rows and by image frames. Thedata drivers 154 can include series to parallel data converters, level shifting, and for some applications digital to analog voltage converters. - All of the drivers (e.g., scan
drivers 152,data drivers 154,actuation driver 153 and global actuation driver 155) for different display functions are time-synchronized by a timing-control 160 in thecontroller 156. Timing commands coordinate the illumination of red, green and blue lamps 162, 164, and 166 vialamp drivers 168, the write-enabling and sequencing of specific rows of the array of pixels, the output of voltages from thedata drivers 154, and for the output of voltages that provide for shutter actuation. - The
controller 156 determines the sequencing or addressing scheme by which each of theshutters 108 in the array can be re-set to the illumination levels appropriate to anew image 104. New images can 104 be set at periodic intervals. For instance, for video displays, thecolor images 104 or frames of the video are refreshed at frequencies ranging from 10 to 300 Hertz. In some embodiments the setting of an image frame is synchronized with the illumination of a backlight such that alternate image frames are illuminated with an alternating series of colors, such as red, green, and blue. The image frames for each respective color is referred to as a color sub-frame. In this method, referred to as the field sequential color method, if the color sub-frames are alternated at frequencies in excess of 20 Hz, the human brain will average the alternating frame images into the perception of an image having a broad and continuous range of colors. - If the
display apparatus 100 is designed for the digital switching ofshutters 108 between open and closed states, thecontroller 156 can control the addressing sequence and/or the time intervals between image frames to produceimages 104 with appropriate gray scale. The process of generating varying levels of grayscale by controlling the amount of time ashutter 108 is open in a particular frame is referred to as time division gray scale. In one embodiment of time division gray scale, thecontroller 156 determines the time period or the fraction of time within each frame that ashutter 108 is allowed to remain in the open state, according to the illumination level or gray scale desired of that pixel. In another embodiment of time division gray scale, the frame time is split into, for instance, 15 equal time-duration sub-frames according to the illumination levels appropriate to a 4-bit binary gray scale. Thecontroller 156 then sets a distinct image into each of the 15 sub-frames. The brighter pixels of the image are left in the open state for most or all of the 15 sub-frames, and the darker pixels are set in the open state for only a fraction of the sub-frames. In another embodiment of time-division gray scale, thecontroller circuit 156 alters the duration of a series of sub-frames in proportion to the bit-level significance of a coded gray scale word representing an illumination value. That is, the time durations of the sub-frames can be varied according to thebinary series shutters 108 for each pixel are then set to either the open or closed state in a particular sub-frame according to the bit value at a corresponding position within the binary word for its intended gray level. - A number of hybrid techniques are available for forming gray scale which combine the time division techniques described above with the use of either
multiple shutters 108 per pixel or via the independent control of backlight intensity. These techniques are described further below. - Addressing the control matrix, i.e., supplying control information to the array of pixels, is, in one implementation, accomplished by a sequential addressing of individual lines, sometimes referred to as the scan lines or rows of the matrix. By applying Vwe to the write-enable
interconnect 110 for a given scan line and selectively applying data voltage pulses Vd to the data interconnects 112 for each column, the control matrix can control the movement of eachshutter 108 in the write-enabled row. By repeating these steps for each row of pixels in thedisplay apparatus 100, the control matrix can complete the set of movement instructions to each pixel in thedisplay apparatus 100. - In one alternative implementation, the control matrix applies Vwe to the write-enable
interconnects 110 of multiple rows of pixels simultaneously, for example, to take advantage of similarities between movement instructions for pixels in different rows of pixels, thereby decreasing the amount of time needed to provide movement instructions to all pixels in thedisplay apparatus 100. In another alternative implementation, the rows are addressed in a non-sequential, e.g., in a pseudo-randomized order, in order to minimize visual artifacts that are sometimes produced, especially in conjunction with the use of a coded time division gray scale. - In alternative embodiments, the array of pixels and the control matrices that control the pixels incorporated into the array may be arranged in configurations other than rectangular rows and columns. For example, the pixels can be arranged in hexagonal arrays or curvilinear rows and columns. In general, as used herein, the term scan-line shall refer to any plurality of pixels that share a write-enabling interconnect.
-
FIG. 2 is diagram of anillustrative shutter assembly 200 suitable for incorporation into thedisplay apparatus 100 ofFIG. 1 . Theshutter assembly 200 includes ashutter 202 coupled to anactuator 204. Theactuator 204 is formed from two separate compliantelectrode beam actuators 205, as described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035, filed on Oct. 14, 2005. Theshutter 202 couples on one side to theactuators 205. Theactuators 205 move the shutter transversely over a surface in a plane of motion which is substantially parallel to the surface. The opposite side of the shutter couples to aspring 207 which provides a restoring force opposing the forces exerted by theactuator 204. - Each
actuator 205 includes acompliant load beam 206 connecting theshutter 202 to aload anchor 208. The load anchors 208 along with the compliant load beams 206 serve as mechanical supports, keeping theshutter 202 suspended proximate to the surface. The surface includes one ormore apertures 211 for admitting the passage of light. The load anchors 208 physically connect the compliant load beams 206 and theshutter 202 to the surface and electrically connect the load beams 206 to a bias voltage, in some instances, ground. - Each
actuator 204 also includes acompliant drive beam 216 positioned adjacent to eachload beam 206. The drive beams 216 couple at one end to adrive beam anchor 218 shared between the drive beams 216. The other end of eachdrive beam 216 is free to move. Eachdrive beam 216 is curved such that it is closest to theload beam 206 near the free end of thedrive beam 216 and the anchored end of theload beam 206. - In operation, a display apparatus incorporating the
shutter assembly 200 applies an electric potential to the drive beams 216 via thedrive beam anchor 218. A second electric potential may be applied to the load beams 206. The resulting potential difference between the drive beams 216 and the load beams 206 pulls the free ends of the drive beams 216 towards the anchored ends of the load beams 206, and pulls the shutter ends of the load beams 206 toward the anchored ends of the drive beams 216, thereby driving theshutter 202 transversely towards thedrive anchor 218. Thecompliant members 206 act as springs, such that when the voltage across thebeams shutter 202 back into its initial position, releasing the stress stored in the load beams 206. - A shutter assembly, such as
shutter assembly 200, that incorporates a passive restoring force mechanism is generally referred to herein as an elastic shutter assembly. A number of elastic restoring mechanisms can be built into or in conjunction with electrostatic actuators, the compliant beams illustrated inshutter assembly 200 providing just one example. Elastic shutter assemblies can be constructed such that in an unactivated, or relaxed state, the shutters are either opened or closed. For illustrative purposes, it is assumed below that the elastic shutter assemblies described herein are constructed to be closed in their relaxed state. - As described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035, referred to above, depending on the curvature of the drive beams 216 and
load beams 206, the shutter assembly may either be controlled in a analog or digital fashion. When the beams have a strongly non-linear or divergent curvature (beams diverging with more than a second order curvature) the application of an analog actuation voltage across drive beams 216 and the load beams 206 results in a predetermined incremental displacement of theshutter 202. Thus, the magnitude ofshutter 202 displacement can be varied by applying different magnitude voltages across the drive beams 216 and the load beams 206.Shutter assemblies 200 including more curved beams are therefore used to implement analog gray scale processes. - For shutter assemblies with less curved beams (beams diverging with second order curvature or less), the application of a voltage across the drive beams 216 and the load beams 206 results in shutter displacement if the voltage is greater than a threshold voltage (Vat). Application of a voltage equaling or exceeding Vat results in the maximum shutter displacement. That is, if the
shutter 202 is closed absent the application of a voltage equaling or exceeding the threshold, application of any voltage equaling or exceeding Vat fully opens the shutter. Such shutter assemblies are utilized for implementing time division and/or digital area division gray scale processes in various embodiments of thedisplay apparatus 100. -
FIGS. 3A and 3B are isometric views of asecond shutter assembly 300 suitable for use in thedisplay apparatus 100.FIG. 3A is a view of thesecond shutter assembly 300 in an open state.FIG. 3B is a view of thesecond shutter assembly 300 in a closed state.Shutter assembly 300 is described in further detail in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035, referenced above. In contrast to theshutter assembly 200,shutter assembly 300 includesactuators shutter 306. Eachactuator open actuator 302, serves to open theshutter 306. A second actuator, the shutter-close actuator 304, serves to close theshutter 306. Bothactuators actuators shutter 306 by driving theshutter 306 substantially in a plane parallel to asurface 307 over which the shutter is suspended. Theshutter 306 is suspended over the surface at viaanchors 308 attached to theactuators shutter 306 along its axis of movement reduces out of plane motion of theshutter 306 and confines the motion substantially to the desired plane of motion. Thesurface 307 includes at least oneaperture 309 for admitting the passage of light through thesurface 307. -
FIG. 4A is a top view of anarray 400 ofshutter assemblies 402 suitable for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100. Eachshutter assembly 402 includes ashutter 404, aload beam 406, and two drive beams 408. As with theshutter assemblies shutter assemblies 402 modulate light by transversely driving theircorresponding shutters 404 such that theshutters 404 selectively interfere with light passing through apertures in a surface over which theshutters 404 are driven. - To drive one of the shutters in one of the shutter assemblies, a voltage is applied across the
load beam 406 and one of the drive beams 408. To generate the voltage, a first electric potential is applied to the selected drive beam and a second electric potential is applied to theload beam 406 and to theshutter 404. The first and second electric potentials may be of the same polarity or they may be of opposite polarities. They also may have the same magnitude or they may have different magnitudes. Either potential may also be set to ground. In order for the shutter assembly to actuate (i.e., for the shutter to change its position) the difference between the first and second potentials must equal or exceed an actuation threshold voltage Vat. - In most embodiments, Vat is reached by applying voltages of substantially different magnitudes to the selected drive beam and the load beam. For example, assuming Vat is 40V, the
display apparatus 100 may apply 30V to the drive beam and −10V to the load beam, resulting in a potential difference of 40V. For purposes of controlling power dissipation, however, it is also important to consider and control the absolute voltage applied to each electrode with respect to the ground or package potential of the display. The power required to apply electric potentials to an array of actuators is proportional to the capacitance seen by the voltage source (P=1/2 fCV2), where f is the frequency of the drive signal, V is the voltage of the source and C is the total capacitance seen by the source. The total capacitance has several additive components, including the capacitance that exists between the load beam and drive beam, the source-drain capacitance of transistors along an interconnect line between the voltage source and the actuator (particularly for those transistors whose gates are closed), the capacitance between the interconnect line and its surroundings, including neighboring shutter assemblies and/or crossover lines, and the capacitance between the load or drive beams and their surroundings, including neighboring shutter assemblies or the display package. Since theload beam 406 is electrically coupled to theshutter 404, the capacitance of theload beam 406 includes the capacitance of theshutter 404. Since the shutter comprises typically a large fraction of area of the pixel, the capacitance between the load beam and its surroundings can represent a significant fraction of the total capacitance seen by the voltage source. Furthermore, because of the difference in area of the combinedload beam 406 andshutter 404 and the area of thedrive beam 408 is significant, the capacitance between the load beam and its surroundings is typically much larger than that between the drive beam and its surroundings. As a result, the CV2 power loss experienced by voltage sources connected to either the drive or the load beams will be significantly different even if the range of their voltage excursions were to be the same. For this reason, it is generally advantageous to connect the higher capacitance end of the actuator, i.e., the load beam, to a voltage source that either does not change in voltage significantly with respect to ground or package potential, or to a voltage source that does not change voltage with the highest frequencies required by the drive system. For example, if a 40 volt difference is required between theload beam 406 and thedrive beam 408 to actuate the actuator, it will be advantageous if the voltage difference between the drive beam and the ground or case potential represents at least half if not most of the 40 volts. - The dashed line overlaid on the
shutter assembly array 400 depicts the bounds of asingle pixel 410. Thepixel 410 includes twoshutter assemblies 402, each of which may be independently controlled. By having twoshutter assemblies 402 perpixel 410, a display apparatus incorporating theshutter assembly array 400 can provide three levels of gray scale per pixel using area division gray scale. More particularly, the pixel could be driven into the following states: both shutter assemblies closed; one shutter assembly opened and one shutter assembly closed; or both shutter assemblies open. Thus, the resulting image pixel can be off, at half brightness, or at full brightness. By having eachshutter assembly 402 in thepixel 410 have different sized apertures, a display apparatus could provide yet another level of gray scale using only area division gray scale. Theshutter assemblies FIGS. 2 , 3 and 4A can be made bi-stable. That is, the shutters can exist in at least two equilibrium positions (e.g. open or closed) with little or no power required to hold them in either position. More particularly, theshutter assembly 300 can be mechanically bi-stable. Once the shutter of theshutter assembly 300 is set in position, no electrical energy or holding voltage is required to maintain that position. The mechanical stresses on the physical elements of theshutter assembly 300 can hold the shutter in place. - The
shutter assemblies spring 207 inshutter assembly 200, or the opposing force may be exerted by an opposing actuator. The minimum voltage needed to maintain a shutter's position against such an opposing force is referred to as a maintenance voltage Vm. - Electrical bi-stability arises from the fact that the electrostatic force across an actuator is a strong function of position as well as voltage. The beams of the actuators in the
shutter assemblies - In shutter assemblies, such as 300, that provide for two separately controllable actuators (for the purpose of opening and closing the shutter respectively), the equilibrium position of the shutter will be determined by the combined effect of the voltage differences across each of the actuators. In other words, the electrical potentials of all three terminals (the shutter open drive beam, the shutter close drive beam, and the shutter/load beams), as well as shutter position, must be considered to determine the equilibrium forces on the shutter.
- For an electrically bi-stable system, a set of logic rules can describe the stable states, and can be used to develop reliable addressing or digital control schemes for the shutter. These logic rules are as follows:
- Let Vs be the electrical potential on the shutter or load beam. Let Vo be the electrical potential on the shutter-open drive beam. Let Vc be the electrical potential on the shutter-close drive beam. Let the expression /Vo−Vs/ refer to the absolute value of the voltage difference between the shutter and the shutter-open drive beam. Let Vm be the maintenance voltage. Let Vat be the actuation threshold voltage, i.e., the voltage necessary to actuate an actuator absent the application of Vm to an opposing drive beam. Let Vmax be the maximum allowable potential for Vo and Vc. Let Vm<Vat<Vmax. Then, assuming Vo and Vc remain below Vmax:
- 1. If /Vo−VS/<Vm and /Vc−Vs/<Vm
- Then the shutter will relax to the equilibrium position of its mechanical spring.
- 2. If /Vo−VS/>Vm and /Vc−Vs/>Vm
- Then the shutter will not move, i.e. it will hold in either the open or the closed state, whichever position was established by the last actuation event.
- 3. If /Vo−Vs/>Vat and /Vc−Vs/<Vm
- Then the shutter will move into the open position.
- 4. If No−Vs/<Vm and /Vc−Vs/>Vat
- Then the shutter will move into the closed position.
- Following
rule 1, with voltage differences on each actuator near to zero, the shutter will relax. In many shutter assemblies the mechanically relaxed position is only partially open or closed, and so this voltage condition is preferably avoided in an addressing scheme. - The condition of
rule 2 makes it possible to include a global actuation function into an addressing scheme. By maintaining a shutter voltage which provides beam voltage differences that are at least the maintenance voltage, the absolute values of the shutter open and shutter closed potentials can be altered or switched in the midst of an addressing sequence over wide voltage ranges (even where voltage differences exceed Vat) with no danger of unintentional shutter motion. - The condition of
rules - The maintenance voltage difference, Vm, can be designed or expressed as a certain fraction of the actuation threshold voltage, Vat. For systems designed for a useful degree of bi-stability the maintenance voltage can exist in a range between 20% and 80% of Vat. This helps ensure that charge leakage or parasitic voltage fluctuations in the system do not result in a deviation of a set holding voltage out of its maintenance range—a deviation which could result in the unintentional actuation of a shutter. In some systems an exceptional degree of bi-stability or hysteresis can be provided, with Vm existing over a range of 2% to 98% of Vat. In these systems, however, care must be taken to ensure that an electrode voltage condition of V<Vm can be reliably obtained within the addressing and actuation time available.
- The control matrices described herein are not limited to controlling shutter-based MEMS light modulators, such as the light modulators described above. For example,
FIG. 4B is a cross sectional view of a light tap-basedlight modulator 450, suitable for inclusion in various ones of the control matrices described below. As described further in U.S. Pat. No. 5,771,321, entitled “Micromechanical Optical Switch and Flat Panel Display,” the entirety of which is incorporated herein by reference, a light tap works according to a principle of frustrated total internal reflection. That is, light 452 is introduced into alight guide 454, in which, without interference, light 452 is for the most part unable to escape thelight guide 454 through its front or rear surfaces due to total internal reflection. Thelight tap 450 includes atap element 456 that has a sufficiently high index of refraction that, in response to thetap element 456 contacting thelight guide 454, light 452 impinging on the surface of the light guide adjacent thetap element 456 escapes thelight guide 454 through thetap element 458 towards a viewer, thereby contributing to the formation of an image. - In one embodiment, the
tap element 456 is formed as part ofbeam 458 of flexible, transparent material.Electrodes 460 coat portions one side of thebeam 458. Opposingelectrodes 460 are disposed on acover plate 464 positioned adjacent thelayer 458 on the opposite side of thelight guide 454. By applying a voltage across theelectrodes 460, the position of thetap element 456 relative to thelight guide 454 can be controlled to selectively extract light 452 from thelight guide 454. - The
light tap 450 is only one example of a non-shutter-based MEMS modulator suitable for control by the control matrices described herein. Other forms of non-shutter-based MEMS modulators could likewise be controlled by various ones of the control matrices described herein without departing from the scope of the invention. -
FIG. 4C is a cross sectional view of a second illustrative non-shutter-based light modulator suitable for inclusion in various embodiments of the invention Specifically,FIG. 4C is a cross sectional view of an electrowetting-basedlight modulation array 470. Thelight modulation array 470 includes a plurality of electrowetting-basedlight modulation cells 472 a-472 d (generally “cells 472”) formed on anoptical cavity 474. Thelight modulation array 470 also includes a set ofcolor filters 476 corresponding to thecells 472. - Each
cell 472 includes a layer of water (or other transparent conductive or polar fluid) 478, a layer oflight absorbing oil 480, a transparent electrode 482 (made, for example, from indium-tin oxide) and an insulatinglayer 484 positioned between the layer oflight absorbing oil 480 and thetransparent electrode 482. Illustrative implementation of such cells are described further in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2005/0104804, published May 19, 2005 and entitled “Display Device.” In the embodiment described herein, the electrode takes up a portion of a rear surface of acell 472. - The remainder of the rear surface of a
cell 472 is formed from areflective aperture layer 486 that forms the front surface of theoptical cavity 474. Thereflective aperture layer 486 is formed from a reflective material, such as a reflective metal or a stack of thin films forming a dielectric mirror. For eachcell 472, an aperture is formed in thereflective aperture layer 486 to allow light to pass through. Theelectrode 482 for the cell is deposited in the aperture and over the material forming thereflective aperture layer 486, separated by another dielectric layer. - The remainder of the
optical cavity 474 includes alight guide 488 positioned proximate thereflective aperture layer 486, and a secondreflective layer 490 on a side of thelight guide 488 opposite thereflective aperture layer 486. A series oflight redirectors 491 are formed on the rear surface of the light guide, proximate the second reflective layer. Thelight redirectors 491 may be either diffuse or specular reflectors. One of morelight sources 492 inject light 494 into thelight guide 488. - In an alternative implementation, an additional transparent substrate is positioned between the
light guide 490 and thelight modulation array 470. In this implementation, thereflective aperture layer 486 is formed on the additional transparent substrate instead of on the surface of thelight guide 490. - In operation, application of a voltage to the
electrode 482 of a cell (for example, cell 472 b or 472 c) causes thelight absorbing oil 480 in the cell to collect in one portion of thecell 472. As a result, thelight absorbing oil 480 no longer obstructs the passage of light through the aperture formed in the reflective aperture layer 486 (see, for example, cells 472 b and 472 c). Light escaping the backlight at the aperture is then able to escape through the cell and through a corresponding color (for example, red, green, or blue) filter in the set ofcolor filters 476 to form a color pixel in an image. When theelectrode 482 is grounded, thelight absorbing oil 480 covers the aperture in thereflective aperture layer 486, absorbing any light 494 attempting to pass through it. - The area under which
oil 480 collects when a voltage is applied to thecell 472 constitutes wasted space in relation to forming an image. This area cannot pass light through, whether a voltage is applied or not, and therefore, without the inclusion of the reflective portions ofreflective apertures layer 486, would absorb light that otherwise could be used to contribute to the formation of an image. However, with the inclusion of thereflective aperture layer 486, this light, which otherwise would have been absorbed, is reflected back into thelight guide 490 for future escape through a different aperture. -
FIG. 5A is a conceptual diagram of acontrol matrix 500 suitable for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100 for addressing an array of pixels.FIG. 5B is an isometric view of a portion of an array of pixels including thecontrol matrix 500. Eachpixel 501 includes anelastic shutter assembly 502, such asshutter assembly 200, controlled by anactuator 503. - The
control matrix 500 is fabricated as a diffused or thin-film-deposited electrical circuit on the surface of asubstrate 504 on which theshutter assemblies 502 are formed. Thecontrol matrix 500 includes a scan-line interconnect 506 for each row ofpixels 501 in thecontrol matrix 500 and a data-interconnect 508 for each column ofpixels 501 in thecontrol matrix 500. Each scan-line interconnect 506 electrically connects a write-enablingvoltage source 507 to thepixels 501 in a corresponding row ofpixels 501. Eachdata interconnect 508 electrically connects an data voltage source, (“Vd source”) 509 to thepixels 501 in a corresponding column of pixels. Incontrol matrix 500, the data voltage Vd provides the majority of the energy necessary for actuation. Thus, thedata voltage source 509 also serves as an actuation voltage source. - For each
pixel 501 or for each shutter assembly in the array, thecontrol matrix 500 includes atransistor 510 and acapacitor 512. The gate of each transistor is electrically connected to the scan-line interconnect 506 of the row in the array in which thepixel 501 is located. The source of eachtransistor 510 is electrically connected to itscorresponding data interconnect 508. Theshutter assembly 502 includes an actuator with two electrodes. The two electrodes have significantly different capacitances with respect to the surroundings. The transistor connects thedata interconnect 508 to the actuator electrode having the lower capacitance. More particularly the drain of eachtransistor 510 is electrically connected in parallel to one electrode of thecorresponding capacitor 512 and to the lower capacitance electrode of the actuator. The two electrodes of the actuator in theshutter assembly 502 have significantly different capacitances. The drain of thetransistor 510 electrically connects to the electrode having the lower capacitance. The other electrode of thecapacitor 512 and the higher capacitance electrode of the actuator inshutter assembly 502 are connected to a common or ground potential. In alternate implementations, thepixel 501 forgoes acapacitor 512 which is distinct from theshutter assembly 502 and instead relies on the capacitance inherent in theshutter assembly 502 in thepixel 501 to store the voltage needed to achieve and maintain theshutter assembly 502 state. - In operation, to form an image, the
control matrix 500 write-enables each row in the array in sequence by applying Vwe to each scan-line interconnect 506 in turn. For a write-enabled row, the application of Vwe to the gates of thetransistors 510 of thepixels 501 in the row allows the flow of current through the data interconnects 508 through the transistors to apply a potential to the actuator of theshutter assembly 502. While the row is write-enabled, data voltages Vd are selectively applied to the data interconnects 508. In implementations providing analog gray scale, the data voltage applied to eachdata interconnect 508 is varied in relation to the desired brightness of thepixel 501 located at the intersection of the write-enabled scan-line interconnect 506 and thedata interconnect 508. In implementations providing digital control schemes, the data voltage is selected to be either a relatively low magnitude voltage (i.e., a voltage near ground) or to meet or exceed Vat (the actuation threshold voltage). In response to the application of Vat to adata interconnect 508, the actuator in thecorresponding shutter assembly 502 actuates, opening the shutter in thatshutter assembly 502. The voltage applied to thedata interconnect 508 remains stored in thecapacitor 512 of the pixel even after thecontrol matrix 500 ceases to apply Vwe to a row. It is not necessary, therefore, to wait and hold the voltage Vwe on a row for times long enough for theshutter assembly 502 to actuate; such actuation can proceed after the write-enabling voltage has been removed from the row. The voltage in thecapacitors 510 in a row remain substantially stored until an entire video frame is written, and in some implementations until new data is written to the row. - The
control matrix 500 can be manufactured through use of the following sequence of processing steps: - First an
aperture layer 550 is formed on asubstrate 504. If thesubstrate 504 is opaque, such as silicon, then thesubstrate 504 serves as theaperture layer 550, andaperture holes 554 are formed in thesubstrate 504 by etching an array of holes through thesubstrate 504. If thesubstrate 504 is transparent, such as glass, then theaperture layer 550 may be formed from the deposition of a light blocking layer on thesubstrate 504 and etching of the light blocking layer into an array of holes. The aperture holes 554 can be generally circular, elliptical, polygonal, serpentine, or irregular in shape. As described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/218,690, filed on Sep. 2, 2005, if the light blocking layer is also made of a reflective material, such as a metal, then theaperture layer 550 can act as a mirror surface which recycles non-transmitted light back into an attached backlight for increased optical efficiency. Reflective metal films appropriate for providing light recycling can be formed by a number of vapor deposition techniques including sputtering, evaporation, ion plating, laser ablation, or chemical vapor deposition. Metals that are effective for this reflective application include, without limitation, Al, Cr, Au, Ag, Cu, Ni, Ta, Ti, Nd, Nb, Si, Mo and/or alloys thereof. Thicknesses in the range of 30 nm to 1000 nm are sufficient. - Second, an intermetal dielectric layer is deposited in blanket fashion over the top of the
aperture layer metal 550. - Third, a first conducting layer is deposited and patterned on the substrate. This conductive layer can be patterned into the conductive traces of the scan-
line interconnect 506. Any of the metals listed above, or conducting oxides such as indium tin oxide, can have sufficiently low resistivity for this application. A portion of thescan line interconnect 506 in each pixel is positioned to so as to form the gate of atransistor 510. - Fourth, another intermetal dielectric layer is deposited in blanket fashion over the top of the first layer of conductive interconnects, including that portion that forms the gate of the
transistor 510. Intermetal dielectrics sufficient for this purpose include SiO2, Si3N4, and Al2O3 with thicknesses in the range of 30 nm to 1000 nm. - Fifth, a layer of amorphous silicon is deposited on top of the intermetal dielectric and then patterned to form the source, drain and channel regions of a thin film transistor active layer. Alternatively this semiconducting material can be polycrystalline silicon.
- Sixth, a second conducting layer is deposited and patterned on top of the amorphous silicon. This conductive layer can be patterned into the conductive traces of the
data interconnect 508. The same metals and/or conducting oxides can be used as listed above. Portions of the second conducting layer can also be used to form contacts to the source and drain regions of thetransistor 510. - Capacitor structures such as
capacitor 512 can be built as plates formed in the first and second conducting layers with the intervening dielectric material. - Seventh, a passivating dielectric is deposited over the top of the second conducting layer.
- Eighth, a sacrificial mechanical layer is deposited over the top of the passivation layer. Vias are opened into both the sacrificial layer and the passivation layer such that subsequent MEMS shutter layers can make electrical contact and mechanical attachment to the conducting layers below.
- Ninth, a MEMS shutter layer is deposited and patterned on top of the sacrificial layer. The MEMS shutter layer is patterned with
shutters 502 as well asactuators 503 and is anchored to thesubstrate 504 through vias that are patterned into the sacrificial layer. The pattern of theshutter 502 is aligned to the pattern of the aperture holes 554 that were formed in thefirst aperture layer 550. The MEMS shutter layer may be composed of a deposited metal, such as Au, Cr or Ni, or a deposited semiconductor, such as polycrystalline silicon or amorphous silicon, with thicknesses in the range of 300 nanometers to 10 microns. - Tenth, the sacrificial layer is removed such that components of the MEMS shutter layer become free to move in response to voltages that are applied across the
actuators 503. - Eleventh, the sidewalls of the
actuator 503 electrodes are coated with a dielectric material to prevent shorting between electrodes with opposing voltages. - Many variations on the above process are possible. For instance the
reflective aperture layer 550 ofstep 1 can be combined into the first conducting layer. Gaps are patterned into this conducting layer to provide for electrically conductive traces within the layer, while most of the pixel area remains covered with a reflective metal. In another embodiment, thetransistor 510 source and drain terminals can be placed on the first conducting layer while the gate terminals are formed in the second conducting layer. In another embodiment the semiconducting amorphous or polycrystalline silicon is placed directly below each of the first and second conducting layers. In this embodiment vias can be patterned into the intermetal dielectric so that metal contacts can be made to the underlying semiconducting layer. - In an alternative implementation, the
shutter assembly 502, along with thecontrol matrix 500, can be fabricated on a separate substrate from the one on which theaperture layer 550 is formed. In such an implementation, the substrate on which thecontrol matrix 500 andshutter assembly 500 are formed is aligned with thesubstrate 504 on which theaperture layer 550 is formed such that the shutters align with their corresponding aperture holes 554. -
FIG. 6 is a diagram of asecond control matrix 600 suitable for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100 for addressing an array ofpixels 602. Thepixels 602 in thecontrol matrix 600 forgo the use of a transistor and capacitor, as are included incontrol matrix 500, in favor of a metal-insulator-metal (“MIM”)diode 604. Thecontrol matrix 600 includes a scan-line interconnect 606 for each row ofpixels 602 in thecontrol matrix 600 and adata interconnect 607 for each column of pixels in thecontrol matrix 600. Each scan-line interconnect 606 electrically connects to one terminal of theMIM diode 604 of eachpixel 602 in its corresponding row ofpixels 602. The other terminal of theMIM diode 604 in apixel 602 electrically connects to one of the two electrodes of ashutter assembly 608, such asshutter assembly 200, in thepixel 602. - In operation the
MIM diode 604 acts as a non-linear switch element which prevents current from flowing to the shutter assembly 609 unless the voltage presented between thescan line interconnect 606 and thedata line interconnect 607 exceeds a threshold voltage Vdiode. Therefore, if voltage pulses provided by thedata line interconnect 607 do not exceed Vdiode, such data pulses will not effect that actuation ofshutter assemblies 608 connected along the data line. If, however, a write-enabling voltage Vwe, is applied to ascan line interconnect 606 such that a voltage difference in excess of Vdiode appears between thescan line interconnect 606 and any of the several data line interconnects 607 that cross thescan line interconnect 606, then the shutters at the intersection of the that scanline interconnect 606 and those data line interconnects 607 will receive their charge and can be actuated. In implementations providing analog gray scale, the data voltage applied to eachdata interconnect 607 is varied in relation to the desired brightness of thepixel 602 located at the intersection of the write-enabled scan-line interconnect 606 and thedata interconnect 607. In implementations providing a digital control schemes, the data voltage is selected to be either close to Vwe (i.e., such that little or no current flows through the diode 604) or high enough such that Vwe-−Vdiode will meet or exceed Vat (the actuation threshold voltage). - In other implementations the
MIM diode 604 can be placed between theshutter assembly 608 and thedata line interconnect 607. The method of operation is the same as described above. In other implementations, two MIM diodes are employed, each connected to a separate and adjacent scan line. One electrode of the shutter assembly is connected to each of the MIM diodes on the side opposite of their respective scan lines such that the voltage appearing on the shutter electrode is almost ½ of the voltage difference between the two scan lines. In this fashion it is easier to fix the potential of one of the electrodes of the actuator to a known zero or common potential. - The two electrodes of the
shutter assembly 608 in thepixel 602 have significantly different capacitances with respect to the ground or case potential. Of these two electrodes, the higher capacitance electrode is preferably connected to the scan line interconnect 606 (optionally, as shown, with a diode connected betweenshutter 608 and the scan line interconnect 606), since the scan line typically requires smaller voltage changes (with respect to ground) than are typically required of thedata line interconnect 607. Thedata interconnect 607 electrically connects to the lower-capacitance electrode of theshutter assembly 608. -
FIG. 7 is a diagram of athird control matrix 700 for controllingpixels 702 incorporatingshutter assemblies 703 with both open and close actuators, such asshutter assemblies control matrix 700 includes scan-line interconnect 704 per row ofpixels 702 in thecontrol matrix 700 and twodata interconnects pixels 702 in thecontrol matrix 700. One of the data interconnects is a shutter-open interconnect 706 a and the other data interconnect is a shutter-close interconnect 706 b. - For a given
pixel 702 in thecontrol matrix 700, thepixel 702 includes two transistor-capacitor pairs, one pair for each data-interconnect pixel 702 electrically couple to the scan-line interconnect 704 corresponding to the row of thecontrol matrix 700 in which thepixel 702 is located. The source of one of the transistors, the shutter-open transistor 708 a, electrically connects to the shutter-open data-interconnect 706 a of the column in which thepixel 702 is located. The drain of the shutter-open transistor 708 a electrically connects, in parallel, to one electrode of one of the capacitors, the shutter-open capacitor 710 a, and to one electrode of the shutter-open actuator of theshutter assembly 703 of the pixel. The other electrode of the shutter-open capacitor 710 a electrically connects to ground or to a bias interconnect set to a common voltage among thepixels 702. - Similarly, the source of the other transistor in the
pixel 702, the shutter-close transistor 708 b, electrically connects to the shutter-close data interconnect 706 b of the column in which thepixel 702 is located. The drain of the shutter-close transistor 708 b electrically connects, in parallel, to the other of the capacitors in the pixel, the shutter-close capacitor 710 b, and to one of the electrodes of the shutter-close actuator of theshutter assembly 703. - Both the shutter-open actuator and the shutter-close actuator of the
shutter assembly 703 include two electrodes. One electrode in each actuator has a significantly higher capacitance than the other. The drains of the shutter-open and the shutter-close transistors electrically connect to the lower-capacitance electrodes of their corresponding actuators. The ground or bias interconnect, if any, electrically connects to the higher-capacitance electrode. - The control matrix of
FIG. 7 employs n-channel transistors. Other embodiments are possible that employ p-channel MOS transistors. In other implementations, thetransistors capacitors - In the case where multiple shutters are to be actuated within each pixel, a separate pair of shutter-open data interconnects and shutter-closed data interconnects, along with associated transistors and capacitors, can be provided for each shutter within the pixel.
-
FIG. 8 is flow chart of a method 800 of addressing thepixels 702 controlled by thecontrol matrix 700 ofFIG. 7 to form an image frame. The steps carried out to address a single image frame are referred to collectively as a “frame addressing cycle.” The method begins by write-enabling the first scan line in the display (step 802). To do so, thecontrol matrix 700 applies Vwe, (e.g., +45V for nMOS transistors or −45V for pMOS transistors), to thescan line interconnect 704 in thecontrol matrix 700 corresponding to the first row in the control matrix and grounds the other scan-line interconnects 704. - The
control matrix 700 then writes data to eachpixel 702 in the write-enabled scan line (decision block 804 to step 812). The data corresponds to the desired states of theshutter assemblies 703 in thosepixels 702. For ease of understanding, the data writing process (decision block 804 to step 812) is described below in relation to asingle pixel 702 in a selected column in the write-enabled scan line. At the same time data is written to thissingle pixel 702, thecontrol matrix 700 also writes data in the same fashion to the remainingpixels 702 in the write-enabled scan line. - To write data to a
pixel 702 at the intersection of a selected column of thecontrol matrix 700 and the write-enabled scan line first, atdecision block 804, it is determined if theshutter assembly 703 in question is to be open in the next image frame or closed. If theshutter assembly 703 is to be open, thecontrol matrix 700 applies a data voltage, Vd, to the shutter-open interconnect 706 a of the selected column (step 806). Vd is selected to raise the voltage across the electrodes of the shutter-open actuator in theshutter assembly 703 to equal or exceed the voltage necessary for actuation, Vat. At about the same time that thecontrol matrix 700 applies Vd to the shutter-open interconnect 706 a of the selected column (step 806), thecontrol matrix 700 grounds the shutter-close interconnect 706 b of the column (step 808). - If, at
decision block 804, it is determined that theshutter assembly 703 is to be closed, thecontrol matrix 700 applies the data voltage Vd to the shutter-close interconnect 706 b (step 810) and grounds the shutter-open interconnect 706 a of the column (step 812). Once the voltage across the electrodes of the desired actuator builds up to Vat, the actuator, if not previously in the desired position, actuates (step 814), moving the shutter in theshutter assembly 703 to the desired position. - After the data is written to the
pixels 702 in the scan line in steps 806-812, thecontrol matrix 700 grounds the scan-line interconnect 704 (step 814) and write-enables the next scan line (step 816). The process repeats until allpixels 702 in thecontrol matrix 700 are addressed. In one implementation, before addressing the first scan line in thecontrol matrix 700, a backlight to which the control matrix is affixed is turned off. Then, after all scan lines in thecontrol matrix 700 have been addressed, the backlight is turned back on. Synchronizing the switching of the backlight off and on with the beginning and end of a period during which a frame is addressed improves the color purity of the resultant image since then the backlight is on only when all pixels are already set to their correct image state. - An actuation event is determined by noting the voltage differences that appear across the shutter-open actuator and the shutter closed actuator. For consistent actuation, generally one of these voltage differences will be kept close to zero, or at least below a certain maintenance voltage Vm, while the absolute value of the other voltage difference will exceed the actuation voltage. Consistent with the actuation conditions described with respect to
FIGS. 2 , 3, and 4A, the polarities of applied voltages, such as Vd, can be either negative or positive, and the voltage applied to the common potential (indicated as “ground” inFIG. 7 or at step 812), can be any voltage either positive or negative. - In some implementations, it is advantageous to periodically or occasionally reverse the sign of the voltages that appear across the actuators of
shutter assembly 703 without otherwise altering the method 800 of addressing the pixels. In one case, polarity reversal can be accomplished by maintaining the common electrode of allshutters 703 at a potential close to zero while reversing the polarity of the data voltage, Vd. In another case polarity reversal can be accomplished by setting the common voltage to Vcommon, where Vcommon is equal to or greater than Vat, and then providing a voltage source such that the data voltage either alternates between Vcommon and 2*Vat or between zero and Vcommon. - Similar advantageous use of polarity reversals and the use of non-zero common voltages can be applied to the
control matrices - The flow chart of method 800 is drawn for the case where only digital information is written into an image frame, i.e. where the shutters are intended to be either open or closed. A similar method of image frame addressing can be employed for the provision of gray scale images built upon loading analog data through data interconnects 706 a and 706 b. In this case, intermediate voltages are intended to produce only partial openings of the
shutters 703. The voltages applied across the shutter-open actuators will tend to move the shutters in directions opposite to the motion induced by voltages across the shutter-closed actuators. There will exist, however, pairs of complementary voltages that, when applied simultaneously across these two actuators, will result in controlled and pre-determined states of partial shutter opening. - The complementary nature of the voltages supplied to either the shutter-
open interconnect 706 a or the shutter-closedinterconnect 706 b can be used to advantage if the voltage source electronics are also designed with capability for charge recycling. Taking as an example method 800, which is designed for the loading of digital information to the image frame: voltages loaded into the interconnects atsteps 806 or 810 are complementary. That is, if Vd is loaded into one of the interconnects, then the other interconnect is usually grounded. Changing the state of the shutter assembly 703 (e.g. from closed to open) is conceptually, then, a matter of transferring the charge stored on one actuator over to its opposing actuator. If the energy lost on each of these transitions is Q*Vd, where Q is the charge stored on an actuator, then considerable power savings can be derived if the stored charge is not simply dissipated as waste energy in the voltage source electronics at each transition but is instead recycled for use on the other actuator. While complete charge recycling is difficult, methods for partial recycling are available. For example, the frame addressing method 800 can provide a step where the data line interconnects 706 a and 706 b are shorted together within the voltage source electronics for a brief period betweensteps -
FIG. 9 is anotherillustrative control matrix 900 suitable for addressing an array of pixels indisplay device 100. Thecontrol matrix 900 is similar to thecontrol matrix 700. That is, thecontrol matrix 900 includes a scan-line interconnect 904 for each row of pixels in thecontrol matrix 900 and two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 906 a and a shutter-close interconnect 906 b, for each column ofpixels 902 in the control matrix. In addition, each pixel in thecontrol matrix 900 includes a shutter open-transistor (or optionally a diode or varistor) 908 a, a shutter-close transistor (or optionally a diode or varistor) 908 b, a shutter-open capacitor 910 a, a shutter-close actuator 910 b, and ashutter assembly 912. The shutter assembly is either mechanically and/or electrically bi-stable. Thecontrol matrix 900, however, includes an additional controllable interconnect, aglobal actuation interconnect 914. Theglobal actuation interconnect 914 substantially simultaneously provides about the same voltage (a “common voltage”) topixels 902 in at least two rows and two columns of thecontrol matrix 900. In one implementation, theglobal actuation interconnect 914 provides a common voltage to allpixels 902 in thecontrol matrix 900. The higher capacitance electrode of the actuators of theshutter assemblies 912 in eachpixel 902 in thecontrol matrix 900 electrically connect to theglobal actuation interconnect 914 instead of to ground. - The inclusion of the
global actuation interconnect 914 enables the near simultaneous actuation ofpixels 902 in multiple rows of thecontrol matrix 900. As a result, all actuators that actuate to set a given image frame (e.g., all shutters that move) can be actuated at the same time, as opposed to a row by row actuation method as described in method 800. The use of a global actuation process temporally decouples the writing of data to apixel 902 from the actuation theshutter assembly 912 in thepixel 902. - The global actuation feature incorporated into the
control matrix 900 takes advantage of the bi-stability of theshutter assemblies 912 in thecontrol matrix 900. Actuating an electrically bi-stable shutter assembly requires that two conditions be satisfied simultaneously, that the absolute value of voltage across one electrode exceeds Vat, while the absolute value of the voltage across the other electrode is less than a maintenance voltage Vm. Thus, forcontrol matrix 900, when a voltage in excess of Vm is applied to one actuator of ashutter assembly 912, applying Vat to the opposing shutter assembly is insufficient to cause the actuator to actuate. - For example, assume that the shutter-open actuator of an electrically bi-stable shutter assembly has a Vat of 40V. At the same time, the application of 10V maintenance voltage across the electrodes of the shutter-close actuator may keep the shutter of the shutter assembly in a closed position even when 60V is applied across the electrodes of the shutter-open actuator. If a −10V bias potential is applied between the higher-capacitance electrodes of all shutter assemblies and ground via the global common interconnect, while the ground potential is applied to one of the actuation electrodes, then a data voltage of +40V can be applied to the lower-capacitance electrodes of selected actuators in the shutter assemblies, thereby yielding a +50V potential difference across those actuators, without causing the actuators to actuate. Then, by grounding the global common interconnect, the voltage across the electrodes of the selected actuators is reduced to +40V while the voltage across the opposing actuator is removed. As +40V still equals the actuation voltage of the actuator and no maintenance voltage is keeping the opposing actuator in position, the selected actuators all move in concert. Another example is described in further detail below in relation to
FIG. 10 . -
FIG. 10 is flow chart of a method 1000 of addressing an image frame using thecontrol matrix 900 ofFIG. 9 . The method begins by setting the globalcommon interconnect 914 to a maintenance voltage Vm, e.g., ½ Vat (step 1001) with respect to ground. Then, thecontrol matrix 900 write-enables the first scan line in the display (step 1002). To do so, thecontrol matrix 900 applies Vwe, e.g., +45V, to a first scan-line interconnect 904 in thecontrol matrix 900 and grounds the other scan-line interconnects 904. - The
control matrix 900 then writes data to eachpixel 902 in the write-enabled scan line corresponding to the desired states of those pixels in the next image frame (decision block 1004 to step 1012). The data writing process is described below in relation to asingle pixel 902 in a selected column in the write-enabled scan line. At the same time that data is written to thissingle pixel 902, thecontrol matrix 900 also writes data in the same fashion to the remainingpixels 902 in the write-enabled scan line. - To write data to a
pixel 902, atdecision block 1004, it is determined if the shutter of theshutter assembly 912 in thepixel 902 is to be in the open position in the next image frame or in the closed position. If the shutter is to be in the open position, thecontrol matrix 900 applies a data voltage, Vd, to the shutter-open interconnect of the selected column (step 1006). Vd is selected such that before the application of a global actuation voltage, Vag, to the globalcommon interconnect 914, the voltage across the shutter-open actuator in thepixel 902 remains insufficient to overcome the bias applied to the shutter-close actuator, but such that after the application of Vag to the globalcommon interconnect 914, the voltage across the electrodes of the shutter-open actuator is sufficient for the shutter-open actuator to actuate. For example, if Vat equals 40V, Vm equals 20V, and Vag equals ground, then Vd is selected to be greater than or equal to 40V, but less than the potential that would overcome Vm. At the same time that thecontrol matrix 900 applies Vd to the shutter-open interconnect 906 a of the selected column (step 1006), thecontrol matrix 900 grounds the shutter-close interconnect 906 b of the column (step 1008). - If at
decision block 1004, it is determined that the shutter is to be in the off position, thecontrol matrix 900 applies the data voltage Vd to the shutter-close interconnect 906 b (step 1010) and grounds the shutter-open interconnect 906 a of the column (step 1012). - After the
control matrix 900 writes data to thepixels 902 in the write-enabled scan line in steps 1006-1012, thecontrol matrix 900 grounds the currently write-enabled scan-line interconnect 904 (step 1014) and write-enables the next scan line (step 1016). The process repeats until allpixels 902 in thecontrol matrix 900 are addressed (see decision block 1015). After all pixels in thecontrol matrix 900 are addressed (see decision block 1015), thecontrol matrix 900 applies the global common voltage Vag to the global common interconnect (step 1018), thereby resulting in a near simultaneous global actuation of theshutter assemblies 912 in thecontrol matrix 900. Thus, for such implementations, the global common interconnect serves as a global actuation interconnect. - As with the method 800, the method 1000 may also include the synchronization of a backlight with shutter actuation. However, by using the global actuation process described above, the backlight can be kept on for a larger percentage of the time a display is in operation, therefore yielding a brighter display for the same level of driving power in a backlight. In one embodiment, a backlight is synchronized such that it is off when ever the shutters in one row of a control matrix are set for one image frame while shutters in other rows of the control matrix are set for a different image frame. In control matrices that do not employ global actuation, for every frame of video, the backlight is turned off during the entire data writing process (approximately 500 microseconds to 5 milliseconds), as each row of pixels actuates as it is addressed. In contrast, in control matrices using global actuation, the backlight can remain on while the data writing process takes place because no pixels change state until after all the data has been written. The backlight is only turned off (if at all), during the much shorter time beginning after the last scan line is written to, and ending a sufficient time after the global actuation voltage is applied for the pixels to have changed states (approximately 10 microseconds to 500 microseconds).
- An actuation event in the method 1000 is determined by noting the voltage differences that appear across the shutter-open actuator and the shutter closed actuator. Consistent with the actuation conditions described with respect to
FIGS. 2 , 3, and 4A, the polarities of applied voltages, such as Vd, can be either negative or positive, and the voltage applied to the global common interconnect can be any voltage either positive or negative. - In other implementations it is possible to apply the method 1000 of
FIG. 10 to a selected portion of a whole array of pixels, since it may be advantageous to update different areas or groupings of rows and columns in series. In this case a number of different global actuation interconnects 914 could be routed to selected portions of the array for selectively updating and actuating different portions of the array. - In some implementations it is advantageous to periodically or occasionally reverse the sign of the voltages that appear across the actuators of
shutter assembly 912 without otherwise altering the method 1000 of addressing the pixels. In one such case polarity reversal can be accomplished by reversing the signs of most of the potentials employed in Method 1000, with the exception of the write-enable voltage. In another cases voltages similar to those used in Method 1000 can be applied but with a complementary logic. Table 1 shows the differences between the nominal voltage assignments as described above for method 1000 and the voltages which could be applied in order to achieve polarity reversal on the electrodes of the shutter assemblies. In the first case, calledPolarity Reversal Method 1, the voltages which appear across actuator electrodes are merely reversed in sign. Instead of applying Vd to the shutter-open electrode, for instance, −Vd would be applied. For the case where nMOS transistors are employed for thetransistors -
TABLE 1 Polarity Polarity Action: Reversal Reveral “Close the Shutter” Method 1000 Method 1Method 2Non-Enabled Row Voltage ground −Vd ground Write-Enable Voltage Vwe −Vd + Vwe Vwe Voltage on shutter-closed Vd −Vd ground interconnect Voltage on shutter-open ground ground Vd interconnect Maintenance Voltage Vm −Vm Vm Global Actuation Voltage Vag −Vag Vd (near ground) (near ground) - Table 1 also shows a second method,
Polarity Reversal Method 2, which allows the use of similar voltages (without having to reverse signs on any interconnect drivers), but still achieves polarity reversal across all actuators. This is accomplished by driving the global actuation interconnect to the higher voltage, Vd, instead of toward ground as in Method 1000 in order to move selected shutters. The sequence of voltage changes inPolarity Reversal Method 2 is similar to that of Method 1000, except that a complementary logic is now employed atstep 1004 when assigning voltages to the actuators of each pixel. In thisMethod 2, if the shutter is to be closed, then the shutter-open interconnect would be brought up to the potential Vd, while the shutter-closed interconnect would be grounded. In this example, after the global actuation interconnect is brought from its maintenance potential Vm up to the actuation potential Vd, the potential across the shutter-open actuator would be near to zero (certainly less than Vm), while the potential across the shutter-closed actuator would be −Vd, sufficient to actuate the shutter to the closed position and with a polarity that is the reverse of what was applied in Method 1000. Similarly if, atstep 1004, the shutter is to be opened then the shutter-closed interconnect would be brought up to the potential Vd while the shutter-open interconnect is grounded. - The
control matrix 900 can alternate between the voltages used in Method 1000 and that used with the above Polarity Reversal Methods in every frame or on some other periodic basis. Over time, the net potentials applied across the actuators onshutter assemblies 1408 by thecharge interconnect 1406 and theglobal actuation interconnect 1416 average out to about 0V. - Actuation methods, similar to method 1000, can also be applied to single-sided or elastic shutter assemblies, such as with
shutter assemblies 502 incontrol matrix 500. Such single-sided applications will be illustrated in conjunction withFIG. 14 below. -
FIG. 11 is a diagram of anothercontrol matrix 1100 suitable for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100. As withcontrol matrices control matrix 1100 includes a series of scan-line interconnects 1104, with one scan-line interconnect 1104 corresponding to each row ofpixels 1102 in thecontrol matrix 1100. Thecontrol matrix 1100 includes asingle data interconnect 1106 for each column ofpixels 1102 in the control matrix. As such, thecontrol matrix 1100 is suitable for controllingelastic shutter assemblies 1108, such asshutter assembly 200. As with actuator inshutter assembly 200, the actuators in theshutter assemblies 1108 in thecontrol matrix 1100 have one higher-capacitance electrode and one lower-capacitance electrode. - In addition to the scan-line and data-
interconnects control matrix 1100 includes a charge interconnect 1110 (also labeled as V(at)) and a charge trigger interconnect 1112 (also labeled as C-T). The charge interconnect 11100 and thecharge trigger interconnect 1112 may be shared among allpixels 1102 in thecontrol matrix 1100, or some subset thereof. For example, each column ofpixels 1100 may share acommon charge interconnect 1110 and a commoncharge trigger interconnect 1112. The following description assumes the incorporation of a globally sharedcharge interconnect 1110 and a globally commoncharge trigger interconnect 1112. - Each
pixel 1102 in thecontrol matrix 1100 includes two transistors, a chargetrigger switch transistor 1114 and adischarge switch transistor 1116. The gate of the chargetrigger switch transistor 1114 is electrically connected to thecharge trigger interconnect 1112 of thecontrol matrix 1100. The drain of the chargetrigger switch transistor 1114 is electrically connected to thecharge interconnect 1110. Thecharge interconnect 1110 receives a DC voltage sufficient to actuate the actuators of theshutter assembly 1108 in eachpixel 1102, absent the application of any bias voltage to thescan line interconnect 1104. The source of the chargetrigger switch transistor 1114 is electrically connected to the lower capacitance electrode of the actuator in theshutter assembly 1108 in thepixel 1102 and to the drain of thedischarge switch transistor 1116. The gate of thedischarge switch transistor 1116 is electrically connected to thedata interconnect 1106 of the column of thecontrol matrix 1100 in which thepixel 1102 is located. The source of thedischarge switch transistor 1116 is electrically connected to the scan-line interconnect 1104 of the row of thecontrol matrix 1100 in which thepixel 1102 is located. The higher-capacitance electrode of the actuator in theshutter assembly 1108 is also electrically connected to the scan-line interconnect 1104 of row corresponding to the pixel. Alternately, the higher capacitance electrode can be connected to a separate ground or common electrode. -
FIG. 12 is a flow chart of a method 1200 of addressing the pixels incorporated into a control matrix, such ascontrol matrix 1100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention. At the beginning of a frame addressing cycle,control matrix 1100 actuates all unactuated actuators of theshutter assemblies 1108 incorporated into thecontrol matrix 1100, such that allshutter assemblies 1108 are set to the same position (open or closed) (steps 1202-1204). To do so, thecontrol matrix 1100 applies a charge trigger voltage, e.g., 45V, to thecharge trigger interconnect 1112, activating the chargetrigger switch transistors 1114 of the pixels (step 1202). The electrodes of the actuators incorporated into theshutter assemblies 1108 of thepixels 1108 serve as capacitors for storing the voltage Vat supplied over thecharge interconnect 1110, e.g., 40V. Thecontrol matrix 1100 continues to apply the charge trigger voltage (step 1202) for a period of time sufficient for all actuators to actuate, and then thecontrol matrix 1100 grounds the charge trigger switch transistor 1114 (step 1204). Thecontrol matrix 1100 applies a bias voltage Vb, e.g., 10V with respect to ground, to all scan-line interconnects 1104 in the control matrix 1100 (step 1206). - The
control matrix 1100 then proceeds with the addressing of eachpixel 1102 in the control matrix, one row at a time (steps 1208-1212). To address a particular row, thecontrol matrix 1100 write-enables a first scan line by grounding the corresponding scan-line interconnect 1104 (step 1208). Then, atdecision block 1210, thecontrol matrix 1100 determines for eachpixel 1102 in the write-enabled row whether thepixel 1102 needs to be switched out of its initial frame position. For example, if atstep 1202, all shutters are opened, then atdecision block 1210, it is determined whether eachpixel 1102 in the write-enabled row is to be closed. If apixel 1102 is to be closed, thecontrol matrix 1100 applies a data voltage, for example 5V, to thedata interconnect 1106 corresponding to the column in which thatpixel 1102 is located (step 1212). As the scan-line interconnect 1104 for the write-enabled row is grounded (step 1208), the application of the data voltage Vd to thedata interconnect 1106 of the column results in a potential difference between the gate and the source of thedischarge switch transistor 1116 of the correct sign and magnitude to open the channel of thetransistor 1116. Once the channel oftransistor 1116 is opened the charge stored in the shutter assembly actuator can be discharged to ground through thescan line interconnect 1104. As the voltage stored in the actuator of theshutter assembly 1108 dissipates, the restoring force or spring in theshutter assembly 1108 forces the shutter into its relaxed position, closing the shutter. If atdecision block 1210, it is determined that no state change is necessary for apixel 1102, the correspondingdata interconnect 1106 is grounded. Although the relaxed position in this example is defined as the shutter-closed position, alternative shutter assemblies can be provided in which the relaxed state is a shutter-open position. In these alternative cases, the application of data voltage Vd, atstep 1212, would result in the opening of the shutter. - In other implementations it is possible to apply the method 1200 of
FIG. 12 to a selected portion of the whole array of pixels, since it may be advantageous to update different areas or groupings of rows and columns in series. In this case a number of differentcharge trigger interconnects 1112 could be routed to selected portions of the array for selectively updating and actuating different portions of the array. - As described above, to address the
pixels 1102 in thecontrol matrix 1100, the data voltage Vd can be significantly less than the actuation voltage Vat (e.g., 5V vs. 40V). Since the actuation voltage Vat is applied once a frame, whereas the data voltage Vd may be applied to eachdata interconnect 1106 as may times per frame as there are rows in thecontrol matrix 1100, control matrices such ascontrol matrix 1100 may save a substantial amount of power in comparison to control matrices which require a data voltage to be high enough to also serve as the actuation voltage. - For
pixels 1102 in non-write-enabled rows, the bias voltage Vb applied to their corresponding scan-line interconnects 1104 keeps the potential at theirdischarge transistor 1116 sources greater than the potentials at theirdischarge transistor 1116 gate terminals, even when a data voltage Vd is applied to thedata interconnect 1106 of their corresponding columns. It will be understood that the embodiment ofFIG. 11 assumes the use of n-channel MOS transistors. Other embodiments are possible that employ p-channel transistors, in which case the relative signs of the bias potentials Vb and Vd would be reversed. - In other embodiments the
discharge switch transistor 1116 can be replaced by a set of two or more transistors, for instance if thecontrol matrix 1100 were to be built using standard CMOS technology the discharge switch transistor could be comprised of a complementary pair of nMOS and pMOS transistors. - The method 1200 assumes digital information is written into an image frame, i.e. where the shutters are intended to be either open or closed. Using the circuit of
control matrix 1100, however, it is also possible to write analog information into theshutter assemblies 1108. In this case, the grounding of the scan line interconnects is provided for only a short and fixed amount of time and only partial voltages are applied through the data line interconnects 1106. The application of partial voltages to thedischarge switch transistor 1116, when operated in a linear amplification mode, allows for only the partial discharge of the electrode of theshutter assembly 1108 and therefore a partial opening of the shutter. - The
control matrix 1100 selectively applies the data voltage to the remaining columns of thecontrol matrix 1100 at the same time. After all pixels have achieved their intended states (step 1214), thecontrol matrix 1100 reapplies Vb to the selected scan-line interconnect and selects a subsequent scan-line interconnect (step 1216). After all scan-lines have been addressed, the process begins again. As with the previously described control matrices, the activity of an attached backlight can be synchronized with the addressing of each frame. -
FIG. 13 is a diagram of anothercontrol matrix 1300 suitable for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention. Thecontrol matrix 1300 is similar tocontrol matrix 1100, thoughpixels 1302 in thecontrol matrix 1300 includecharge diodes 1304 as opposed to chargetrigger switch transistors 1114, and thecontrol matrix 1300 lacks acharge trigger interconnect 1112. More particularly, thecontrol matrix 1300 includes onedata interconnect 1306 for each column in thecontrol matrix 1300 and one scan-line interconnect 1308 for each row in thecontrol matrix 1300, and adischarge transistor 1309. - The
control matrix 1300 also includes a charge interconnect 1310 (also labeled as V(at)) similar to that incorporated intocontrol matrix 1100. - The
control matrix 1300 includes a actuation voltage source electrically connected to thecharge interconnect 1310. The actuation voltage source supplies pulses of voltage at the beginning of each frame addressing cycle, allowing current to flow into theshutter assemblies 1314 of thepixels 1302 in thecontrol matrix 1300 and thereby actuating any unactuated actuators in theshutter assemblies 1314. As a result, after the voltage pulse, all of thepixels 1302 in thecontrol matrix 1300 are in the same state, open or closed. After the voltage pulse, when the potential of thecharge interconnect 1310 has been reset to zero, thecharge diode 1304 prevents the voltage stored in theshutter assemblies 1314 to be dissipated via thecharge interconnect 1310. Thecontrol matrix 1300 can be controlled using a method similar to the pixel addressing method 1200. Instead of applying a voltage to thecharge trigger interconnect 1112 atstep 1202, the actuation voltage source supplies a voltage pulse having duration and magnitude sufficient to open any closed shutter assemblies. - It is preferable that the higher-capacitance electrode of
shutter assemblies transistor 1114 or throughdiode 1304 to the charge interconnects 1112 or 1310. The voltage changes driven onto the shutter electrodes through the charge interconnects will generally be higher in magnitude than those experienced through the scan line interconnects. -
FIG. 14 is a diagram of acontrol matrix 1400 suitable for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100. Thecontrol matrix 1400 includes the components ofcontrol matrix 1300, i.e., scan-line interconnects 1402, data-interconnects 1404, and acharge interconnect 1406. Thepixels 1408 in thecontrol matrix 1400 include acharge diode 1410, ashutter assembly 1412, and dischargetransistor 1414.Control matrix 1400 also includes aglobal actuation interconnect 1416 for providing global actuation of thepixels 1408 in thecontrol matrix 1400, using a method similar to that described in relation toFIGS. 9 and 10 . The control matrix also includes anoptional capacitor 1418, which is connected in parallel with the source and drain of thedischarge transistor 1414. The capacitor helps maintain a stable voltage at one electrode ofshutter assembly 1412 despite voltage changes which might be applied on the other electrode through theglobal actuation interconnect 1416 Theinterconnect 1416 is shared amongpixels 1408 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. - The global actuation interconnect, if used in a mode similar to
polarity reversal method 2 of Table 1, may be employed to ensure a 0V DC average mode of operation in addition to providing an actuation threshold voltage. To achieve 0V DC averaging, the control matrix alternates between control logics. In the first control logic, similar to that employed in the pixel addressing method 1000 and 1200, at the beginning of a frame addressing cycle, thecontrol matrix 1400 opens theshutter assemblies 1412 of all pixels in thecontrol matrix 1400 by storing Vat across the electrodes of theshutter assembly 1412 actuator. Thecontrol matrix 1400 then applies a bias voltage to lock theshutter assemblies 1412 in the open state.Control matrix 1400 applies a bias voltage, e.g., ½ Vat, which is greater than Vm, via theglobal actuation interconnect 1416. Then, to change the state of ashutter assembly 1412, when the row ofpixels 1408 in which theshutter assembly 1412 is located is write-enabled, thecontrol matrix 1400 discharges the stored Vat in theshutter assembly 1412. The maintenance voltage keeps theshutter assembly 1412 open until theglobal actuation interconnect 1416 is grounded. - In the second control logic, which is similar to the
polarity reversal method 2 of Table 1, instead of the control matrix changing the voltage applied to theglobal actuation interconnect 1416 from ½ Vat to ground, the control matrix changes the voltage applied to theglobal actuation interconnect 1416 from ½ Vat to Vat. Thus, to release a shutter in ashutter assembly 1412 to its relaxed state, the voltage applied via thecharge diode 1410 must be maintained, as opposed to discharged. Therefore, in the second control logic, thecontrol matrix 1400 discharges the stored Vat from shutter assemblies that are to remain open, as opposed to those that are closed. Thecontrol matrix 1400 can alternate between the control logics every frame or on some other periodic basis. Over time, the net potentials applied across the actuators of theshutter assemblies 1408 by thecharge interconnect 1406 and theglobal actuation interconnect 1416 average out to 0V. -
FIG. 15 is a diagram of still anothersuitable control matrix 1500 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention. Thecontrol matrix 1500 is similar to thecontrol matrix 1100 ofFIG. 11 .Control matrix 1500 includes adata interconnect 1502 for each column ofpixels 1504 in thecontrol matrix 1500 and a scan-line interconnect 1506 for each row ofpixels 1504 in thecontrol matrix 1500. Thecontrol matrix 1500 includes a commoncharge trigger interconnect 1508 and acommon charge interconnect 1510. Thepixels 1504 in thecontrol matrix 1500 each include anelastic shutter assembly 1511, a chargetrigger switch transistor 1512 and adischarge switch transistor 1514, as described inFIG. 11 .Control matrix 1500 also incorporates aglobal actuation interconnect 1516 and its corresponding functionality described inFIG. 9 in relation to controlmatrix 900.Control matrix 1500 also incorporates an optionalvoltage stabilizing capacitor 1517 which is connected in parallel with the source and drain ofdischarge switch transistor 1514. - Each
pixel 1504 ofcontrol matrix 1500, also includes a third transistor, a write-enabletransistor 1518, and adata store capacitor 1520. The scan-line interconnect 1506 for a row ofpixels 1504 connects to the gates of the write-enabletransistor 1518 incorporated into eachpixel 1504 in the row. The data interconnects 1502 for the columns of thecontrol matrix 1500 electrically connect to the source terminals of the write-enabletransistors 1518 of thepixels 1504 in the column. The drain of the write-enabletransistors 1518 in eachpixel 1504 electrically connect in parallel to thedata store capacitor 1520 and the gate terminal of thedischarge trigger transistor 1514 of therespective pixels 1504. - The operation of the
control matrix 1500 includes elements in common with each of the methods 1000 and 1200. At the beginning of an frame addressing cycle, a voltage is applied to thecharge trigger interconnect 1508 and thecharge interconnect 1510 of thecontrol matrix 1500 to build up a potential, Vat, on oneshutter assembly 1511 actuator electrode of eachpixel 1504 in thecontrol matrix 1500 to open anyclosed shutter assemblies 1511. These steps are similar to those performed insteps FIG. 12 . Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, except instead of performing the write-enable as a grounding of corresponding scan-line interconnects as was done with respect toFIGS. 11 , 13, and 14, thecontrol matrix 1500 applies a write-enabling voltage Vwe to the scan-line interconnect 1506 corresponding to each row. While a particular row ofpixels 1504 is write-enabled, thecontrol matrix 1500 applies a data voltage to eachdata interconnect 1508 of thecontrol matrix 1500 corresponding to a column that incorporates apixel 1502 in the write-enabled row that is to be closed. The application of Vwe to the scan-line interconnect 1506 for the write-enabled row turns on the write-enabletransistors 1518 of thepixels 1504 in the corresponding scan line. The voltages applied to the data interconnects 1502 are thereby allowed to be stored on thedata store capacitors 1520 of therespective pixels 1504. - If the voltage stored on the
data store capacitor 1520 of apixel 1504 is sufficiently greater than ground, e.g., 5V, thedischarge switch transistor 1514 is activated, allowing the charge applied to thecorresponding shutter assembly 1511 via the chargetrigger switch transistor 1514 to discharge. The discharge of the larger voltage, Vat, stored in theshutter assembly 1511, however, can take more time than is needed to store the relatively small data voltage on thedata store capacitor 1520. By storing the data voltage on thedata store capacitor 1520, the discharge and the mechanical actuation process can continue even after thecontrol matrix 1500 grounds the scan-line interconnect 1506, thereby isolating the charge stored on thecapacitor 1520 from its correspondingdata interconnect 1502. In contrast to the discharge process presented by the control matrices inFIGS. 11 , 13, and 14, therefore, thecontrol matrix 1500 regulates the discharge switch 1514 (for controlling application of the actuation voltage Vat on shutter assembly 1511) by means of data voltage which is stored on thecapacitor 1520, instead of requiring real time communication with signals on thedata interconnect 1502. - In alternative implementations, the
storage capacitor 1520 and write-enabletransistor 1518 can be replaced with alternative data memory circuits, such as a DRAM or SRAM circuits known in the art. - In contrast to the circuits shown in
FIGS. 11 , 13, and 14, the charge on the electrodes ofshutter assembly 1511, when discharged, does not flow to ground by means of the scan line interconnect that corresponds topixel 1504. Instead the source of thedischarge switch transistor 1514 is connected to thescan line interconnect 1522 of the pixel in the row below it. When not write-enabled the scan line interconnects 1522 incontrol matrix 1500 are held at or near to the ground potential; they can thereby function as effective sinks for discharge currents in neighboring rows. - The
control matrix 1500 also includes the capability for global actuation, the process or method of which is similar to that described inFIG. 10 . The shutters in dischargedpixels 1504 are kept in position due to the application of a maintenance voltage Vm, e.g., ½ Vat, to theglobal actuation interconnect 1516. After all rows have been addressed, thecontrol matrix 1500 grounds theglobal actuation interconnect 1516, thereby releasing the shutters of all dischargedshutter assemblies 1511 substantially in unison. -
FIG. 16A is a diagram of still anothersuitable control matrix 1600 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention. Thecontrol matrix 1600 is similar to thecontrol matrix 1500 ofFIG. 15 .Control matrix 1600 includes adata interconnect 1602 for each column ofpixels 1604 in thecontrol matrix 1600, a scan-line interconnect 1606 for each row ofpixels 1604 in thecontrol matrix 1600. Thecontrol matrix 1600 includes a commoncharge trigger interconnect 1608, acommon charge interconnect 1610, and aglobal actuation interconnect 1612. Thepixels 1604 in thecontrol matrix 1600 each include anelastic shutter assembly 1614, a chargetrigger switch transistor 1616, adischarge switch transistor 1617, a write-enabletransistor 1618, and adata store capacitor 1620 as described inFIG. 15 . Thecontrol matrix 1600 also includes a shuttercommon interconnect 1622 which is distinct from theglobal actuation interconnect 1612. Theseinterconnects pixels 1604 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. - In operation the
control matrix 1600 performs the same functions as those ofcontrol matrix 1500, but by different means or methods. Most particularly, the method for accomplishing global actuation incontrol matrix 1600 is unique from that performed incontrol matrices control matrix 1600, however, theglobal actuation interconnect 1612 is connected to the source of thedischarge switch transistor 1617. Maintaining theglobal actuation interconnect 1612 at a potential significantly above that of the shuttercommon interconnect 1622 prevents the turn-on of any of thedischarge switch transistors 1617, regardless of what charge is stored oncapacitor 1620. Global actuation incontrol matrix 1600 is achieved by bringing the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 1612 to the same potential as the shuttercommon interconnect 1622, making it possible for those discharge switch transistors 1617 s to turn-on in accordance to the whether a data voltage has been stored oncapacitor 1620 or not.Control matrix 1600, therefore, does not depend on electrical bi-stability in theshutter assembly 1614 in order to achieve global actuation. - Applying partial voltages to the
data store capacitor 1620 allows partial turn-on of thedischarge switch transistor 1617 during the time that theglobal actuation interconnect 1612 is brought to its actuation potential. In this fashion, an analog voltage is created on theshutter assembly 1614, for providing analog gray scale. - In the
control matrix 1600, in contrast to controlmatrix 1500, the higher-capacitance electrode of the actuators in theshutter assemblies 1614 electrically connect to the shuttercommon interconnect 1622, instead of theglobal actuation interconnect 1612. In operation, the control matrix alternates between two control logics as described in relation to controlmatrix 1400 ofFIG. 14 . Forcontrol matrix 1600, however, when the control matrix switches between the control logics, thecontrol matrix 1600 switches the voltage applied to the shuttercommon interconnect 1622 to either ground or Vat, depending on the selected control logic, instead of switching the global actuation voltage applied to the global actuation interconnect, as is done bycontrol matrix 1400. - As in the
control matrix 1300 ofFIG. 13 , a simple diode and/or an MIM diode can be substituted for thecharge trigger transistor 1616 to perform the switching or charge loading function for each pixel in the array. -
FIG. 16B is yet anothersuitable control matrix 1640 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 1640 controls an array ofpixels 1642 that include elastic shutter assemblies. Thecontrol matrix 1640 includes asingle data interconnect 1648 for each column ofpixels 1642 in the control matrix. As such, thecontrol matrix 1640 is suitable for controllingelastic shutter assemblies 1644, such asshutter assembly 200. The actuators in theshutter assemblies 1644 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 1640 includes a scan-line interconnect 1646 for each row ofpixels 1642 in thecontrol matrix 1640. Thecontrol matrix 1640 further includes acharge interconnect 1650, and aglobal actuation interconnect 1654, and a shuttercommon interconnect 1655. Theseinterconnects pixels 1642 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 1642 in thecontrol matrix 1640. - Each
pixel 1642 in the control matrix includes ashutter charge transistor 1656, ashutter discharge transistor 1658, a shutter write-enabletransistor 1657, and adata store capacitor 1659, as described inFIGS. 16A and 19 .Control matrix 1640 also incorporates an optionalvoltage stabilizing capacitor 1652 which is connected in parallel with the source and drain ofdischarge switch transistor 1658. - By comparison to control
matrix 1600, the chargingtransistor 1656 is wired with a different circuit connection to thecharge interconnect 1650.Control matrix 1640 does not include a charge trigger interconnect which is shared among pixels. Instead, the gate terminals of the chargingtransistor 1656 are connected directly to thecharge interconnect 1650, along with the drain terminal oftransistor 1656. In operation, the chargingtransistors 1656 operate essentially as diodes, they can pass a current in only 1 direction. Their function in the charging circuit becomes equivalent to that ofdiode 1410 incontrol circuit 1400 ofFIG. 14 . - At the beginning of each frame addressing cycle the
control matrix 1640 applies a voltage pulse to thecharge interconnect 1650, allowing current to flow through chargingtransistor 1656 and into theshutter assemblies 1644 of thepixels 1642. After this charging pulse, each of the shutter electrodes ofshutter assemblies 1644 will be in the same voltage state. After the voltage pulse, the potential ofcharge interconnect 1650 is reset to zero, and the chargingtransistors 1656 will prevent the charge stored in theshutter assemblies 1644 from being dissipated throughcharge interconnect 1650. Thecharge interconnect 1650, in one implementation, transmits a pulsed voltage equal to or greater than Vat, e.g., 40V. - Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, as was described with respect to control
matrix 1500 ofFIG. 15 . While a particular row ofpixels 1642 is write-enabled, thecontrol matrix 1640 applies a data voltage to thedata interconnect 1648 corresponding to each column ofpixels 1642 in thecontrol matrix 1640. The application of Vwe to the scan-line interconnect 1646 for the write-enabled row turns on the write-enabletransistor 1657 of thepixels 1642 in the corresponding scan line. The voltages applied to thedata interconnect 1648 is thereby caused to be stored on thedata store capacitor 1659 of therespective pixels 1642. - In
control matrix 1640 theglobal actuation interconnect 1654 is connected to the source of the shutterdischarge switch transistor 1658. Maintaining theglobal actuation interconnect 1654 at a potential significantly above that of the shuttercommon interconnect 1655 prevents the turn-on of thedischarge switch transistor 1658, regardless of what charge is stored on thecapacitor 1659. Global actuation incontrol matrix 1640 is achieved by bringing the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 1654 to ground or to substantially the same potential as the shuttercommon interconnect 1655, enabling thedischarge switch transistor 1658 to turn-on in accordance to the whether a data voltage has been stored oncapacitor 1659.Control matrix 1640, therefore, does not depend on electrical bi-stability in theshutter assembly 1644 in order to achieve global actuation. - Applying partial voltages to the
data store capacitor 1659 allows partial turn-on of thedischarge switch transistor 1658 during the time that theglobal actuation interconnect 1654 is brought to its actuation potential. In this fashion, an analog voltage is created on theshutter assembly 1644, for providing analog gray scale. - An alternative method of addressing pixels in
control matrix 1640 is illustrated by themethod 1670 shown inFIG. 16C . Themethod 1670 proceeds in three general steps. First the matrix is addressed row by row by storing data into thedata store capacitors 1659. Next all actuators are actuated (or reset) simultaneously (step 1688) be applying a voltage Vat to thecharge interconnect 1650. And finally the image is set in a global actuation step 1692 by selectively activatingtransistors 1658 by means of theglobal actuation interconnect 1654. - In more detail, the frame addressing cycle of
method 1670 begins when a voltage Voff is applied to the global actuation interconnect 1654 (step 1672). The voltage Voff oninterconnect 1654 is designed to ensure that thedischarge transistor 1658 will not turn on regardless of whether a voltage has been stored oncapacitor 1659. - The
control matrix 1640 then proceeds with the addressing of eachpixel 1642 in the control matrix, one row at a time (steps 1674-1684). To address a particular row, thecontrol matrix 1640 write-enables a first scan line by applying a voltage Vwe to the corresponding scan-line interconnect 1646 (step 1674). Then, at decision block 1676, thecontrol matrix 1640 determines for eachpixel 1642 in the write-enabled row whether thepixel 1642 needs to be open or closed. For example, if at thereset step 1688 all shutters are to be (temporarily) closed, then at decision block 1676 it is determined for eachpixel 1642 in the write-enabled row whether or not the pixel is to be (subsequently) opened. If apixel 1642 is to be opened, thecontrol matrix 1640 applies a data voltage Vd, for example 5V, to thedata interconnect 1648 corresponding to the column in which thatpixel 1642 is located (step 1678). The voltage Vd applied to thedata interconnect 1648 is thereby caused to be stored by means of a charge on thedata store capacitor 1659 of the selected pixel 1642 (step 1679). If at decision block 1676, it is determined that apixel 1642 is to be closed, the correspondingdata interconnect 1648 is grounded (step 1680). Although the relaxed position in this example is defined as the shutter-open position, alternative shutter assemblies can be provided in which the relaxed state is a shutter-closed position. In these alternative cases, the application of data voltage Vd, at step 1678, would result in the closing of the shutter. - The application of Vwe to the scan-
line interconnect 1646 for the write-enabled row turns on all of the write-enabletransistors 1657 for thepixels 1642 in the corresponding scan line. Thecontrol matrix 1640 selectively applies the data voltage to all columns of a given row in thecontrol matrix 1640 at the same time while that row has been write-enabled. After all data has been stored oncapacitors 1659 in the selected row (steps 1679 and 1681), thecontrol matrix 1640 grounds the selected scan-line interconnect (step 1682) and selects a subsequent scan-line interconnect for writing (step 1685). After the information has been stored in the capacitors for all the rows incontrol matrix 1640, thedecision block 1684 is triggered to begin the global actuation sequence. - The actuation sequence begins at
step 1686 ofmethod 1670, with the application of an actuation voltage Vat, e.g. 40 V, to thecharge interconnect 1650. As a consequence ofstep 1686, the voltage Vat is now imposed simultaneously across all the actuators of all theshutter assemblies 1644 incontrol matrix 1640. Thecontrol matrix 1640 continues to apply the voltage Vat (step 1686) for a period of time sufficient for all actuators to actuate into an initial state (step 1688). For the example given inmethod 1670,step 1688 acts to reset and close all actuators. Alternatives to themethod 1670 are possible, however, in which thereset step 1688 acts to open all shutters. At the next step 1690 the control matrix grounds thecharge interconnect 1650. A voltage, at least greater than a maintenance voltage Vm, remains stored across thecapacitor 1652, thereby holding the shutters in position. The electrodes on the actuators inshutter assembly 1644 provide a capacitance which also stores a charge after thecharge interconnect 1650 has been grounded, useful for those embodiments in whichcapacitor 1652 is not included. - After all actuators have been actuated and held in their closed position by voltage in excess of Vm, the data stored in
capacitors 1659 can now be utilized to set an image incontrol matrix 1640 by selectively opening the specified shutter assemblies (steps 1692 and 1694). First, the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 1654 is set to substantially the same potential as the shutter common interconnect 1655 (step 1692). Step 1692 makes it possible for thedischarge switch transistor 1658 to turn-on in accordance to whether a data voltage has been stored oncapacitor 1659. For those pixels in which a voltage has been stored oncapacitor 1659, the charge which was stored on the actuator ofshutter assembly 1644 is now allowed to dissipate through theglobal actuation interconnect 1654. Atstep 1694, therefore, selected shutters are discharged throughtransistor 1658 and allowed to return by means of a restoring force or spring into their relaxed position. For the example given inmethod 1670, a discharge into the relaxed position means that the selectedshutter assemblies 1644 are placed in their open position. For pixels where no voltage was stored oncapacitor 1659, thetransistor 1658 remains closed atstep 1694, no discharge will occur and theshutter assembly 1644 remains closed. - To set an image in a subsequent video frame, the process begins again at step 1672.
- In the
method 1670, all of the shutters are closed simultaneously during the time betweenstep 1688 andstep 1694, a time in which no image information can be presented to the viewer. Themethod 1670, however, is designed to minimize this dead time (or reset time) by making use ofdata store capacitors 1659 andglobal actuation interconnect 1654 to provide timing control over thetransistors 1658. By the action of step 1672, all of the data for a given image frame can be written to thecapacitors 1659 during the addressing sequence (steps 1674-1685), without any immediate actuation effect on the shutter assemblies. Theshutter assemblies 1644 remain locked in the positions they were assigned in the previous image frame until addressing is complete and they are uniformly actuated or reset atstep 1688. The global actuation step 1692 allows the simultaneous transfer of data out of thedata store capacitors 1659 so that all shutter assemblies can be brought into their next addressed image state at the same time. - As with the previously described control matrices, the activity of an attached backlight can be synchronized with the addressing of each frame. To take advantage of the minimal dead time offered in the addressing sequence of
method 1670, a command to turn the illumination off can be given betweenstep 1684 andstep 1686. The illumination can then be turned-on again afterstep 1694. In a field-sequential color scheme, a lamp with one color can be turned off afterstep 1684 while a lamp with either the same or a different color is turned on afterstep 1694. - In other implementations it is possible to apply the
method 1670 ofFIG. 16C to a selected portion of the whole array of pixels, since it may be advantageous to update different areas or groupings of rows and columns in series. In this case a number ofdifferent charge interconnects 1650 andglobal actuation interconnects 1654 could be routed to selected portions of the array for selectively updating and actuating different portions of the array. - As described above, to address the
pixels 1642 in thecontrol matrix 1640, the data voltage Vd can be significantly less than the actuation voltage Vat (e.g., 5V vs. 40V). Since the actuation voltage Vat is applied once a frame, whereas the data voltage Vd may be applied to eachdata interconnect 1648 as may times per frame as there are rows in thecontrol matrix 1640, control matrices such ascontrol matrix 1640 may save a substantial amount of power in comparison to control matrices which require a data voltage to be high enough to also serve as the actuation voltage. - It will be understood that the embodiment of
FIG. 16B assumes the use of n-channel MOS transistors. Other embodiments are possible that employ p-channel transistors, in which case the relative signs of the bias potentials Vat and Vd would be reversed. - The
method 1670 assumes digital information is written into an image frame, i.e. where the shutters are intended to be either open or closed. Using the circuit ofcontrol matrix 1640, however, it is also possible to write analog information into theshutter assemblies 1644. In this case, the grounding of the scan line interconnects is provided for only a short and fixed amount of time and only partial voltages are applied through the data line interconnects 1648. The application of partial voltages to thedischarge switch transistor 1658, when operated in a linear amplification mode, allows for only the partial discharge of the electrode of theshutter assembly 1644 and therefore a partial opening of the shutter. - In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the
shutter assembly 1644, the control matrix alternates between two control logics, as described in relation to controlmatrix 1400 ofFIG. 14 . In the first control logic, atstep 1686 in the addressing cycle, thecontrol matrix 1640 closes theshutter assemblies 1644 of all pixels in thecontrol matrix 1640 by storing Vat across the electrodes of theshutter assembly 1644 actuator. The potential on the shuttercommon interconnect 1655 is held at ground. - In the second control logic, which is similar to the
polarity reversal method 2 of Table 1 described with respect toFIG. 10 , the potential of the shuttercommon interconnect 1655 is set instead to the actuation voltage Vat. Atsteps charge interconnect 1650 is set to Vat, all shutters are instead allowed to relax to their open position. Therefore, in the second control logic, thecontrol matrix 1640 discharges the stored Vat from shutter assemblies that are to be closed, as opposed to those that are to remain open. At step 1692, global actuation is achieved by setting theglobal actuation interconnect 1654 to ground. - The
control matrix 1640 can alternate between the control logics every frame or on some other periodic basis. Over time, the net potentials applied to theshutter assemblies 1644 by thecharge interconnect 1650 and the shuttercommon interconnect 1655 average out to 0V. -
FIG. 17 is still a furthersuitable control matrix 1700 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 1700 controls an array ofpixels 1702 that includeelastic shutter assemblies 1704. Thecontrol matrix 1700 preferably includes shutter assemblies that are not bi-stable, so that theshutter assemblies 1704 are better controlled in an analog fashion. That is, the application of a particular voltage to the actuator of one of theshutter assemblies 1704 results in a known incremental shutter displacement. -
Control matrix 1700 includes one scan-line interconnect 1706 for each row ofpixels 1702 in thecontrol matrix 1700 and onedata interconnect 1708 for each column ofpixels 1702 in thecontrol matrix 1700. Thecontrol matrix 1700 also includes acharge interconnect 1710, acharge trigger interconnect 1712, and adischarge trigger interconnect 1714. Theseinterconnects pixels 1702 in thecontrol matrix 1700. Eachpixel 1702 in thecontrol matrix 1700 includes four transistors, acharge trigger transistor 1716, agrayscale transistor 1718, adischarge transistor 1720, and a write-enabletransistor 1722. The gate of thecharge trigger transistor 1716 electrically connects to thecharge trigger interconnect 1712. Its drain electrically connects to thecharge interconnect 1710, and its source electrically connects to thegrayscale transistor 1718. The gate of thegrayscale transistor 1718 electrically connects, in parallel, to adata store capacitor 1724 and the write-enabletransistor 1722. The source of thegrayscale transistor 1718 electrically connects to thedischarge transistor 1720. The gate of thedischarge transistor 1720 electrically connects to thedischarge interconnect 1714, and its source is grounded. Referring back to the write-enablingtransistor 1722, its gate electrically connects to its corresponding scan-line interconnect 1706, and its drain electrically connects to itscorresponding data interconnect 1708. - The
control matrix 1700 can be utilized to provide analog gray scale to thedisplay apparatus 100. In operation, at the beginning of a frame addressing cycle, thecontrol matrix 1700 applies a voltage to thedischarge trigger interconnect 1714, turning on thedischarge transistor 1720. Any voltage stored in the actuators of theshutter assemblies 1704 in thepixels 1702 is discharged, releasing the shutters in theshutter assemblies 1704 to their rest positions. Thecontrol matrix 1700 then grounds thedischarge trigger interconnect 1714. Subsequently, thecontrol matrix 1700, in sequence applies a write-enabling voltage Vwe to each scan-line interconnect 1706, turning on the write-enablingtransistors 1722 of thepixels 1702 in each corresponding row of thecontrol matrix 1700. As the write-enablingtransistor 1722 for a given row is turned on, thecontrol matrix 1700 applies voltage pulses to each of the data-interconnects 1708 to indicate the desired brightness of eachpixel 1702 in the write-enabled row ofpixels 1702. After the addressing sequence is complete, the control matrix then applies a voltage to thecharge trigger interconnect 1712 which turns on thecharge trigger transistor 1716 so that all electrodes can be charged and all pixels actuated simultaneously. - Brightness of a
pixel 1702 is determined by the duration or the magnitude of the voltage pulse applied to itscorresponding data interconnect 1708. While the voltage pulse is applied to thedata interconnect 1708 of the pixel, current flows through the write-enablingtransistor 1722, building up a potential on thedata store capacitor 1724. The voltage on thecapacitor 1724 is used to control the opening of the conducting channel in thegrayscale transistor 1718. This channel remains open so long as the gate-to-source voltage exceeds a certain threshold voltage. Eventually, during the charging cycle, the potential on the electrode ofshutter assembly 1704 will rise to match the potential stored on thecapacitor 1724, at which point the grayscale transistor will turn off. In this fashion the actuation voltage stored on the shutter assembly can be made to vary in proportion to the analog voltage stored oncapacitor 1724. The resulting electrode voltage causes an incremental displacement of the shutter in theshutter assembly 1704 proportional to the resultant voltage. The shutter remains displaced from its rest position until thedischarge trigger interconnect 1714 is powered again at the end of the frame addressing cycle. - As in the
control matrix 1300 ofFIG. 13 , a simple diode and/or an MIM diode can be substituted for thecharge trigger transistor 1716 to perform the switching or charge loading function for each pixel in the array. -
FIG. 18 is yet anothersuitable control matrix 1800 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 1800 controls an array ofpixels 1802 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 1804 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators). The actuators in theshutter assemblies 1804 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 1800 includes a scan-line interconnect 1806 for each row ofpixels 1802 in thecontrol matrix 1800. Thecontrol matrix 1800 also includes two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 1808 a and a shutter-close interconnect 1808 b, for each column ofpixels 1802 in thecontrol matrix 1800. Thecontrol matrix 1800 further includes acharge interconnect 1810, acharge trigger interconnect 1812, and aglobal actuation interconnect 1814. Theseinterconnects pixels 1802 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 1802 in thecontrol matrix 1800. - Each
pixel 1802 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 1816, a shutter-open discharge transistor 1818, a shutter-close charge transistor 1820, and a shutter-close discharge transistor 1822. The control matrix also incorporates twovoltage stabilizing capacitors 1824, which are connected, one each, in parallel with the source and drain of thedischarge transistors control matrix 1800 applies a maintenance voltage, Vm, e.g., ½ the voltage needed to actuate the shutter assemblies, Vat, to theglobal actuation interconnect 1814. The maintenance voltage locks theshutter assemblies 1804 into their current states until a global actuation is initiated at the end of the frame addressing cycle. Thecontrol matrix 1800 then applies a voltage to thecharge trigger interconnect 1812, turning on the shutter-open and shutter-close transistors pixels 1802 in thecontrol matrix 1800. Thecharge interconnect 1810, in one implementation, carries a DC voltage equal to or greater than Vat, e.g., 40V. - As each row of
pixels 1802 in thecontrol matrix 1800 is addressed, thecontrol matrix 1800 write-enables a row ofpixels 1802 by grounding its corresponding scan-line interconnect 1806. Thecontrol matrix 1800 then applies a data voltage, Vd, e.g., 5V, to either the shutter-open interconnect 1808 a or the shutter-close interconnect 1808 b corresponding to each column ofpixels 1802 in thecontrol matrix 1800. If Vd is applied to the shutter-closedinterconnect 1808 b of a column, the voltage stored on the shutter-close actuator of thecorresponding shutter assembly 1804 is discharged via the shutter-close discharge transistor 1822. Similarly if Vd is applied to the shutter-open interconnect 1808 a of a column, the voltage stored on the shutter-open actuator of thecorresponding shutter assembly 1804 is discharged via the shutter-open discharge transistor 1818. Generally, to ensure proper actuation, only one of the actuators, either the shutter-closed actuator or the shutter-open actuator, is allowed to be discharged for any given shutter assembly in the array. - After all rows of
pixels 1802 are addressed, thecontrol matrix 1800 globally actuates thepixels 1802 by changing the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 1814 from Vm to ground. The change in voltage releases the actuators from their locked in state to switch to their next state, if needed. If the global actuation interconnect were to be replaced with a constant voltage ground or common interconnect, i.e. if the global actuation method is not utilized with thecontrol matrix 1800, then thevoltage stabilizing capacitors 1824 may not be necessary. - As in the
control matrix 1400 ofFIG. 14 , a simple diode and/or an MIM diode can be substituted for both the shutter-open charge transistor 1816 and the shutter-close charge transistor 1820. - Alternatively, it is possible to take advantage of the bi-stable nature of
shutter assembly 1804 and substitute a resistor for both the shutter-open charge transistor 1816 and the shutter-close charge transistor 1820. When operated with a resistor, one relies on the fact that the RC charging time constant associated with the resistor and the capacitance of the actuator in theshutter assembly 1804 can be much greater in magnitude than the time necessary for discharging the actuator through either the shutter-open discharge transistor 1818 or the shutter-close discharge transistor 1822. In the time interval between when the actuator of theshutter assembly 1804 is discharged through one of the discharge transistors and when the actuator is re-charged through the resistor and thecharge interconnect 1810, the correct voltage differences can be established across the actuators of theshutter assembly 1804 and the shutter assembly can be caused to actuate. After each of the open and closed actuators of theshutter assembly 1804 have been re-charged through the resistor, theshutter assembly 1804 will not re-actuate since either or both of the actuators now effectively holds the appropriate maintenance voltage, i.e., a voltage greater than Vm. -
FIG. 19 is yet anothersuitable control matrix 1900 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 1900 controls an array ofpixels 1902 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 1904 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators). The actuators in theshutter assemblies 1904 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 1900 includes a scan-line interconnect 1906 for each row ofpixels 1902 in thecontrol matrix 1900. Thecontrol matrix 1900 also includes two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 1908 a and a shutter-close interconnect 1908 b, for each column ofpixels 1902 in thecontrol matrix 1900. Thecontrol matrix 1900 further includes acharge interconnect 1910, acharge trigger interconnect 1912, and aglobal actuation interconnect 1914, and a shuttercommon interconnect 1915. Theseinterconnects pixels 1902 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 1902 in thecontrol matrix 1900. - Each
pixel 1902 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 1916, a shutter-open discharge transistor 1918, a shutter-open write-enabletransistor 1917, and adata store capacitor 1919 as described inFIG. 16A . Eachpixel 1902 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor 1920, and a shutter-close discharge transistor 1922, a shutter-close write-enabletransistor 1927, and adata store capacitor 1929. - At the beginning of each frame addressing cycle the
control matrix 1900 applies a voltage to thecharge trigger interconnect 1912, turning on the shutter-open and shutter-close transistors pixels 1902 in thecontrol matrix 1900. Thecharge interconnect 1910, in one implementation, carries a DC voltage equal to or greater than Vat, e.g., 40V. - Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, as was described with respect to control
matrix 1500 ofFIG. 15 . While a particular row ofpixels 1902 is write-enabled, thecontrol matrix 1900 applies a data voltage to either the shutter-open interconnect 1908 a or the shutter-close interconnect 1908 b corresponding to each column ofpixels 1902 in thecontrol matrix 1900. The application of Vwe to the scan-line interconnect 1906 for the write-enabled row turns on both of the write-enabletransistors pixels 1902 in the corresponding scan line. The voltages applied to the data interconnects 1908 a and 1908 b are thereby allowed to be stored on thedata store capacitors respective pixels 1902. Generally, to ensure proper actuation, only one of the actuators, either the shutter-closed actuator or the shutter-open actuator, is allowed to be discharged for any given shutter assembly in the array. - In
control matrix 1900 theglobal actuation interconnect 1914 is connected to the source of the both the shutter-opendischarge switch transistor 1918 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 1922. Maintaining theglobal actuation interconnect 1914 at a potential significantly above that of the shuttercommon interconnect 1915 prevents the turn-on of any of thedischarge switch transistors capacitors control matrix 1900 is achieved by bringing the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 1914 to the same potential as the shuttercommon interconnect 1915, making it possible for thedischarge switch transistors ether capacitor Control matrix 1900, therefore, does not depend on electrical bi-stability in theshutter assembly 1904 in order to achieve global actuation. - Applying partial voltages to the
data store capacitors 1919 and 1921 allows partial turn-on of thedischarge switch transistors global actuation interconnect 1914 is brought to its actuation potential. In this fashion, an analog voltage is created on theshutter assembly 1904, for providing analog gray scale. - In operation, the control matrix alternates between two control logics as described in relation to control
matrix 1600 ofFIG. 16A . - As in the
control matrix 1300 ofFIG. 13 , simple MIM diodes or varistors can be substituted for thecharge trigger transistor 1616 to perform the switching or charge loading function for each pixel in the array. Also, as incontrol matrix 1800 ofFIG. 18 it is possible to substitute a resistor for both the shutter-open charge transistor 1916 and the shutter-close charge transistor 1920. -
FIG. 20 is yet anothersuitable control matrix 2000 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 2000 controls an array ofpixels 2002 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2004 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators). The actuators in theshutter assemblies 2004 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 2000 includes a scan-line interconnect 2006 for each row ofpixels 2002 in thecontrol matrix 2000. Thecontrol matrix 2000 also includes two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 2008 a and a shutter-close interconnect 2008 b, for each column ofpixels 2002 in thecontrol matrix 2000. Thecontrol matrix 2000 further includes acharge interconnect 2010, and aglobal actuation interconnect 2014, and a shuttercommon interconnect 2015. Theseinterconnects pixels 2002 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 2002 in thecontrol matrix 2000. - Each
pixel 2002 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 2016, a shutter-open discharge transistor 2018, a shutter-open write-enabletransistor 2017, and adata store capacitor 2019 as described inFIGS. 16A and 19 . Eachpixel 2002 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor 2020, and a shutter-close discharge transistor 2022, a shutter-close write-enabletransistor 2027, and adata store capacitor 2029. -
Control matrix 2000 also incorporates twovoltage stabilizing capacitors discharge switch transistors common interconnect 2015. - By comparison to control
matrix 1900, the chargingtransistors charge interconnect 2010.Control matrix 2000 does not include a charge trigger interconnect which is shared among pixels. Instead, the gate terminals of both chargingtransistors charge interconnect 2010, along with the drain terminal oftransistors diode 1410 incontrol circuit 1400 ofFIG. 14 . - At the beginning of each frame addressing cycle the
control matrix 2000 applies a voltage pulse to thecharge interconnect 2010, allowing current to flow through chargingtransistors shutter assemblies 2004 of thepixels 2002. After this charging pulse, each of the shutter open and shutter closed electrodes ofshutter assemblies 2004 will be in the same voltage state. After the voltage pulse, the potential ofcharge interconnect 2010 is reset to zero, and the chargingtransistors shutter assemblies 2004 from being dissipated throughcharge interconnect 2010. Thecharge interconnect 2010, in one implementation, transmits a pulsed voltage equal to or greater than Vat, e.g., 40V. - Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, as was described with respect to control
matrix 1500 ofFIG. 15 . While a particular row ofpixels 2002 is write-enabled, thecontrol matrix 2000 applies a data voltage to either the shutter-open interconnect 2008 a or the shutter-close interconnect 2008 b corresponding to each column ofpixels 2002 in thecontrol matrix 2000. The application of Vwe to the scan-line interconnect 2006 for the write-enabled row turns on both of the write-enabletransistors pixels 2002 in the corresponding scan line. The voltages applied to the data interconnects 2008 a and 2008 b are thereby caused to be stored on thedata store capacitors respective pixels 2002. Generally, to ensure proper actuation, only one of the actuators, either the shutter-closed actuator or the shutter-open actuator, is caused to be discharged for any given shutter assembly in the array. - In
control matrix 2000 theglobal actuation interconnect 2014 is connected to the source of the both the shutter-opendischarge switch transistor 2018 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 2022. Maintaining theglobal actuation interconnect 2014 at a potential significantly above that of the shuttercommon interconnect 2015 prevents the turn-on of any of thedischarge switch transistors capacitors control matrix 2000 is achieved by bringing the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 2014 to substantially the same potential as the shuttercommon interconnect 2015, making it possible for thedischarge switch transistors ether capacitor Control matrix 2000, therefore, does not depend on electrical bi-stability in theshutter assembly 2004 in order to achieve global actuation. - Applying partial voltages to the
data store capacitors 2019 and 2021 allows partial turn-on of thedischarge switch transistors global actuation interconnect 2014 is brought to its actuation potential. In this fashion, an analog voltage is created on theshutter assembly 2004, for providing analog gray scale. - In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the
shutter assembly 2004, thecontrol matrix 2000 alternates between two control logics, as described in relation to controlmatrix 1600 ofFIG. 16A . -
FIG. 21 is yet anothersuitable control matrix 2100 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 2100 controls an array ofpixels 2102 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2104 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators). The actuators in theshutter assemblies 2104 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 2100 includes a scan-line interconnect 2106 for each row ofpixels 2102 in thecontrol matrix 2100. Despite the fact thatshutter assemblies 2104 are dual-actuator shutter assemblies, thecontrol matrix 2100 only includes asingle data interconnect 2108. Thecontrol matrix 2100 further includes acharge interconnect 2110, and aglobal actuation interconnect 2114, and a shuttercommon interconnect 2115. Theseinterconnects pixels 2102 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 2102 in thecontrol matrix 2100. - Each
pixel 2102 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 2116, a shutter-open discharge transistor 2118, a shutter-open write-enabletransistor 2117, and adata store capacitor 2119, as described inFIGS. 16A and 19 . Eachpixel 2102 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor 2120, a shutter-close discharge transistor 2122, and adata store capacitor 2129. - In addition and in contrast to control matrices described until now, the
control matrix 2100 includes a data load transistor 2135 and a data discharge transistor 2137.Control matrix 2100 also incorporates twovoltage stabilizing capacitors discharge switch transistors common interconnect 2115. - The charging
transistors control matrix 2000 ofFIG. 20 . That is, the gate terminals of both chargingtransistors charge interconnect 2110, along with the drain terminal oftransistors diode 1410 incontrol circuit 1400 ofFIG. 14 . - At the beginning of each frame addressing cycle the
control matrix 2100 applies a voltage pulse to thecharge interconnect 2110, allowing current to flow through chargingtransistors shutter assemblies 2104 of thepixels 2102. After this charging pulse, each of the shutter open and shutter closed electrodes ofshutter assemblies 2104 will be in the same voltage state. After the voltage pulse, the potential ofcharge interconnect 2110 is reset to zero, and the chargingtransistors shutter assemblies 2104 from being dissipated throughcharge interconnect 2110. Thecharge interconnect 2110, in one implementation, transmits a pulsed voltage equal to or greater than Vat, e.g., 40V. - Each row is then write-enabled in sequence, as was described with respect to control
matrix 1500 ofFIG. 15 . While a particular row ofpixels 2102 is write-enabled, thecontrol matrix 2100 applies a data voltage to thedata interconnect 2108. The application of Vwe to the scan-line interconnect 2106 for the write-enabled row turns on the write-enabletransistor 2117 of thepixels 2102 in the corresponding scan line. The voltages applied to thedata interconnect 2108 is thereby caused to be stored on thedata store capacitor 2119 of therespective pixels 2102. The same Vwe that is applied to the write enabletransistor 2117 is applied simultaneously to both the gate and the drain of data load transistor 2135, which allows current to pass through the data load transistor 2135 depending on whatever voltage is stored oncapacitor 2129. - The combination of transistors 2135 and 2137 functions essentially as an inverter with respect to the data stored on
capacitor 2119. The source of data load transistor 2135 is connected to the drain of data discharge transistor 2137 and simultaneously to an electrode of thedata store capacitor 2129. The gate of data discharge transistor 2137 is connected to an electrode ofdata store capacitor 2119. The voltage stored oncapacitor 2129, therefore, becomes the complement or inverse of the voltage stored ondata store capacitor 2119. For instance, if the voltage on thedata store capacitor 2119 is Von, then the data discharge transistor 2137 can switch on and the voltage on thedata store capacitor 2129 can become zero. Conversely, if the voltage ondata store capacitor 2119 is zero, then the data discharge transistor 2137 will switch off and the voltage on thedata store capacitor 2129 will remain at its pre-set voltage Vwe. - In
control matrix 2100 theglobal actuation interconnect 2114 is connected to the source of the shutter-opendischarge switch transistor 2118, the shutter-close discharge transistor 2122, and the data discharge transistor 2137. Maintaining theglobal actuation interconnect 2114 at a potential significantly above that of the shuttercommon interconnect 2115 prevents the turn-on of any of thedischarge switch transistors capacitors 2119. Global actuation incontrol matrix 2100 is achieved by bringing the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 2114 to substantially the same potential as the shuttercommon interconnect 2115. During the time that the global actuation is so activated, all three of thetransistors capacitor 2119. Because of the operation of the inverter 2135 and 2137, only one of thedischarge transistors shutter assembly 2104. The presence of the inverter 2135 and 2137 helps to obviate the need for a separate shutter-close data interconnect. - Applying partial voltages to the
data store capacitors discharge switch transistors global actuation interconnect 2114 is brought to its actuation potential. In this fashion, an analog voltage is created on theshutter assembly 2104, for providing analog gray scale. - In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the
shutter assembly 2104, thecontrol matrix 2100 alternates between two control logics as described in relation to controlmatrix 1600 ofFIG. 16A . -
FIG. 22 is yet anothersuitable control matrix 2200 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 2200 controls an array ofpixels 2202 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2204 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators). The actuators in theshutter assemblies 2204 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 2200 includes a scan-line interconnect 2206 for each row ofpixels 2202 in thecontrol matrix 2200. Thecontrol matrix 2200 also includes two data interconnects, a shutter-open interconnect 2208 a and a shutter-close interconnect 2208 b, for each column ofpixels 2202 in thecontrol matrix 2200. Thecontrol matrix 2200 further includes acharge interconnect 2210, aglobal actuation interconnect 2214, and a shuttercommon interconnect 2215. Theseinterconnects pixels 2202 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 2202 in thecontrol matrix 2200. - Each
pixel 2202 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor 2216, a shutter-open discharge transistor 2218, a shutter-open write-enabletransistor 2217, and adata store capacitor 2219 as described inFIGS. 16A and 19 . Eachpixel 2202 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor 2220, and a shutter-close discharge transistor 2222, a shutter-close write-enabletransistor 2227, and adata store capacitor 2229. - The
control matrix 2200 makes use of two complementary types of transistors, both p-channel and n-channel transistors. It is therefore referred to as a complementary MOS control matrix or a CMOS control matrix. The chargingtransistors discharge transistors - The
CMOS control matrix 2200 does not incorporate and does not require any voltage stabilizing capacitors, such as 2031 and 2033 fromcontrol matrix 2000 ofFIG. 20 .Control matrix 2200 does not include a charge trigger interconnect (such ascharge trigger interconnect 1912 incontrol matrix 1900 ofFIG. 19 ). By comparison to controlmatrices transistors charge interconnect 2210 and theshutter assembly 2204. The source of each oftransistors charge interconnect 2210. The gate of shutter-close charge transistor 2220 is connected to the drain of a shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 and simultaneously to the shutter-open actuator of thecorresponding shutter assembly 2204. The gate of shutter-open charge transistor 2216 is connected to the drain of a shutter-close discharge transistor 2222 and simultaneously to the shutter-close actuator of thecorresponding shutter assembly 2204. The drain of shutter-close charge transistor 2220 is connected to the drain of a shutter-close discharge transistor 2222 and simultaneously to the shutter-close actuator of thecorresponding shutter assembly 2204. The drain of shutter-open charge transistor 2216 is connected to the drain of a shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 and simultaneously to the shutter-open actuator of thecorresponding shutter assembly 2204. - The operation of
control matrix 2200 is distinct from that of the circuits already discussed, in particular fromcontrol matrices FIGS. 18 , 19 and 20, respectively, which have generally employed the charging sequence described in control method 1200 ofFIG. 12 . In control method 1200, as applied to controlmatrix 1900, an actuation voltage is first applied to each side of theshutter assembly 1902, or applied simultaneously to the shutter-open actuator and the shutter-closed actuators ofshutter assembly 1902. Later, as part of the global actuation sequence, either one actuator or the other inshutter assembly 1902 is caused to discharge in accordance to whether a data voltage was stored onether capacitor control matrix 2200 does not require a distinct or initializing charging sequence. Thecharge interconnect 2210 is maintained at a steady DC voltage equal to the actuation voltage Vat, e.g. at 40 volts. - The
control matrix 2200 operates as a logical flip-flop, which has only two stable states. In the first stable state the shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 is on, the shutter-closeddischarge transistor 2222 is off, the shutter-open charge transistor 2216 is off, and the shutter-close charge transistor 2220 is on. In this first stable state the shutter-open actuator is discharged or set to the same potential as theglobal actuation interconnect 2214, while the shutter-closed actuator is held at the actuation voltage Vat. In the second stable state the shutter-open discharge transistor 2218 is off, the shutter-closeddischarge transistor 2222 is on, the shutter-open charge transistor 2216 is on, and the shutter-close charge transistor 2220 is off. In this second stable state the shutter-closed actuator is discharged or set to the same potential as theglobal actuation interconnect 2214, while the shutter-closed actuator is held at the actuation voltage Vat. The cross-coupling oftransistors - Those skilled in the art will recognize that both the shutter-open and shutter-close actuators of
shutter assembly 2204 are connected to the output stage of a corresponding CMOS inverter. These inverters can be labeled as the shutter open inverter which comprisestransistors transistors data store capacitors - The two stable actuation states of
control matrix 2200 are associated with substantially zero current flow between thecharge interconnect 2210 and theglobal actuation interconnect 2214, an important power savings. This is achieved because the shutter-open charge transistor 2216 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 2218 are made from different transistor types, pMOS or nMOS, while the shutter-close charge transistor 2220 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 2222 are also made from the different transistor types, pMOS and nMOS. - The flip-flop operation of
control matrix 2200 allows for a constant voltage actuation of theshutter assembly 2204, without the need for voltage stabilizing capacitors, such ascapacitor control matrix 2000 ofFIG. 20 . This is because one of the chargingtransistors interconnect 2210 throughout the actuation event. - At the beginning of each frame addressing cycle the
control matrix 2200 applies a write enable voltage to each scan-line interconnect 2206 in sequence. While a particular row ofpixels 2202 is write-enabled, thecontrol matrix 2200 applies a data voltage to either the shutter-open interconnect 2208 a or the shutter-close interconnect 2208 b corresponding to each column ofpixels 2202 in thecontrol matrix 2200. The application of V, to the scan-line interconnect 2206 for the write-enabled row turns on both of the write-enabletransistors pixels 2202 in the corresponding scan line. The voltages applied to the data interconnects 2208 a and 2208 b are thereby caused to be stored on thedata store capacitors respective pixels 2202. Generally, to ensure proper actuation, only one of the actuators, either the shutter-closed actuator or the shutter-open actuator, is caused to be discharged for any given shutter assembly in the array. - In
control matrix 2200 theglobal actuation interconnect 2214 is connected to the source of the both the shutter-opendischarge switch transistor 2218 and the shutter-close discharge transistor 2222. Maintaining theglobal actuation interconnect 2214 at a potential significantly above that of the shuttercommon interconnect 2215 prevents the turn-on of any of thedischarge switch transistors capacitors control matrix 2200 is achieved by bringing the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 2214 to substantially the same potential as the shuttercommon interconnect 2215, making it possible for thedischarge switch transistors capacitor capacitor - The voltage stored on
capacitors charge interconnect 2210. Therefore some optional specifications on the transistors can help to reduce any transient switching currents incontrol matrix 2200. For instance, it may be preferable to increase the ratio of width to length in thedischarge transistors charge transistors - In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the
shutter assembly 2204, thecontrol matrix 2200 alternates between two control logics as described in relation to controlmatrix 1600 ofFIG. 16A . -
FIG. 23 is yet anothersuitable control matrix 2300 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 2300 controls an array ofpixels 2302 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2304 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators). The actuators in theshutter assemblies 2304 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 2300 includes a scan-line interconnect 2306 for each row ofpixels 2302 in thecontrol matrix 2300. Despite the fact thatshutter assemblies 2304 are dual-actuator shutter assemblies, thecontrol matrix 2300 only includes asingle data interconnect 2308. Thecontrol matrix 2300 further includes acharge interconnect 2310, and aglobal actuation interconnect 2314, and a shuttercommon interconnect 2315. Theseinterconnects pixels 2302 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 2302 in thecontrol matrix 2300. - Each
pixel 2302 in the control matrix includes a shutter-open charge transistor Q16, a shutter-open discharge transistor Q18, a shutter-open write-enable transistor Q17, and a data store capacitor C19, as described inFIGS. 16A and 19 . Eachpixel 2302 in the control matrix includes a shutter-close charge transistor Q20, and a shutter-close discharge transistor Q22, and a shutter-close write-enable transistor Q27. - The
control matrix 2300 makes use of two complementary types of transistors, both p-channel and n-channel transistors. It is therefore referred to as a complementary MOS control matrix or a CMOS control matrix. The charging transistors Q16 and Q20, for instance, are of the pMOS type, while the discharge transistors Q18 and Q22 are of the nMOS type. In other implementations, the types of transistors employed incontrol matrix 2300 can be reversed, for example nMOS transistors can be used for the charging transistors and pMOS transistors can be used for the discharge transistors. - In addition to the transistors identified above, the
control matrix 2300 includes alevel shifting inverter 2332, comprised of transistors Q31 and Q33; it includes a transition-sharpeninginverter 2336, comprised of transistors Q35 and Q37; and it includes aswitching inverter 2340, comprised of transistors Q39 and Q41. Each of these inverters is comprised of complementary pairs of transistors (i.e., nMOS coupled with pMOS). The sources of transistors Q33, Q37, and Q41 are connected to a Vdd supply interconnect 2334. The sources of transistors Q31, Q35, and Q39 are connected to theglobal actuation interconnect 2314. - The
CMOS control matrix 2300 does not incorporate and does not require any voltage stabilizing capacitors, such as 2031 and 2033 fromcontrol matrix 2000 ofFIG. 20 .Control matrix 2300 does not include a charge trigger interconnect (such ascharge trigger interconnect 1912 ofFIG. 19 ). - In a wiring similar to
control matrix 2200, the transistors Q16, Q18, Q20, and Q22 are cross connected and operate as a flip flop. The sources of both transistors Q16 and Q20 are connected directly tocharge interconnect 2310, which is held at a DC potential equal to the actuation voltage Vat, e.g. at 40 volts. The sources of both transistors Q18 and Q22 are connected to theglobal actuation interconnect 2314. The cross coupling of transistors Q16, Q18, Q20, and Q22 ensures that there are only two stable states—in which only one of the actuators inshutter assembly 2304 is held at the actuation voltage Vat, while the other actuator (after global actuation) is held at a voltage near to zero. By contrast to the operation ofcontrol matrices FIGS. 18 , 19, and 20, respectively, thecontrol matrix 2300 does not require a distinct charging sequence or any variation or pulsing of the voltage fromcharge interconnect 2310. - As was the case in
control matrix 2200 ofFIG. 22 , the flip-flop switching circuit can be recognized as the cross coupling of two inverters, namely a shutter open inverter (transistors Q16 and Q18) and a shutter close inverter (transistors Q20 and Q22). - In either of its stable states, the flip-flop circuit formed by transistors Q16, Q18, Q20, and Q22 is associated with substantially zero DC current flow, and therefore forms a low power voltage switching circuit. This is achieved because of the use of complementary (CMOS) transistor types.
- The flip-flop operation of
control matrix 2300 allows for a constant voltage actuation of theshutter assembly 2304, without the need for voltage stabilizing capacitors, such ascapacitor control matrix 2000 ofFIG. 20 . This is because one of the charging transistors Q16 or Q20 remains on throughout the actuation event, allowing the corresponding actuator to maintain a low impedance connection to the DC supply of theinterconnect 2210 throughout the actuation event. - At the beginning of each frame addressing cycle the
control matrix 2300 applies a write enable voltage to each scan-line interconnect 2306 in sequence. While a particular row ofpixels 2302 is write-enabled, thecontrol matrix 2300 applies a data voltage to thedata interconnect 2308. The application of V, to the scan-line interconnect 2306 for the write-enabled row turns on the write-enable transistor Q17 of thepixels 2302 in the corresponding scan line. The voltages applied to thedata interconnect 2308 is thereby caused to be stored on the data store capacitor 2319 of therespective pixels 2302. - The functions of the inverters with transistors Q31 through Q41 will now be explained. The
level shifting inverter 2332 outputs a voltage Vdd (derived from supply interconnect 2334), e.g. 8 volts, which is provisionally supplied to the input of thetransition sharpening inverter 2336, depending on the voltage state of capacitor C19. The transition-sharpeninginverter 2336 outputs the inverse or complement of its input from thevoltage leveling inverter 2332, and supplies that complement voltage to both theswitching inverter 2340, as well as to the gate of transistor Q22. (By complement we mean that if the output of the voltage leveling inverter is Vdd, then the output of the transition sharpening inverter will be near to zero, and vice versa.) The output of theswitching inverter 2340 supplies a voltage to the gate of transistor Q18, which is again the complement of the voltage supplied from the transition-sharpeninginverter 2336. - In a manner similar to the function of transistors 2135 and 2137 from
control matrix 2100 ofFIG. 21 , the switchinginverter 2340 ensures that only one of the discharge transistors Q18 or Q22 can be on at any one time, thereby ensuring proper actuation ofshutter assembly 2304. The presence of theswitching inverter 2340 obviates the need for a separate shutter-close data interconnect. - The
level shifting inverter 2332 requires only a low voltage input (e.g. 3 volts) and outputs a complement which is shifted to the higher voltage of Vdd (e.g. 8 volts). For instance, if the voltage on capacitor C19 is 3 volts, then the output voltage frominverter 2332 will be close to zero, while if the voltage on capacitor C19 is close to zero, then the output from theinverter 2332 will be at Vdd (e.g. 8 volts). The presence of the level shifting inverter, therefore, provides several advantages. A higher voltage (e.g. 8 volts) is supplied as a switch voltage to discharge transistors Q18 and Q22. But the 8 volts required for such switching is derived from a power supply,interconnect 2334, which is a DC supply and which only needs to provide enough current to charge the gate capacitance on various transistors in the pixel. The power required to drive thesupply interconnect 2334 will, therefore, be only a minor contributor to the power required to driveshutter assembly 2304. At the same time the data voltage, supplied bydata interconnect 2308 and stored on capacitor C19, can be less than 5 volts (e.g. 3 volts) and the power associated with AC voltage variations oninterconnect 2308 will be substantially reduced. - The transition-sharpening
inverter 2336 helps to reduce the switching time or latency between voltage states as output to the discharge transistor Q22 and to theswitching inverter 2340. Any reduction in switching time on the inputs to the CMOS switching circuit (Q16 through Q22) helps to reduce the transient switching currents experienced by that circuit. - The combination of the CMOS switching circuit, with transistors Q16 through Q22, the
CMOS switching inverter 2340, and the CMOSlevel shifting inverter 2332 makes thecontrol matrix 2300 an attractive low power method for driving an array ofshutter assemblies 2304. Reliable actuation of even dual-actuator shutter assemblies, such asshutter assembly 2304, is achieved with the use of only a single storage capacitor, C19, in each pixel. - In
control matrix 2300 theglobal actuation interconnect 2314 is connected to the source of transistors Q31, Q35, Q39, Q18, and Q22. Maintaining theglobal actuation interconnect 2314 at a potential significantly above that of the shuttercommon interconnect 2315 prevents the turn-on of any of the transistors Q31, Q35, Q39, Q18, and Q22, regardless of what charge is stored on the capacitor C19. Global actuation incontrol matrix 2300 is achieved by bringing the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 2314 to substantially the same potential as the shuttercommon interconnect 2315. During the time that the global actuation is so activated, all of the transistors Q31, Q35, Q39, Q18, and Q22 have the opportunity to change their state, depending on what data voltage has been stored on capacitor C19. - The voltage supplied by
supply interconnect 2334, Vdd, is not necessarily the same as the actuation voltage Vat, as supplied by thecharge interconnect 2310. Therefore, some optional specifications on transistors Q16 through Q22 can help to reduce the transient switching currents incontrol matrix 2300. For instance it may be preferable to increase the width to length ratio in the discharge transistors Q18 and Q22 as compared to the charge transistors Q16 and Q20. The ratio of width to length for the discharge transistors may vary between 1 and 10 while the ratio of length to width for the charge transistors may vary between 0.1 and 1. Similarly the width to length ratio between level shifting transistors Q31 and Q33 should be similarly differentiated. For instance, the ratio of width to length for transistor Q31 may vary between 1 and 10 while the ratio of width to length for transistor Q33 may vary between 0.1 and 1. - In operation, in order to periodically reverse the polarity of voltages supplied to the
shutter assembly 2304, thecontrol matrix 2300 alternates between two control logics as described in relation to controlmatrix 1600 ofFIG. 16A . - Alternative embodiments to control
matrix 2300 are also possible. For instance, thelevel shifting inverters 2332 and thetransition sharpening inverter 2336 can be removed from the circuit as long as the voltage supplied by thedata interconnect 2308 is high enough to switch the flip-flop circuit reliably. As this required switching voltage may be as high as 8 volts, the power dissipation for such a simplified circuit is expected to increase by comparison to controlmatrix 2300. The simplified circuit would, however, require less real estate and could therefore be packed to higher pixel densities. - In another alternative to control
matrix 2300, the pre-charge circuit fromcontrol matrices FIGS. 20 and 21 , respectively, can be substituted intocontrol matrix 2300, in place of transistors Q16, Q18, Q20, and Q22. For such a control matrix thetransition sharpening inverter 2336 would no longer be necessary. To the extent that both pMOS and nMOS remain available to this CMOS circuit, both types of transistors would still be beneficial in thelevel shifting inverter 2332 and in theswitching inverter 2340. This circuit would thereby exhibit power dissipation advantages by comparison to controlmatrix 2100 ofFIG. 21 . -
FIG. 24 is yet anothersuitable control matrix 2440 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 2440 controls an array ofpixels 2442 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2444 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators). The actuators in theshutter assemblies 2444 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. -
Control matrix 2440 is substantially the same ascontrol matrix 1640 ofFIG. 16B , except for three changes. A dual-actuator shutter assembly 2444 is utilized instead of theelastic shutter assembly 1644, a newcommon drive interconnect 2462 is added, and there is no voltage stabilizing capacitor, such ascapacitor 1652, incontrol matrix 2440. For the example given incontrol matrix 2440, thecommon drive interconnect 2462 is electrically connected to the shutter-open actuator of theshutter assembly 2444. - Despite the presence of a dual-
actuator shutter assembly 2444, thecontrol matrix 2440 includes only asingle data interconnect 2448 for each column ofpixels 2442 in the control matrix. The actuators in theshutter assemblies 2444 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 2440 includes a scan-line interconnect 2446 for each row ofpixels 2442 in thecontrol matrix 2440. Thecontrol matrix 2440 further includes acharge interconnect 2450, aglobal actuation interconnect 2454, and a shuttercommon interconnect 2455. Theinterconnects pixels 2442 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 2442 in thecontrol matrix 2440. - Each
pixel 2442 in the control matrix includes ashutter charge transistor 2456, ashutter discharge transistor 2458, a shutter write-enabletransistor 2457, and adata store capacitor 2459 as described inFIGS. 16A and 19 . For the example given incontrol matrix 2440 the drain of the shutter discharge transistor is connected to the shutter-close actuator of theshutter assembly 2444. - By comparison to control
matrix 1600 ofFIG. 16A , the chargingtransistor 2456 is wired with a different circuit connection to thecharge interconnect 2450.Control matrix 2440 does not include a charge trigger interconnect which is shared among pixels. Instead, the gate terminals of the chargingtransistor 2456 are connected directly to thecharge interconnect 2450, along with the drain terminal oftransistor 2456. In operation, the charging transistors operate essentially as diodes, i.e., they can pass a current in only 1 direction. Their function in the charging circuit becomes equivalent to that ofdiode 1410 incontrol circuit 1400 ofFIG. 14 . - A method of addressing and actuating the pixels in
control matrix 2440 is illustrated by themethod 2470 shown inFIG. 25 . Themethod 2470 proceeds in three general steps. First the matrix is addressed row by row by storing data into thedata store capacitors 2459. Next all actuators are actuated (or reset) simultaneously (step 2488) in part by applying a voltage Vat to thecharge interconnect 2450. And finally the image is set in steps 2492-2494 by a) selectively activatingtransistors 2458 by means of theglobal actuation interconnect 2454 and b) changing the potential difference between thecommon drive interconnect 2462 and the shuttercommon interconnect 2455 so as to be greater than an actuation voltage Vat. - As described with respect to control method 1000 of
FIG. 10 , or with respect to controlmatrix 1400 ofFIG. 14 , thecontrol matrix 2440 can operate between two control logics—which provide a periodic polarity reversal and thereby ensure a 0V DC average operation across theshutter assemblies 2442. For reasons of clarity the details forcontrol method 2470 are described next with respect to only the first control logic. In this first control logic the potential of the shuttercommon interconnect 2455 is maintained at all times near to the ground potential. A shutter will be held in either the open or closed states by applying a voltage Vat directly across either or both of thecharge interconnect 2450 or thecommon drive interconnect 2462. (In the second control logic, to be described after we complete the discussion ofFIG. 25 , the shutter common interconnect is held at the voltage Vat, and an actuated state will be maintained by maintaining either or both of thecharge interconnect 2450 or thecommon drive interconnect 2462 at ground.) - More specifically for the first control logic of
method 2470, the frame addressing cycle ofmethod 2470 begins when a voltage Voff is applied to the global actuation interconnect 2454 (step 2472). The voltage Voff oninterconnect 2454 is designed to ensure that thedischarge transistor 2458 will not turn on regardless of whether a voltage has been stored oncapacitor 2459. - The
control matrix 2440 then proceeds with the addressing of eachpixel 2442 in the control matrix, one row at a time (steps 2474-2484). To address a particular row, thecontrol matrix 2440 write-enables a first scan line by applying a voltage Vwe to the corresponding scan-line interconnect 2446 (step 2474). Then, atdecision block 2476, thecontrol matrix 2440 determines for eachpixel 2442 in the write-enabled row whether thepixel 2442 needs to be open or closed. For example, if at thereset step 2488 all shutters are to be (temporarily) closed, then atdecision block 2476 it is determined for eachpixel 2442 in the write-enabled row whether or not the pixel is to be (subsequently) opened. If apixel 2442 is to be opened, thecontrol matrix 2440 applies a data voltage Vd, for example 5V, to thedata interconnect 2448 corresponding to the column in which thatpixel 2442 is located (step 2478). The voltage Vd applied to thedata interconnect 2448 is thereby caused to be stored by means of a charge on thedata store capacitor 2459 of the selected pixel 2442 (step 2479). If atdecision block 2476, it is determined that apixel 2442 is to be closed, the correspondingdata interconnect 2448 is grounded (step 2480). Although the temporary (or reset) position afterstep 2488 in this example is defined as the shutter-close position, alternative shutter assemblies can be provided in which the reset position after 2488 is a shutter-open position. In these alternative cases, the application of data voltage Vd, at step 2478, would result in the opening of the shutter. - The application of Vwe to the scan-
line interconnect 2446 for the write-enabled row turns on all of the write-enabletransistors 2457 for thepixels 2442 in the corresponding scan line. Thecontrol matrix 2440 selectively applies the data voltage to all columns of a given row in thecontrol matrix 2440 at the same time while that row has been write-enabled. After all data has been stored oncapacitors 2459 in the selected row (steps 2479 and 2481), thecontrol matrix 2440 grounds the selected scan-line interconnect (step 2482) and selects a subsequent scan-line interconnect for writing (step 2485). After the information has been stored in the capacitors for all the rows incontrol matrix 2440, thedecision block 2484 is triggered to begin the global actuation sequence. - The actuation sequence begins at step 2486 of
method 2470, with the application of an actuation voltage Vat, e.g. 40 V, to thecharge interconnect 2450. As a consequence of step 2486, the voltage Vat is now imposed simultaneously across all of the shutter-close actuators of all theshutter assemblies 2444 incontrol matrix 2440. Next, atstep 2487, the potential on thecommon drive interconnect 2462 is grounded. In this first control logic (with the shutter common potential 2455 held near to ground) a groundedcommon drive interconnect 2462 reduces the voltage drop across all of the shutter-open actuators of allshutter assemblies 2444 to a value substantially below the maintenance voltage Vm. Thecontrol matrix 2440 then continues to maintain these actuator voltages (from steps 2486 and 2487) for a period of time sufficient for all actuators to actuate (step 2488). For the example given inmethod 2470,step 2488 acts to reset and close all actuators into an initial state. Alternatives to themethod 2470 are possible, however, in which thereset step 2488 acts to open all shutters. For this case thecommon drive interconnect 2462 would be electrically connected to the shutter-closed actuator of allshutter assemblies 2444. - At the next step 2490 the control matrix grounds the
charge interconnect 2450. The electrodes on the shutter-close actuators inshutter assembly 2444 provide a capacitance which stores a charge after thecharge interconnect 2450 has been grounded and the chargingtransistor 2456 has been turned off. The stored charge acts to maintain a voltage in excess of the maintenance voltage Vm across the shutter-close actuator. - After all actuators have been actuated and held in their closed position by a voltage in excess of Vm, the data stored in
capacitors 2459 can now be utilized to set an image incontrol matrix 2440 by selectively opening the specified shutter assemblies (steps 2492-2494). First, the potential on theglobal actuation interconnect 2454 is set to ground (step 2492). Step 2492 makes it possible for thedischarge switch transistor 2458 to turn-on in accordance to whether a data voltage has been stored oncapacitor 2459. For those pixels in which a voltage has been stored oncapacitor 2459, the charge which was stored on the shutter-close actuator ofshutter assembly 2444 is now allowed to dissipate through theglobal actuation interconnect 2454. - Next, at
step 2493, the voltage on thecommon drive interconnect 2462 is returned to the actuation voltage Vat, or is set such that the potential difference between thecommon drive interconnect 2462 and the shuttercommon interconnect 2455 is greater than an actuation voltage Vat. The conditions for selective actuation of the pixels have now been set. For those pixels in which a charge (or voltage Vd) has been stored oncapacitor 2459, the voltage difference across the shutter-close actuator will now be less than the maintenance voltage Vm while the voltage across the shutter-open actuator (which is tied to the common drive 2462) will at Vat. These selected shutters will now be caused to open at step 2494. For those pixels in which no charge has been stored oncapacitor 2459, thetransistor 2458 remains off and the voltage difference across the shutter-close actuator will be maintained above the maintenance voltage Vm. Even though a voltage Vat has been imposed across the shutter-open actuator, theshutter assembly 2444 will not actuate at step 2494 and will remain closed. Thecontrol matrix 2440 continues to maintain the voltages set aftersteps 2492 and 2493 for a period of time sufficient for all selected actuators to actuate during step 2494. After step 2494, each shutter is in its addressed state, i.e., the position dictated by the data voltages applied during the addressing andactuating method 2470. - To set an image in a subsequent video frame, the process begins again at step 2472.
- In alternate embodiments, the positions of the
steps 2486 and 2487 in the sequence can be switched, so thatstep 2487 occurs before step 2486. - In the
method 2470, all of the shutters are closed simultaneously during the time betweenstep 2488 and step 2494, a time in which no image information can be presented to the viewer. Themethod 2470, however, is designed to minimize this dead time (or reset time), by making use ofdata store capacitors 2459 andglobal actuation interconnect 2454 to provide timing control over thetransistors 2458. By the action of step 2472, all of the data for a given image frame can be written to thecapacitors 2459 during the addressing sequence (steps 2474-2485), without any immediate actuation effect on the shutter assemblies. Theshutter assemblies 2444 remain locked in the positions they were assigned in the previous image frame until addressing is complete and they are uniformly actuated or reset atstep 2488. The global actuation step 2492 allows the simultaneous transfer of data out of thedata store capacitors 2459 so that all shutter assemblies can be brought into their next image state at the same time. - As with the previously described control matrices, the activity of an attached backlight can be synchronized with the addressing of each frame. To take advantage of the minimal dead time offered in the addressing sequence of
method 2470, a command to turn the illumination off can be given betweenstep 2484 and step 2486. The illumination can then be turned-on again after step 2494. In a field-sequential color scheme, a lamp with one color can be turned off afterstep 2484 while a lamp with either the same or a different color is turned on after step 2494. - In other implementations, it is possible to apply the
method 2470 ofFIG. 25 to a selected portion of the whole array of pixels, since it may be advantageous to update different areas or groupings of rows and columns in series. In this case a number ofdifferent charge interconnects 2450,global actuation interconnects 2454, andcommon drive interconnects 2462 could be routed to selected portions of the array for selectively updating and actuating different portions of the array. - As described above, to address the
pixels 2442 in thecontrol matrix 2440, the data voltage Vd can be significantly less than the actuation voltage Vat (e.g., 5V vs. 40V). Since the actuation voltage Vat is applied once a frame, whereas the data voltage Vd may be applied to eachdata interconnect 2448 as may times per frame as there are rows in thecontrol matrix 2440, control matrices such ascontrol matrix 2440 may save a substantial amount of power in comparison to control matrices which require a data voltage to be high enough to also serve as the actuation voltage. - It will be understood that the embodiment of
FIG. 24 assumes the use of n-channel MOS transistors. Other embodiments are possible that employ p-channel transistors, in which case the relative signs of the bias potentials Vat and Vd would be reversed. - In operation, the control matrix alternates between two control logics as described with respect to control method 1000 of
FIG. 10 , or with respect to controlmatrix 1400 ofFIG. 14 . The two control logics provide a periodic polarity reversal and thereby ensure a 0V DC average operation across theshutter assemblies 2442. To achieve polarity reversal in the second control logic several of the voltage assignments illustrated and described with respect tomethod 2470 ofFIG. 25 are changed, although the sequencing of the control steps remains the same. - In the second control logic, the potential on the shutter
common interconnect 2455 is maintained at a voltage near to Vat (instead of near ground as was the case in the first control logic). In the second control logic, at step 2478, where the logic is set for the opening of a shutter assembly, thedata interconnect 2448 is grounded instead of taken to Vd. Atstep 2480, where the logic is set for the closing of a shutter assembly, the data interconnect is taken to the voltage Vd. Step 2486 remains the same, but atstep 2487 the common drive interconnect is set to the actuation voltage Vat in the second control logic instead of to ground. At the end ofstep 2487 in the second control logic, therefore, each of the shuttercommon interconnect 2455, thecommon drive interconnect 2462, and thecharge interconnect 2450 are set to the same voltage Vat. The image setting sequence then continues with grounding of theglobal actuation interconnect 2454 at step 2492—which has the effect in this second logic of closing only those shutters for which a voltage Vd was stored across thecapacitor 2459. Atstep 2493 in the second control logic thecommon drive interconnect 2462 is grounded. This has the effect of actuating and opening any shutters that were not otherwise actuated at step 2492. The logical state expressed at step 2494, therefore, is reversed in the second control logic, and the polarities are also effectively reversed. - Generally speaking any of the
control matrices FIG. 8 , the data supplied to the data-open interconnects and the data-closed interconnects will often be complementary, i.e. If a logical “1” is supplied to the data-open interconnect then a logical “0” will typically be supplied to the data closed interconnect. In additional alternative implementations, the control matrices can be modified to replace the transistors with varistors. - In alternative implementations, the control matrix keeps track of the prior position of each pixel and only applies positions to the data interconnects corresponding to a pixel if the state of the pixel for the next image frame is different than the prior position. In another alternative embodiment, the pixels include mechanically bi-stable shutter assemblies instead of just electrically bi-stable shutter assemblies. In such an embodiment, the charge trigger transistors can be replaced with resistors and the charge trigger interconnect can be omitted from the control matrix, as described above in relation to
FIG. 18 . The dual control logic used bycontrol matrix 1400 may also be utilized in other implementations ofcontrol matrix 1800. -
FIG. 26 is a schematic diagram of yet anothersuitable control matrix 2640 for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 2640 controls an array ofpixels 2642 that include dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2644 (i.e., shutter assemblies with both shutter-open and shutter-close actuators). The actuators in theshutter assemblies 2004 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. -
Control matrix 2640 is substantially the same ascontrol matrix 2440, with two changes: acharge trigger interconnect 2652 has been added and a pMOS transistor has been substituted for the chargingtransistor 2656 instead of the nMOS transistor as was indicated at 2456. - The
control matrix 2640 utilizes a dual-actuator shutter assembly 2644 along with acommon drive interconnect 2662. For the example given incontrol matrix 2640 thecommon drive interconnect 2662 is electrically connected to the shutter-open actuator of theshutter assembly 2644. Despite the presence of a dual-actuator shutter assembly 2644, thecontrol matrix 2640 includes only asingle data interconnect 2648 for each column ofpixels 2642 in the control matrix. - The
control matrix 2640 includes a scan-line interconnect 2646 for each row ofpixels 2642 in thecontrol matrix 2640. Thecontrol matrix 2640 further includes acharge interconnect 2650, acharge trigger interconnect 2652, aglobal actuation interconnect 2654, and a shuttercommon interconnect 2655. Theinterconnects pixels 2642 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In one implementation (the one described in more detail below), theinterconnects pixels 2642 in thecontrol matrix 2640. - Each
pixel 2642 in the control matrix includes ashutter charge transistor 2656, ashutter discharge transistor 2658, a shutter write-enabletransistor 2657, and adata store capacitor 2659 as described inFIGS. 16 and 18 . For the example given incontrol matrix 2644 the drain of the shutter discharge transistor is connected to the shutter-close actuator of theshutter assembly 2644. - The
control matrix 2640 makes use of two complementary types of transistors: both p-channel and n-channel transistors. It is therefore referred to as a complementary MOS control matrix or a CMOS control matrix. While the chargingtransistor 2656 is made of the pMOS type, thedischarge transistor 2658 is made of the nMOS type of transistor. (In other implementations the types of transistors can be reversed, for example nMOS transistors can be used for the charging transistors and pMOS transistors can be used for the discharge transistors.) The use of a charge trigger interconnect along with the CMOS circuit helps to reduce the set of voltage variations required to achieve shutter actuation. - With the use of the
charge trigger interconnect 2652, thecontrol circuit 2640 is wired to the chargingtransistor 2656 in a fashion similar to that ofcontrol matrix 1600. Only the source ofpMOS transistor 2656 is connected to thecharge interconnect 2650 while the gate is connected to thecharge trigger interconnect 2652. Throughout operation, thecharge interconnect 2650 is maintained at a constant voltage equal to the actuation voltage Vat. Thecharge trigger interconnect 2652 is maintained at the same voltage (Vat) as that of the charge interconnect whenever thecharge transistor 2656 is to be held in the off state. In order to turn-on thecharge transistor 2656, the voltage on thecharge trigger interconnect 2652 is reduced so that the voltage difference betweencharge interconnect 2650 andinterconnect 2652 is greater than the threshold voltage of thetransistor 2656. Threshold voltages can vary in a range from 2 to 8 volts. In one implementation where thetransistor 2656 is a pMOS transistor, both thecharge interconnect 2650 and thecharge trigger interconnect 2652 are held at a Vat of 40 volts when thetransistor 2656 is off. In order to turntransistor 2656 on, the voltage on thecharge interconnect 2650 would remain at 40 volts while the voltage on thecharge trigger interconnect 2652 is temporarily reduced to 35 volts. (If an nMOS transistor were to be used at the point oftransistor 2656, then the Vat would be −40 volts and a charge trigger voltage of −35 volts would be sufficient to turn the transistor on.) - A method for addressing and actuating pixels in
control matrix 2640 is similar to that ofmethod 2470, with the following changes. At step 2486 the voltage on the charge trigger interconnect is reduced from Vat to Vat minus a threshold voltage. Similar to the operation ofmethod 2470 all of the shutter-closed actuators then become charged at the same time, and atstep 2488 all shutters will close while a constant voltage Vat is maintained across the shutter close actuator. In another modification to themethod 2470, at step 2490, thecharge interconnect 2650 is allowed to remain at Vat while thetransistor 2656 is turned off by returning the voltage on thecharge trigger interconnect 2652 to Vat. After thetransistor 2656 is turned off, the actuation procedure proceeds to the global actuation step 2492. - The actuator charging process at step 2486 in
method 2470 can be accomplished as described above forcontrol matrix 2640 with nearly zero voltage change on thecharge interconnect 2650 and only a minimal (threshold voltage) change required for thecharge trigger interconnect 2652. Therefore the energy required to repeatedly change the voltage from Vat to ground and back is saved in this control matrix. The power required to drive each actuation cycle is considerably reduced incontrol matrix 2640 as compared tocontrol matrix 2440. - In a similar fashion, the use of complementary nMOS and pMOS transistor types can be applied to the charging transistors in
control matrices -
FIG. 27 is a schematic diagram of anothercontrol matrix 2740 suitable for inclusion in thedisplay apparatus 100, according to an illustrative embodiment of the invention.Control matrix 2740 operates in a manner substantially similar to that ofcontrol matrix 2440, except that some of the circuit elements are now shared between multiple shutter assemblies in the array of shutter assemblies. In addition several of the common interconnects are wired into separate groups, such that each of these common interconnects are shared only amongst the pixels of their particular group. - The
control matrix 2740 includes an array of dual-actuator shutter assemblies 2744. Similar to thecontrol matrix 2440, however, thecontrol matrix 2740 includes only asingle data interconnect 2748 for each column of pixels 2742 in the control matrix. The actuators in theshutter assemblies 2744 can be made either electrically bi-stable or mechanically bi-stable. - The
control matrix 2740 includes one scan-line interconnect 2746 which is shared amongst four consecutive rows of pixels 2742 in the array of pixels. Each pixel in the array is also connected to a global actuation interconnect, a common drive interconnect, a charge interconnect, and a shutter common interconnect. For the embodiment illustrated inFIG. 27 , however, the pixels are identified as members of four separate groups which are connected in common only to certain interconnects within their particular group. Thepixels 2742A, for instance, are aligned along the first row and are members of the first group incontrol matrix 2740. Each pixel in the group of pixels that includepixels 2742A is connected to aglobal actuation interconnect 2754A and acommon drive interconnect 2762A. Thepixels 2742B are aligned along the second row and are members of the second group incontrol matrix 2740. Each pixel in the group ofpixels 2742B is connected to aglobal actuation interconnect 2754B and acommon drive interconnect 2762B. Similarly thepixels 2742C in the third row are members of the third group of pixels which are connected in common toglobal actuation interconnect 2754C and common drive interconnect 2762C. Similarly thepixels 2742D in the third row are members of the third group of pixels which are connected in common toglobal actuation interconnect 2754D andcommon drive interconnect 2762D. The sequential pattern ofrows including pixels FIG. 27 . Each group of four rows includes a single scan line interconnect 2746 which is shared between the four rows. - The global actuation interconnects 2754A, 2754B, 2754C, and 2754D are electrically independent of each other. A global actuation signal applied to the
interconnect 2754A may actuate allpixels 2742A within that row of the array, as well as all pixels in similarly connected rows (that occur in every fourth row of the array). A global actuation signal applied to theinterconnect 2754A, however, will not actuate any of the pixels in the other groups, e.g. it will not actuate thepixels - The
control matrix 2740 further includes acharge interconnect 2750 and a shuttercommon interconnect 2755. Theinterconnects FIG. 27 ), theinterconnects control matrix 2740. - Each pixel 2742 in the control matrix includes a
shutter charge transistor 2756 and ashutter discharge transistor 2758. As described inFIG. 16B andFIG. 24 thecharge transistor 2756 is connected between thecharge interconnect 2750 and the shutter-closed actuator ofshutter assemblies 2744 in each pixel. Theshutter discharge transistor 2758 is connected between theshutter assembly 2744 and the particularglobal actuation interconnect control matrix 2740 the common drive interconnects 2762A, 2762B, 2762C, and 2762D are electrically connected to the shutter-open actuators of theshutter assemblies 2744 within their particular groups. - Near to the intersection of each
data interconnect 2748 and each scan line interconnect 2746 is a write-enabletransistor 2757, and adata store capacitor 2759. Thetransistors 2757 andcapacitor 2759 appear in each column but, like the scan line interconnect 2746, they appear only once in every four rows. The function of these circuit elements is shared between the pixels in each of the four adjacent rows. A fan-out interconnect 2766 is used to connect the charge stored on thecapacitor 2759 to the gates on each of theshutter discharge transistors 2758 within the column for the four adjacent rows. - The operation of
shutter assemblies 2744 is very similar to that described forcontrol matrix 2440 inmethod 2470. The difference is that, forcontrol matrix 2740, the addressing and actuating of the pixels is carried out independently and during separate time intervals for each of the fourpixel groups FIG. 27 the addressing for the pixels ingroup 2742A would proceed by applying Voff to theglobal actuation interconnect 2754A and applying a write-enable voltage to each of the scan line interconnects 2746 in turn. During the time that a scan line is write-enabled the data corresponding to each of the pixels of group A assigned to a particular scan line is loaded into thecapacitor 2759 by means of thedata interconnect 2748 in each column. After the addressing of the scan lines in the whole array is complete, the control matrix then proceeds to an actuation sequence as described from step 2486 to step 2494 in themethod 2470. Except, forcontrol matrix 2740, the data is loaded for only one group of pixels at a time (e.g. thepixels 2742A in group A) and the actuation proceeds by activating only the global actuation interconnect (2754A) and the common drive interconnect (2762A) for that particular group of pixels. - After actuation of
pixels 2742A is complete, the control matrix proceeds with the loading of data into the second group of pixels, e.g. 2742B. The addressing of the second group of pixels (group B) proceeds by use of the same set of scan line interconnects 2746, data interconnects 2748, anddata store capacitors 2759 as were employed for group A. The data stored incapacitors 2759 will only affect the actuation of thepixels 2742B in group B, however, since this data can only be transferred to the shutter assemblies of their particular group after actuation by means of the global actuation interconnect for the group, 2754B. The selective actuation of each the four pixel groups is accomplished by means of the independent global actuation interconnects 2754A, 2754B, 2754C, or 2754D and independent common drive interconnects 2762A, 2762B, 2762C, or 2762D. - In order to address and actuate all pixels in the array it is necessary to address and actuate the pixels in each of the four
pixel groups transistors 2757 and thedata store capacitors 2759 only need to be fabricated once for each adjacent set of four rows. - For the embodiment given in
FIG. 27 the pixels in the array have been broken into four groups A, B, C, and D. Other embodiments are possible, however, in which the array can be broken into only 2 groups, into 3 groups, into 6 groups, or into 8 groups. In all of these cases the pixels of a group are connected in common to their own particular global actuation interconnect and common drive interconnect. For the case of 2 groups the scan line interconnect, the write-enable transistor, and the data store capacitor would appear in every other row. For the case of 6 groups the scan line interconnect, the write-enable transistor, and the data store capacitor would appear in every sixth row. - For the embodiment given in
FIG. 27 thecharge interconnect 2750 and shuttercommon interconnect 2755 are shared among pixels 2742 in multiple rows and multiple columns in the array. In other embodiments the charge interconnects and shutter common interconnects can also be assigned and shared only among particular groups, such as groups A, B, C, and D. - The sharing of actuation interconnects amongst distinct groups, and the sharing of scan line interconnects, write-enable transistors, and data store capacitors amongst adjacent rows has been described in an implementation particular to the
control matrix 2440. Similar sharing of pixel elements, however, can be adopted with respect to a number of other control matrices, such ascontrol matrices - Voltage vs. Charge Actuation
- As described above, in various embodiments of the invention, the MEMS-based light modulators used to form an image utilize electrostatic actuation, in which opposing capacitive members are drawn together during an actuation event. In some actuator implementations, depending on the geometry of the electrostatic members, the force drawing the capacitive members will vary in relation to the voltage applied across the electrostatic members. If the charge stored on the actuator is held constant, then the voltage and thus the force attracting the capacitive members, may decrease as the capacitive beams draw closer together. For such actuators, it is desirable to maintain a substantially constant voltage across the capacitive members to maintain sufficient force to complete actuation. For other actuator geometries (e.g., parallel plate capacitors), force is proportional to the strength of the electric field between the capacitive portions of the actuator, the electric field likewise being proportional to the amount of charge stored on the capacitive members. In such actuators, if an elastic restoring force is present which increases as capacitive members draw together, it may be necessary to increase the stored charge on the members to complete the actuation. An increase in stored charge and therefore the force of actuation can be accomplished by connecting the actuator to a source of charge, i.e. a constant voltage source.
-
Control matrix 1900 ofFIG. 19 operates in conditions in which actuators are electrically isolated from a source of charge during actuation. Prior to actuation of either of the two actuators included in the pixel, charge yielding a voltage sufficient to initiate actuation of both actuators Vat, absent a maintenance voltage, is stored directly on each actuator. The actuators are then isolated from external voltage sources. At a later date, the charge stored on one of the actuators is discharged. The non-discharged actuator then actuates based solely on the constant charge previously stored on the actuator. -
FIG. 28 includes three charts that illustrate the variations in electrostatic parameters that result from movement of portions of electrostatic actuators in various implementations of the invention. The chart labeled Case A inFIG. 28 illustrates the variations in parameters associated with the actuation of the actuator of a pixel fromcontrol matrix 1900 from an open position to a closed position. During actuation, since the actuator is electrically isolated, the charge remains constant. As the capacitive members draw closer together, the voltage decreases and the capacitance increases. To ensure proper actuation, the initial voltage applied to the actuator is preferably high enough such that as the voltage decreases resulting from motion of portions of the actuator, the resulting voltage is still sufficient to fully actuate the actuator. - To help ensure proper actuation without applying what might otherwise be an unnecessarily high voltage across the capacitive members of an actuator, a control matrix can incorporate a voltage regulator in electrical communication with the actuator during actuation of the actuator. The voltage regulator maintains a substantially constant voltage on the actuator during actuation. As a result, as the capacitance of the actuator increases as the capacitive elements draw closer together, additional charge flows into the capacitive members to maintain the voltage across the capacitive members, thereby maintaining the voltage level, increasing the electric field, and increasing the attractive force between the capacitive members. Thus, the voltage regulator substantially limits variations in voltage that would otherwise be caused by movement of portions of the actuators during actuation.
- Voltage regulators can be included in each pixel in a control matrix, for example, as stabilizing capacitors connected to the capacitive members of the actuators.
Control matrices FIG. 28 . In such implementations, as the capacitive members of an actuator draw closer together, charge stored on the stabilizing capacitor flows into the capacitive member maintaining a voltage equilibrium between the stabilizing capacitor and the actuator. Thus, the voltage on the actuator decreases, but less so than in control matrices without a stabilizing capacitor. Preferably, the stabilizing capacitor is selected such that during actuation, the variation in the voltage on the actuator is limited to less than about 20% of Vat. In other implementations, a higher capacitance capacitor is selected such that during actuation, the variation in the voltage on the actuator is limited to less than about 10% of Vat. In still other implementations, the stabilizing capacitor is selected such that during actuation, the variation in the voltage on the actuator is limited to less than about 5% of Vat. - Alternatively, display drivers may serve as voltage regulators. The display drivers output a DC actuation voltage. In some implementations, the voltage may be substantially constant throughout operation of the display apparatus in which it is incorporated. In such implementations, the application of the voltage output by the display drivers is regulated by transistors incorporated into each pixel in the control matrix. In other implementations, the display drivers switch between two substantially constant voltage levels according. In such implementations, no such transistors are needed. In some implementations the pixels are connected to the display drivers by means of a voltage actuation interconnect. In some implementations, such as
control matrix 2640, a voltage actuation interconnect such asinterconnect 2662, can be a global common interconnect, meaning that it connects to pixels in at least two rows and two columns of the array of pixels. -
Control matrices FIG. 28 , as the capacitive members of an electrostatic actuator connected to a voltage source draw together, the voltage across the capacitive members remains substantially constant. To maintain the constant voltage despite increasing capacitance, additional charge flows into the capacitive members as the capacitance of the actuator increases. - The
display apparatus 100 provides high-quality video images using relatively low power. The optical throughput efficiency of a shutter-based light valve can be an order of magnitude higher than afforded by liquid crystal displays, because there is no need for polarizers or color filters in the production of the image. As described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/218,690, filed on Sep. 2, 2005, a regenerative light guide can be designed which allows for 75% of the light produced in a backlight to be made available to a viewer. - Without the use of color filters, one method for producing video images in a shutter-based display is the use of field-sequential color. Color filters reduce the optical efficiency by >60% through absorption in the filters. Displays utilizing field sequential color instead use a backlight which produces pure red, green and blue light in an ordered sequence. A separate image is generated for each color. When the separate color images are alternated at frequencies in excess of 50 Hz, the human eye averages the images to produce the perception of a single image with a broad and continuous range of colors. Efficient backlights can now be produced that allow fast switching between pure colors from either light-emitting diode (LED) sources or electroluminescent sources.
- The control matrices illustrated in
FIGS. 5 , 6, 7, 9, 11, 13-19 provide means for generating color-specific images (color sub-frame images), with accurate gray-tones, and the means for switching between color images in rapid fashion. - Formation of accurate images with field-sequential color can be improved by synchronization between the backlight and the pixel addressing process, especially since it requires a finite period of time to switch or reset each pixel between the required states of each color sub-frame. Depending on the control matrix used to address and actuate the pixels, if the option of global actuation is not employed, then the image controller may need to pause at each row or scan line of the display long enough for the mechanical switching or actuation to complete in each row. If the backlight were to broadly illuminate the whole display in a single color while the display controller was switching states, row by row, between 2 color images, then the resulting contrast would be confused.
- Consider two examples illustrating the blanking times that can be employed with the backlight during resetting of an image between colors in a synchronized display. If the shutters require 20 microseconds to actuate or move between open and closed states, if the shutters are actuated in a row-by-row fashion, and if there are 100 rows, then it would require 2 milliseconds to complete the addressing. The synchronized backlight might then be turned-off during those 2 milliseconds. Note that if the display runs at a 60 Hz frame rate with 3 colors per frame, then there is only 5.6 msec allowed per color sub-frame and, in this example, the backlight would be off 36% of the time.
- Alternately, when using a global actuation scheme for switching between color sub-frames, the same resetting of the image would require only 20 microseconds for the simultaneous movement of all shutters between images. The requirements for shutter speed are now substantially relaxed. If, during the color reset, the backlight were to be off for as much as 100 microseconds, the percentage of illumination time at 60 Hz frame rate is now better than 98%. Assuming a 100 microsecond image refresh time, it is now possible to increase the frame rate to 120 Hz with no substantial loss in illumination time. Using a frame rate of 120 Hz substantially reduces image artifacts induced by field sequential color, such as color breakup in fast moving video images.
- The number of unique colors available in the display is dependant in part on the levels of gray scale that are available within each of the three color images. Four principle methods of producing gray scale and combinations thereof are applicable to the transverse shutter displays.
- The first method of producing gray scale is an analog method, by which the shutters are caused to only partially obstruct an aperture in proportion to the application of a partial actuation voltage. Transverse shutters can be designed such that the percent of transmitted light is proportional to an actuation voltage, for instance through control of the shape of the actuation electrodes as described above in relation to
FIG. 2 and in more detail in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035 referenced above. - For analog gray scale, the display apparatus is equipped with a digital to analog converter such that the voltage delivered to the pixels is proportional to the intended gray scale level. The proportional voltage on each actuator is maintained throughout the period of an image frame such that the proportional shutter position is maintained throughout the illumination period. The optional use of a capacitor placed in parallel with the actuators in
FIGS. 2 and 17 helps to ensure that, even though some charge may leak from the pixel during the time of illumination, the voltage does not change appreciably so as to alter the shutter position during the period of illumination. - The analog gray scale has the advantage of requiring only 1 shutter in motion per pixel and the setting of only 1 image frame during the period of each color illumination. The data rates and addressing speeds for analog gray scale are therefore the least demanding amongst all alternative methods of gray scale.
- With proper design of the transverse shutter, a low voltage switching can be achieved which is fast. Transversely driven shutter assemblies, as described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/251,035 referenced above, can be built having actuation times in the range of 3 microseconds to 100 microseconds. Such rapid actuation makes possible the implementation of time division gray scale, wherein the contrast is achieved by controlling the relative on-times or duty cycles of the actuated shutters. A time division gray scale can be implemented using digital gray scale coding, in that control matrices incorporating bi-stable shutter assemblies recognize two states of shutter actuation, on or off. Gray scale is achieved by controlling the length of time a shutter is open.
- The switching times can be appreciated by assuming the case of a 60 Hz frame rate with field sequential color. Each color sub-frame is allotted 5.6 msec. If the available time interval were to be divided into 63 segments (6-bit gray scale per color), then the smallest increment of on-time for each image, known as the least significant bit time (LSB), would be 88 microseconds. If an image for the LSB time-bit were to be constructed and displayed using a global actuation scheme, then the actuation of all shutters would need to be completed in significantly less than the 88 microsecond LSB time. If the display is addressed in a row-by-row basis then the time available for reset at each row is considerably less. For a display with 100 rows, the available actuation time can be less than 0.5 microseconds per row. A number of controller algorithms are possible for relaxing the time intervals required for addressing shutters in a row-by-row scheme (see for example N. A. Clark et al., Ferroelectrics, v. 46, p. 97 (2000)), but in any case the time required for shutter actuation in the 6-bit gray scale example is considerably less than 20 microseconds.
- Achieving multiple bits of gray scale through the use of time division multiplexing requires significant power in the addressing circuitry, since the energy lost in the actuation cycle is ½ CV2 for each pixel through each refresh or addressing cycle in the control scheme (C is the capacitance of the pixel plus control electrodes and V is the actuation voltage). The circuit diagrams of FIGS. 11 and 13-19 reduce power requirements by decoupling and reducing the addressing voltages (the voltages required on the scan lines and data lines) from the actuation voltages (the voltages required to move a shutter).
- Another method that can reduce the addressing speed and power requirements of the time division gray scale is to allow for multiple shutters and actuators per pixel. A 6 bit binary time-division scheme (63 required time slots) can be reduced to a 5 bit time scheme (31 required time slots) by adding the availability of an additional gray scale bit in the spatial or area domain. The additional spatial bit can be accomplished with 2 shutters and apertures per pixel, especially if the shutters/apertures have unequal area. Similarly, if 4 shutters (with unequal areas) are available per pixel then the number of required time bits can be reduced to 3 with the result still being an effective 64 levels of gray scale per color.
- Another method that can relax the speed and/or real estate requirements for the above gray scale techniques is use of an illumination gray scale. The contrast achieved through the illumination of the color image can be adjusted or given finer gray levels by means of altered intensity from the backlight. If the backlight is capable of fast response (as in the case of LED backlights), then contrast can be achieved by either altering the brightness of the backlight or the duration of its illumination.
- Let us consider one example, wherein it is assumed that the control matrix utilizes a global actuation scheme and that time division gray scale is accomplished through construction and display of distinct time-bit images illuminated for differing lengths of time. Take for example a 4-bit binary time coding scheme accomplished by dividing the color frame into 15 time slots. The image that is constructed for the shortest (LSB) time should be held for 1/15 of the available frame time. In order to expand to a 5-bit coding scheme one could, in the time domain, divide the color frame into 31 time slots, requiring twice the addressing speed. Alternately, one could assign only 16 time slots and assign to one of these time slots an image that is illuminated at only ½ the brightness or by a backlight that is flashed for an on period of only 1/31 of the frame time. As many as 3 additional bits of gray scale can be added on top of a 4 bit time-division coding scheme by adding these short time-duration images accompanied by partial illumination. If the partial illumination bits are assigned to the smallest of the time slices, then a negligible loss of average projected brightness will result.
- The four principle means of gray scale are analog gray scale, time division gray scale, area division gray scale, and illumination gray scale. It should be understood that useful control schemes can be constructed by combinations of any of the above methods, for instance by combining the use of time division, area division and the use of partial illumination. Further divisions of gray scale are also available through interpolation techniques, also known as dither. Time domain dither includes the insertion of LSB time bits only in an alternating series of color frames. Spatial domain dither, also known as half-toning, involves the control or opening of a specified fraction of neighboring pixels to produce localized areas with only partial brightness.
- The invention may be embodied in other specific forms without departing from the spirit or essential characteristics thereof. The forgoing embodiments are therefore to be considered in all respects illustrative, rather than limiting of the invention.
Claims (21)
1. A display apparatus comprising:
a substrate;
an array of pixels, wherein each pixel includes:
at least one actuator; and
at least one MEMS device capable of modulating light, wherein each of the MEMS devices can be driven to at least three states, including: a substantially open state, a substantially closed state, and a partially open state; and
a control matrix for driving each of the MEMS devices in the array of pixels into one of the at least three states.
2. The display apparatus of claim 1 , wherein the control matrix drives a MEMS device into the substantially open state by applying an actuation voltage across the at least one actuator.
3. The display apparatus of claim 2 , wherein the control matrix drives a MEMS device into the substantially closed state by applying an actuation voltage across the at least one actuator.
4. The display apparatus of claim 3 , wherein the control matrix drives a MEMS device into the partially open state by applying an intermediate voltage across the at least one actuator.
5. The display apparatus of claim 4 , wherein the intermediate voltage is between a ground voltage and the actuation voltage.
6. The display apparatus of claim 3 , wherein the at least one actuator comprises opposing first and second actuators.
7. The display apparatus of claim 6 , wherein the control matrix drives a MEMS device into the partially open state by applying a pair of complementary voltages that, when applied simultaneously across the opposing first and second actuators, results in controlled states of partial opening.
8. The display apparatus of claim 1 , wherein the control matrix includes:
a plurality of scan-line interconnects running in a first direction, each enabling a plurality of pixels along the first direction to respond to data voltages; and
a plurality of data interconnects running in a second direction perpendicular to the first direction, each providing data voltages to a plurality of pixels along the second direction.
9. The display apparatus of claim 1 , wherein the substrate is transparent.
10. The display apparatus of claim 1 , wherein the MEMS device modulates light by moving transversely through a path of a propagating ray of light.
11. The display apparatus of claim 1 , further comprising a restoring spring opposing the at least one actuator.
12. The display apparatus of claim 1 , wherein the control matrix includes:
an actuation voltage interconnect for applying an actuation voltage to the at least one actuator;
a grayscale switch electrically connected between the actuation voltage interconnect and the at least one actuator; and
a data voltage interconnect coupled to the grayscale switch, wherein a data voltage on the data voltage interconnect controls the grayscale switch.
13. The display apparatus of claim 12 , wherein the actuation voltage applied to the at least one actuator varies in proportion to the data voltage resulting in an incremental displacement of the MEMS device.
14. The display apparatus of claim 13 , wherein the controller drives a MEMS device into one of the at least three states based at least in part on the magnitude of the data voltage applied to the data voltage interconnect.
15. The display apparatus of claim 14 , wherein the controller drives a MEMS device into one of the at least three states based at least in part on the duration of the data voltage applied to the data voltage interconnect.
16. The display apparatus of claim 12 , further comprising a data store capacitor electrically coupled to the data voltage interconnect for storing the data voltage corresponding to the one of at least three states of the MEMS device.
17. A method for displaying an image frame, comprising:
applying a write-enabling voltage to a scan-line interconnect in a first row of an array of MEMS devices;
applying a data voltage to at least one data-interconnect for a first MEMS device in the first row of the array; and
actuating the first MEMS device to drive the first MEMS device into the one of at least three states: a substantially open state, a substantially closed state, and a partially open state.
18. The method of claim 17 , wherein the partially open state includes a range of partially open states between the substantially open state and the substantially closed state.
19. The method of claim 18 , wherein the range of partially open states includes discrete ranges of partial MEMS device opening.
20. The method of claim 17 , wherein displacement of the MEMS device is proportional to the data voltage.
21. The method of claim 17 , wherein the data voltage comprises an analog data voltage.
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US13/551,025 US20120280971A1 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2012-07-17 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
Applications Claiming Priority (11)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US65582705P | 2005-02-23 | 2005-02-23 | |
US67605305P | 2005-04-29 | 2005-04-29 | |
US11/218,690 US7417782B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2005-09-02 | Methods and apparatus for spatial light modulation |
US11/251,035 US7271945B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2005-10-14 | Methods and apparatus for actuating displays |
US11/326,784 US7742016B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-01-06 | Display methods and apparatus |
US11/326,696 US9158106B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-01-06 | Display methods and apparatus |
US11/326,962 US7755582B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-01-06 | Display methods and apparatus |
US11/326,900 US8159428B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-01-06 | Display methods and apparatus |
US81123206P | 2006-06-05 | 2006-06-05 | |
US11/607,715 US8310442B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-12-01 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US13/551,025 US20120280971A1 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2012-07-17 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US11/607,715 Continuation US8310442B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-12-01 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20120280971A1 true US20120280971A1 (en) | 2012-11-08 |
Family
ID=37947895
Family Applications (3)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US11/607,715 Active 2028-11-04 US8310442B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-12-01 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US13/551,025 Abandoned US20120280971A1 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2012-07-17 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US13/617,112 Active US9336732B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2012-09-14 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
Family Applications Before (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US11/607,715 Active 2028-11-04 US8310442B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-12-01 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
Family Applications After (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US13/617,112 Active US9336732B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2012-09-14 | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
Country Status (1)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (3) | US8310442B2 (en) |
Cited By (20)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US8482496B2 (en) | 2006-01-06 | 2013-07-09 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling MEMS display apparatus on a transparent substrate |
US8519923B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2013-08-27 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display methods and apparatus |
US8519945B2 (en) | 2006-01-06 | 2013-08-27 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US8526096B2 (en) | 2006-02-23 | 2013-09-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Mechanical light modulators with stressed beams |
US8599463B2 (en) | 2008-10-27 | 2013-12-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | MEMS anchors |
US9082353B2 (en) | 2010-01-05 | 2015-07-14 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9087486B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-07-21 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9134552B2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2015-09-15 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus with narrow gap electrostatic actuators |
US9135868B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-09-15 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Direct-view MEMS display devices and methods for generating images thereon |
US9158106B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-10-13 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display methods and apparatus |
US9170421B2 (en) | 2013-02-05 | 2015-10-27 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus incorporating multi-level shutters |
US9176318B2 (en) | 2007-05-18 | 2015-11-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Methods for manufacturing fluid-filled MEMS displays |
US9229222B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-01-05 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Alignment methods in fluid-filled MEMS displays |
US9261694B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-02-16 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus and methods for manufacture thereof |
US9291813B2 (en) | 2010-12-20 | 2016-03-22 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Systems and methods for MEMS light modulator arrays with reduced acoustic emission |
US9336732B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-05-10 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9500853B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-11-22 | Snaptrack, Inc. | MEMS-based display apparatus |
US9857628B2 (en) | 2011-01-07 | 2018-01-02 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Display device |
US10685598B2 (en) | 2016-03-25 | 2020-06-16 | Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha | Display panel, display apparatus, and method for manufacturing display panel |
US11024656B2 (en) | 2016-06-28 | 2021-06-01 | Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha | Active matrix substrate, optical shutter substrate, display device, and method for manufacturing active matrix substrate |
Families Citing this family (95)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US8928967B2 (en) | 1998-04-08 | 2015-01-06 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Method and device for modulating light |
WO1999052006A2 (en) | 1998-04-08 | 1999-10-14 | Etalon, Inc. | Interferometric modulation of radiation |
US7417782B2 (en) * | 2005-02-23 | 2008-08-26 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for spatial light modulation |
US7161728B2 (en) * | 2003-12-09 | 2007-01-09 | Idc, Llc | Area array modulation and lead reduction in interferometric modulators |
US7755582B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2010-07-13 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Display methods and apparatus |
US7746529B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2010-06-29 | Pixtronix, Inc. | MEMS display apparatus |
US20080158635A1 (en) * | 2005-02-23 | 2008-07-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus and methods for manufacture thereof |
US7742016B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2010-06-22 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Display methods and apparatus |
US20060227080A1 (en) * | 2005-04-07 | 2006-10-12 | Cheermore Huang | Charge-recycling circuit of display device |
US7916980B2 (en) | 2006-01-13 | 2011-03-29 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Interconnect structure for MEMS device |
US20070182448A1 (en) * | 2006-01-20 | 2007-08-09 | Oh Kyong Kwon | Level shifter for flat panel display device |
US7876489B2 (en) | 2006-06-05 | 2011-01-25 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus with optical cavities |
EP2527903A1 (en) * | 2006-06-05 | 2012-11-28 | Pixtronix Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US7777715B2 (en) * | 2006-06-29 | 2010-08-17 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Passive circuits for de-multiplexing display inputs |
US7527998B2 (en) | 2006-06-30 | 2009-05-05 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Method of manufacturing MEMS devices providing air gap control |
US7629197B2 (en) * | 2006-10-18 | 2009-12-08 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Spatial light modulator |
EP2080045A1 (en) | 2006-10-20 | 2009-07-22 | Pixtronix Inc. | Light guides and backlight systems incorporating light redirectors at varying densities |
US7852546B2 (en) | 2007-10-19 | 2010-12-14 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Spacers for maintaining display apparatus alignment |
US7403180B1 (en) * | 2007-01-29 | 2008-07-22 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Hybrid color synthesis for multistate reflective modulator displays |
US8115987B2 (en) | 2007-02-01 | 2012-02-14 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Modulating the intensity of light from an interferometric reflector |
US7916378B2 (en) | 2007-03-08 | 2011-03-29 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Method and apparatus for providing a light absorbing mask in an interferometric modulator display |
US7742220B2 (en) * | 2007-03-28 | 2010-06-22 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Microelectromechanical device and method utilizing conducting layers separated by stops |
US7715085B2 (en) | 2007-05-09 | 2010-05-11 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Electromechanical system having a dielectric movable membrane and a mirror |
US7643202B2 (en) | 2007-05-09 | 2010-01-05 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Microelectromechanical system having a dielectric movable membrane and a mirror |
US8111262B2 (en) * | 2007-05-18 | 2012-02-07 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Interferometric modulator displays with reduced color sensitivity |
GB0709987D0 (en) * | 2007-05-24 | 2007-07-04 | Liquavista Bv | Electrowetting element, display device and control system |
US7782517B2 (en) * | 2007-06-21 | 2010-08-24 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Infrared and dual mode displays |
US7630121B2 (en) | 2007-07-02 | 2009-12-08 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Electromechanical device with optical function separated from mechanical and electrical function |
GB0712859D0 (en) | 2007-07-03 | 2007-08-08 | Liquavista Bv | Electrowetting system and method for operating it |
KR20100066452A (en) | 2007-07-31 | 2010-06-17 | 퀄컴 엠이엠스 테크놀로지스, 인크. | Devices for enhancing colour shift of interferometric modulators |
US8072402B2 (en) | 2007-08-29 | 2011-12-06 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Interferometric optical modulator with broadband reflection characteristics |
US7847999B2 (en) | 2007-09-14 | 2010-12-07 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Interferometric modulator display devices |
US7773286B2 (en) * | 2007-09-14 | 2010-08-10 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Periodic dimple array |
US8058549B2 (en) | 2007-10-19 | 2011-11-15 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Photovoltaic devices with integrated color interferometric film stacks |
CN101828146B (en) | 2007-10-19 | 2013-05-01 | 高通Mems科技公司 | Display with integrated photovoltaic device |
WO2009055393A1 (en) | 2007-10-23 | 2009-04-30 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Adjustably transmissive mems-based devices |
US8941631B2 (en) | 2007-11-16 | 2015-01-27 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Simultaneous light collection and illumination on an active display |
US7715079B2 (en) * | 2007-12-07 | 2010-05-11 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | MEMS devices requiring no mechanical support |
US8451298B2 (en) * | 2008-02-13 | 2013-05-28 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Multi-level stochastic dithering with noise mitigation via sequential template averaging |
US8164821B2 (en) | 2008-02-22 | 2012-04-24 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Microelectromechanical device with thermal expansion balancing layer or stiffening layer |
US7944604B2 (en) | 2008-03-07 | 2011-05-17 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Interferometric modulator in transmission mode |
US7612933B2 (en) | 2008-03-27 | 2009-11-03 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Microelectromechanical device with spacing layer |
US7898723B2 (en) | 2008-04-02 | 2011-03-01 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Microelectromechanical systems display element with photovoltaic structure |
US7969638B2 (en) | 2008-04-10 | 2011-06-28 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Device having thin black mask and method of fabricating the same |
US8248560B2 (en) | 2008-04-18 | 2012-08-21 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Light guides and backlight systems incorporating prismatic structures and light redirectors |
US7768690B2 (en) | 2008-06-25 | 2010-08-03 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Backlight displays |
US7746539B2 (en) * | 2008-06-25 | 2010-06-29 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Method for packing a display device and the device obtained thereof |
US7791783B2 (en) * | 2008-06-25 | 2010-09-07 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Backlight displays |
US8023167B2 (en) | 2008-06-25 | 2011-09-20 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Backlight displays |
US7859740B2 (en) * | 2008-07-11 | 2010-12-28 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Stiction mitigation with integrated mech micro-cantilevers through vertical stress gradient control |
US7920317B2 (en) | 2008-08-04 | 2011-04-05 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display with controlled formation of bubbles |
US7855826B2 (en) | 2008-08-12 | 2010-12-21 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Method and apparatus to reduce or eliminate stiction and image retention in interferometric modulator devices |
US8358266B2 (en) | 2008-09-02 | 2013-01-22 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Light turning device with prismatic light turning features |
US8270056B2 (en) | 2009-03-23 | 2012-09-18 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Display device with openings between sub-pixels and method of making same |
US8556972B2 (en) * | 2009-04-02 | 2013-10-15 | Sevika Holding AG | Monolithic orthopedic implant with an articular finished surface |
US20100256758A1 (en) * | 2009-04-02 | 2010-10-07 | Synvasive Technology, Inc. | Monolithic orthopedic implant with an articular finished surface |
WO2010138765A1 (en) | 2009-05-29 | 2010-12-02 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Illumination devices and methods of fabrication thereof |
WO2010141767A1 (en) * | 2009-06-05 | 2010-12-09 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | System and method for improving the quality of halftone video using an adaptive threshold |
US7990604B2 (en) * | 2009-06-15 | 2011-08-02 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Analog interferometric modulator |
KR20110002751A (en) * | 2009-07-02 | 2011-01-10 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Display device and driving method thereof |
US8270062B2 (en) | 2009-09-17 | 2012-09-18 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Display device with at least one movable stop element |
US8488228B2 (en) | 2009-09-28 | 2013-07-16 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Interferometric display with interferometric reflector |
US8310421B2 (en) * | 2010-01-06 | 2012-11-13 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Display drive switch configuration |
CN102834763B (en) | 2010-02-02 | 2015-07-22 | 皮克斯特罗尼克斯公司 | Methods for manufacturing cold seal fluid-filled display apparatus |
BR112012022900A2 (en) | 2010-03-11 | 2018-06-05 | Pixtronix Inc | Transflexive and reflective modes of operation for a display device |
EP2556403A1 (en) | 2010-04-09 | 2013-02-13 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Mechanical layer of an electromechanical device and methods of forming the same |
KR101701234B1 (en) * | 2010-07-30 | 2017-02-02 | 삼성디스플레이 주식회사 | Display panel, method of driving the display panel and display device performing the method |
JP2013544370A (en) | 2010-08-17 | 2013-12-12 | クォルコム・メムズ・テクノロジーズ・インコーポレーテッド | Operation and calibration of charge neutral electrodes in interference display devices |
US9057872B2 (en) | 2010-08-31 | 2015-06-16 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Dielectric enhanced mirror for IMOD display |
US8963159B2 (en) | 2011-04-04 | 2015-02-24 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Pixel via and methods of forming the same |
US9134527B2 (en) | 2011-04-04 | 2015-09-15 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Pixel via and methods of forming the same |
US8659816B2 (en) | 2011-04-25 | 2014-02-25 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Mechanical layer and methods of making the same |
US9196189B2 (en) | 2011-05-13 | 2015-11-24 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display devices and methods for generating images thereon |
US9235047B2 (en) | 2011-06-01 | 2016-01-12 | Pixtronix, Inc. | MEMS display pixel control circuits and methods |
US9239457B2 (en) | 2011-07-15 | 2016-01-19 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9809445B2 (en) * | 2011-08-26 | 2017-11-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Electromechanical system structures with ribs having gaps |
US9159277B2 (en) * | 2011-09-20 | 2015-10-13 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling an array of light modulators of a display apparatus to generate display images |
KR20130033805A (en) * | 2011-09-27 | 2013-04-04 | 삼성디스플레이 주식회사 | Display apparatus |
US8736939B2 (en) | 2011-11-04 | 2014-05-27 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Matching layer thin-films for an electromechanical systems reflective display device |
US9128289B2 (en) | 2012-12-28 | 2015-09-08 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus incorporating high-aspect ratio electrical interconnects |
US20140071142A1 (en) * | 2012-09-13 | 2014-03-13 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus incorporating vertically oriented electrical interconnects |
US9030723B2 (en) * | 2013-01-18 | 2015-05-12 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Asymmetric travel for MEMS light modulator |
US9135867B2 (en) | 2013-04-01 | 2015-09-15 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display element pixel circuit with voltage equalization |
US9967546B2 (en) | 2013-10-29 | 2018-05-08 | Vefxi Corporation | Method and apparatus for converting 2D-images and videos to 3D for consumer, commercial and professional applications |
US20150116458A1 (en) | 2013-10-30 | 2015-04-30 | Barkatech Consulting, LLC | Method and apparatus for generating enhanced 3d-effects for real-time and offline appplications |
KR102135677B1 (en) | 2013-11-28 | 2020-07-20 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Image sensor and method of driving image sensor |
US20150194083A1 (en) * | 2014-01-03 | 2015-07-09 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Adaptive power-efficient high-speed data link between display controller and component on glass driver ics |
US20150192772A1 (en) * | 2014-01-06 | 2015-07-09 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display aperture pixel circuit architecture including planarization layer |
US10158847B2 (en) | 2014-06-19 | 2018-12-18 | Vefxi Corporation | Real—time stereo 3D and autostereoscopic 3D video and image editing |
CN104112427B (en) * | 2014-07-21 | 2017-10-13 | 京东方科技集团股份有限公司 | Image element circuit and its driving method and display device |
CN104464632B (en) * | 2014-12-24 | 2017-01-11 | 京东方科技集团股份有限公司 | Pixel structure, manufacturing method thereof, pixel display method and array substrate |
US10078986B2 (en) * | 2015-09-15 | 2018-09-18 | Sharp Life Science (Eu) Limited | Active matrix device and method of driving |
US10720095B2 (en) * | 2017-11-07 | 2020-07-21 | Shenzhen China Star Optoelectronics Semiconductor Display Technology Co., Ltd. | Method of potential regulation of display panel, potential regulation system and storage apparatus |
WO2020028247A1 (en) * | 2018-08-03 | 2020-02-06 | North Carolina State University | Actuated polymer-based dielectric mirrors |
CN109658891B (en) * | 2019-01-30 | 2020-08-18 | 惠科股份有限公司 | Drive circuit, display panel and display device |
Citations (3)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6428173B1 (en) * | 1999-05-03 | 2002-08-06 | Jds Uniphase, Inc. | Moveable microelectromechanical mirror structures and associated methods |
US6798935B2 (en) * | 2000-02-25 | 2004-09-28 | Colibrys S.A. | Switching device, particularly for optical switching |
US20070052636A1 (en) * | 2002-02-09 | 2007-03-08 | Kalt Charles G | Flexible video displays and their manufacture |
Family Cites Families (783)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US3864582A (en) * | 1973-01-22 | 1975-02-04 | Timex Corp | Mosfet dynamic circuit |
US4074253A (en) | 1975-11-19 | 1978-02-14 | Kenneth E. Macklin | Novel bistable light modulators and display element and arrays therefrom |
US4067043A (en) | 1976-01-21 | 1978-01-03 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Administrator Of The National Aeronautics And Space Administration | Optical conversion method |
CH633902A5 (en) | 1980-03-11 | 1982-12-31 | Centre Electron Horloger | LIGHT MODULATION DEVICE. |
US4421381A (en) | 1980-04-04 | 1983-12-20 | Yokogawa Hokushin Electric Corp. | Mechanical vibrating element |
JPS5762028A (en) | 1980-10-01 | 1982-04-14 | Hitachi Ltd | Manufacture of liquid crystal display element |
JPS63106Y2 (en) | 1980-10-25 | 1988-01-05 | ||
JPS5828291Y2 (en) | 1981-02-02 | 1983-06-20 | 株式会社 小林記録紙製造所 | optically readable form |
US4563836A (en) | 1981-04-06 | 1986-01-14 | American Cyanamid Co. | Insect feeding station |
CH641315B (en) | 1981-07-02 | Centre Electron Horloger | MINIATURE SHUTTER DISPLAY DEVICE. | |
US4559535A (en) | 1982-07-12 | 1985-12-17 | Sigmatron Nova, Inc. | System for displaying information with multiple shades of a color on a thin-film EL matrix display panel |
JPS5933077U (en) | 1982-08-23 | 1984-02-29 | 株式会社小糸製作所 | LCD display |
US4582396A (en) | 1983-05-09 | 1986-04-15 | Tektronix, Inc. | Field sequential color display system using optical retardation |
JPS6079331A (en) | 1983-10-07 | 1985-05-07 | Citizen Watch Co Ltd | Manufacture of color liquid crystal display device |
US5096279A (en) | 1984-08-31 | 1992-03-17 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Spatial light modulator and method |
US5061049A (en) | 1984-08-31 | 1991-10-29 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Spatial light modulator and method |
US4744640A (en) | 1985-08-29 | 1988-05-17 | Motorola Inc. | PLZT multi-shutter color electrode pattern |
US4728936A (en) | 1986-04-11 | 1988-03-01 | Adt, Inc. | Control and display system |
US5835255A (en) | 1986-04-23 | 1998-11-10 | Etalon, Inc. | Visible spectrum modulator arrays |
JPS62275230A (en) | 1986-05-23 | 1987-11-30 | Nippon Telegr & Teleph Corp <Ntt> | Optical gate matrix switch |
GB8728433D0 (en) | 1987-12-04 | 1988-01-13 | Emi Plc Thorn | Display device |
US4907132A (en) | 1988-03-22 | 1990-03-06 | Lumitex, Inc. | Light emitting panel assemblies and method of making same |
US4991941A (en) | 1988-06-13 | 1991-02-12 | Kaiser Aerospace & Electronics Corporation | Method and apparatus for multi-color display |
US5042900A (en) | 1988-09-12 | 1991-08-27 | Lumitex, Inc. | Connector assemblies for optical fiber light cables |
CA1335889C (en) | 1988-10-07 | 1995-06-13 | Mahmoud A. Gawad | Small profile luminaire having adjustable photometric distribution |
US4958911A (en) | 1988-10-19 | 1990-09-25 | Jonand, Inc. | Liquid crystal display module having housing of C-shaped cross section |
US5986828A (en) | 1988-11-01 | 1999-11-16 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Army | Optical power limiter utilizing nonlinear refraction |
EP0366847A3 (en) | 1988-11-02 | 1991-01-09 | Sportsoft Systems, Inc. | Graphics display using biomorphs |
US4889603A (en) | 1988-12-09 | 1989-12-26 | Copytele, Inc. | Method of eliminating gas bubbles in an electrophoretic display |
DE3842900C1 (en) | 1988-12-16 | 1990-05-10 | Krone Ag, 1000 Berlin, De | |
US5005108A (en) | 1989-02-10 | 1991-04-02 | Lumitex, Inc. | Thin panel illuminator |
US5025346A (en) | 1989-02-17 | 1991-06-18 | Regents Of The University Of California | Laterally driven resonant microstructures |
US5446479A (en) | 1989-02-27 | 1995-08-29 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Multi-dimensional array video processor system |
EP0438614A1 (en) | 1990-01-23 | 1991-07-31 | Alternative Energy Research Center Inc. | Information display apparatus and method |
CH682523A5 (en) | 1990-04-20 | 1993-09-30 | Suisse Electronique Microtech | A modulation matrix addressed light. |
US5142405A (en) | 1990-06-29 | 1992-08-25 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Bistable dmd addressing circuit and method |
EP0467048B1 (en) | 1990-06-29 | 1995-09-20 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Field-updated deformable mirror device |
US5184248A (en) | 1990-07-16 | 1993-02-02 | U.S. Philips Corporation | Image projection apparatus |
US5990990A (en) | 1990-08-03 | 1999-11-23 | Crabtree; Allen F. | Three-dimensional display techniques, device, systems and method of presenting data in a volumetric format |
US5319491A (en) | 1990-08-10 | 1994-06-07 | Continental Typographics, Inc. | Optical display |
US5062689A (en) | 1990-08-21 | 1991-11-05 | Koehler Dale R | Electrostatically actuatable light modulating device |
US5202950A (en) | 1990-09-27 | 1993-04-13 | Compaq Computer Corporation | Backlighting system with faceted light pipes |
US5050946A (en) | 1990-09-27 | 1991-09-24 | Compaq Computer Corporation | Faceted light pipe |
US5128787A (en) | 1990-12-07 | 1992-07-07 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Lcd display with multifaceted back reflector |
DE69122075T2 (en) | 1991-01-16 | 1997-04-03 | Lumitex Inc | Thin plate lamp |
US5233459A (en) | 1991-03-06 | 1993-08-03 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Electric display device |
DE4110209C2 (en) | 1991-03-28 | 1993-11-18 | Roland Man Druckmasch | Device for adjusting a CNC-controlled grinding machine |
CA2063744C (en) | 1991-04-01 | 2002-10-08 | Paul M. Urbanus | Digital micromirror device architecture and timing for use in a pulse-width modulated display system |
US5136751A (en) | 1991-04-30 | 1992-08-11 | Master Manufacturing Co. | Wheel assembly |
US5579035A (en) | 1991-07-05 | 1996-11-26 | Technomarket, L.P. | Liquid crystal display module |
JP3158667B2 (en) | 1991-08-01 | 2001-04-23 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Method of manufacturing liquid crystal display element and method of reproducing liquid crystal display element |
US5233385A (en) | 1991-12-18 | 1993-08-03 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | White light enhanced color field sequential projection |
US5245454A (en) | 1991-12-31 | 1993-09-14 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Lcd display with microtextured back reflector and method for making same |
JPH05188337A (en) | 1992-01-09 | 1993-07-30 | Minolta Camera Co Ltd | Optical shutter array |
KR960010845B1 (en) | 1992-01-18 | 1996-08-09 | 제일모직 주식회사 | Epoxy resin composition for encapsulating semiconductor element |
US5198730A (en) | 1992-01-29 | 1993-03-30 | Vancil Bernard K | Color display tube |
JPH0579530U (en) | 1992-03-24 | 1993-10-29 | 日本ビクター株式会社 | Display system optics |
US5655832A (en) | 1992-04-16 | 1997-08-12 | Tir Technologies, Inc. | Multiple wavelength light processor |
JPH06174929A (en) | 1992-05-15 | 1994-06-24 | Fujitsu Ltd | Backlight device and condenser |
US5231559A (en) | 1992-05-22 | 1993-07-27 | Kalt Charles G | Full color light modulating capacitor |
US5499127A (en) | 1992-05-25 | 1996-03-12 | Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha | Liquid crystal display device having a larger gap between the substrates in the display area than in the sealant area |
DK69492D0 (en) | 1992-05-26 | 1992-05-26 | Purup Prepress As | DEVICE FOR EXPOSURE OF A MEDIUM, DEVICE FOR POINT EXPOSURE OF A MEDIA, AND A DEVICE FOR HOLDING A MEDIA |
NL194848C (en) | 1992-06-01 | 2003-04-03 | Samsung Electronics Co Ltd | Liquid crystal indicator device. |
US5568964A (en) | 1992-07-10 | 1996-10-29 | Lumitex, Inc. | Fiber optic light emitting panel assemblies and methods of making such panel assemblies |
US5724062A (en) | 1992-08-05 | 1998-03-03 | Cree Research, Inc. | High resolution, high brightness light emitting diode display and method and producing the same |
US5359345A (en) | 1992-08-05 | 1994-10-25 | Cree Research, Inc. | Shuttered and cycled light emitting diode display and method of producing the same |
US5319061A (en) | 1992-08-07 | 1994-06-07 | The Humphrey Chemical Co., Inc. | Imparting moisture resistance to epoxies |
US5493439A (en) | 1992-09-29 | 1996-02-20 | Engle; Craig D. | Enhanced surface deformation light modulator |
US5339179A (en) | 1992-10-01 | 1994-08-16 | International Business Machines Corp. | Edge-lit transflective non-emissive display with angled interface means on both sides of light conducting panel |
US6008781A (en) | 1992-10-22 | 1999-12-28 | Board Of Regents Of The University Of Washington | Virtual retinal display |
US5467104A (en) | 1992-10-22 | 1995-11-14 | Board Of Regents Of The University Of Washington | Virtual retinal display |
US5596339A (en) | 1992-10-22 | 1997-01-21 | University Of Washington | Virtual retinal display with fiber optic point source |
KR960001941B1 (en) | 1992-11-10 | 1996-02-08 | 재단법인한국전자통신연구소 | Plate display device |
KR950010659B1 (en) | 1992-11-10 | 1995-09-21 | 재단법인한국전자통신연구소 | Micro light shutter and manufacturing method thereof |
GB2272555A (en) | 1992-11-11 | 1994-05-18 | Sharp Kk | Stereoscopic display using a light modulator |
DE69330425T2 (en) | 1992-11-27 | 2001-10-25 | Yasuhiro Koike | DEVICE FOR GUIDING SPREADED LIGHTS |
CN1057614C (en) | 1993-01-11 | 2000-10-18 | 德克萨斯仪器股份有限公司 | Pixel control circuitry for spatial light modulator |
US5528262A (en) | 1993-01-21 | 1996-06-18 | Fakespace, Inc. | Method for line field-sequential color video display |
JP2555922B2 (en) | 1993-02-26 | 1996-11-20 | 日本電気株式会社 | Electrostatically driven micro shutters and shutter arrays |
US6674562B1 (en) | 1994-05-05 | 2004-01-06 | Iridigm Display Corporation | Interferometric modulation of radiation |
US5810469A (en) | 1993-03-26 | 1998-09-22 | Weinreich; Steve | Combination light concentrating and collimating device and light fixture and display screen employing the same |
US5461411A (en) | 1993-03-29 | 1995-10-24 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Process and architecture for digital micromirror printer |
US5477086A (en) | 1993-04-30 | 1995-12-19 | Lsi Logic Corporation | Shaped, self-aligning micro-bump structures |
GB2278480A (en) | 1993-05-25 | 1994-11-30 | Sharp Kk | Optical apparatus |
US5884872A (en) | 1993-05-26 | 1999-03-23 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Navy | Oscillating flap lift enhancement device |
US5622612A (en) | 1993-06-02 | 1997-04-22 | Duracell Inc. | Method of preparing current collectors for electrochemical cells |
US5510824A (en) | 1993-07-26 | 1996-04-23 | Texas Instruments, Inc. | Spatial light modulator array |
US5552925A (en) | 1993-09-07 | 1996-09-03 | John M. Baker | Electro-micro-mechanical shutters on transparent substrates |
FR2709854B1 (en) | 1993-09-07 | 1995-10-06 | Sextant Avionique | Visualization device with optimized colors. |
US5564959A (en) | 1993-09-08 | 1996-10-15 | Silicon Video Corporation | Use of charged-particle tracks in fabricating gated electron-emitting devices |
US5559389A (en) | 1993-09-08 | 1996-09-24 | Silicon Video Corporation | Electron-emitting devices having variously constituted electron-emissive elements, including cones or pedestals |
US5440197A (en) | 1993-10-05 | 1995-08-08 | Tir Technologies, Inc. | Backlighting apparatus for uniformly illuminating a display panel |
US5526051A (en) | 1993-10-27 | 1996-06-11 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Digital television system |
US5452024A (en) | 1993-11-01 | 1995-09-19 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | DMD display system |
US5894686A (en) | 1993-11-04 | 1999-04-20 | Lumitex, Inc. | Light distribution/information display systems |
US5396350A (en) | 1993-11-05 | 1995-03-07 | Alliedsignal Inc. | Backlighting apparatus employing an array of microprisms |
US5517347A (en) | 1993-12-01 | 1996-05-14 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Direct view deformable mirror device |
US5798746A (en) | 1993-12-27 | 1998-08-25 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Liquid crystal display device |
JPH07212639A (en) | 1994-01-25 | 1995-08-11 | Sony Corp | Electronic shutter device for television cameras |
US5504389A (en) | 1994-03-08 | 1996-04-02 | Planar Systems, Inc. | Black electrode TFEL display |
US5729038A (en) | 1995-12-15 | 1998-03-17 | Harris Corporation | Silicon-glass bonded wafers |
US5465054A (en) | 1994-04-08 | 1995-11-07 | Vivid Semiconductor, Inc. | High voltage CMOS logic using low voltage CMOS process |
US5629784A (en) | 1994-04-12 | 1997-05-13 | Ois Optical Imaging Systems, Inc. | Liquid crystal display with holographic diffuser and prism sheet on viewer side |
JP3102259B2 (en) | 1994-04-21 | 2000-10-23 | 株式会社村田製作所 | High voltage connector |
US5491347A (en) | 1994-04-28 | 1996-02-13 | Xerox Corporation | Thin-film structure with dense array of binary control units for presenting images |
US7123216B1 (en) | 1994-05-05 | 2006-10-17 | Idc, Llc | Photonic MEMS and structures |
US6040937A (en) | 1994-05-05 | 2000-03-21 | Etalon, Inc. | Interferometric modulation |
US7460291B2 (en) | 1994-05-05 | 2008-12-02 | Idc, Llc | Separable modulator |
US6710908B2 (en) | 1994-05-05 | 2004-03-23 | Iridigm Display Corporation | Controlling micro-electro-mechanical cavities |
US20010003487A1 (en) | 1996-11-05 | 2001-06-14 | Mark W. Miles | Visible spectrum modulator arrays |
US6680792B2 (en) | 1994-05-05 | 2004-01-20 | Iridigm Display Corporation | Interferometric modulation of radiation |
US7550794B2 (en) | 2002-09-20 | 2009-06-23 | Idc, Llc | Micromechanical systems device comprising a displaceable electrode and a charge-trapping layer |
JP3708583B2 (en) | 1994-05-16 | 2005-10-19 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Driving method of liquid crystal electro-optical device |
US5815134A (en) | 1994-05-16 | 1998-09-29 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Liquid crystal electro-optical device and driving method thereof |
US5497258A (en) | 1994-05-27 | 1996-03-05 | The Regents Of The University Of Colorado | Spatial light modulator including a VLSI chip and using solder for horizontal and vertical component positioning |
US5497172A (en) | 1994-06-13 | 1996-03-05 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Pulse width modulation for spatial light modulator with split reset addressing |
GB9411160D0 (en) | 1994-06-03 | 1994-07-27 | Land Infrared Ltd | Improvements relating to radiation thermometers |
US5694227A (en) | 1994-07-15 | 1997-12-02 | Apple Computer, Inc. | Method and apparatus for calibrating and adjusting a color imaging system |
JP3184069B2 (en) | 1994-09-02 | 2001-07-09 | シャープ株式会社 | Image display device |
JPH0895526A (en) | 1994-09-22 | 1996-04-12 | Casio Comput Co Ltd | Color liquid crystal display device for rgb field sequential display system |
DE69525236T2 (en) | 1994-10-18 | 2002-10-24 | Mitsubishi Rayon Co., Ltd. | Actinic radiation-curable composition and leaf-shaped lens |
FR2726135B1 (en) | 1994-10-25 | 1997-01-17 | Suisse Electronique Microtech | SWITCHING DEVICE |
JP3755911B2 (en) | 1994-11-15 | 2006-03-15 | 富士通株式会社 | Semiconductor circuit |
US5808800A (en) | 1994-12-22 | 1998-09-15 | Displaytech, Inc. | Optics arrangements including light source arrangements for an active matrix liquid crystal image generator |
US5596369A (en) | 1995-01-24 | 1997-01-21 | Lsi Logic Corporation | Statistically derived method and system for decoding MPEG motion compensation and transform coded video data |
US5504614A (en) | 1995-01-31 | 1996-04-02 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Method for fabricating a DMD spatial light modulator with a hardened hinge |
US6111560A (en) | 1995-04-18 | 2000-08-29 | Cambridge Display Technology Limited | Display with a light modulator and a light source |
US6424388B1 (en) | 1995-04-28 | 2002-07-23 | International Business Machines Corporation | Reflective spatial light modulator array |
JPH11507748A (en) | 1995-06-07 | 1999-07-06 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Computer with video display controller having power saving mode |
US6969635B2 (en) | 2000-12-07 | 2005-11-29 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Methods for depositing, releasing and packaging micro-electromechanical devices on wafer substrates |
US5835256A (en) | 1995-06-19 | 1998-11-10 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Reflective spatial light modulator with encapsulated micro-mechanical elements |
US6046840A (en) | 1995-06-19 | 2000-04-04 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Double substrate reflective spatial light modulator with self-limiting micro-mechanical elements |
US6952301B2 (en) | 1995-06-19 | 2005-10-04 | Reflectivity, Inc | Spatial light modulators with light blocking and absorbing areas |
US7108414B2 (en) | 1995-06-27 | 2006-09-19 | Solid State Opto Limited | Light emitting panel assemblies |
US6712481B2 (en) | 1995-06-27 | 2004-03-30 | Solid State Opto Limited | Light emitting panel assemblies |
US5975711A (en) | 1995-06-27 | 1999-11-02 | Lumitex, Inc. | Integrated display panel assemblies |
US5613751A (en) | 1995-06-27 | 1997-03-25 | Lumitex, Inc. | Light emitting panel assemblies |
US6185356B1 (en) | 1995-06-27 | 2001-02-06 | Lumitex, Inc. | Protective cover for a lighting device |
US20020058931A1 (en) | 1995-06-27 | 2002-05-16 | Jeffrey R. Parker | Light delivery system and applications thereof |
US20040135273A1 (en) | 1995-06-27 | 2004-07-15 | Parker Jeffery R. | Methods of making a pattern of optical element shapes on a roll for use in making optical elements on or in substrates |
US5959598A (en) | 1995-07-20 | 1999-09-28 | The Regents Of The University Of Colorado | Pixel buffer circuits for implementing improved methods of displaying grey-scale or color images |
EP0757958A1 (en) | 1995-08-07 | 1997-02-12 | Societe Des Produits Nestle S.A. | Multi-pack of units held together by means of an adhesive sticker |
DE19530121A1 (en) | 1995-08-16 | 1997-02-20 | Fev Motorentech Gmbh & Co Kg | Reduction of impact velocity method for armature impacting on to electromagnetic actuator |
US5801792A (en) | 1995-12-13 | 1998-09-01 | Swz Engineering Ltd. | High resolution, high intensity video projection cathode ray tube provided with a cooled reflective phosphor screen support |
JP3799092B2 (en) | 1995-12-29 | 2006-07-19 | アジレント・テクノロジーズ・インク | Light modulation device and display device |
US5771321A (en) | 1996-01-04 | 1998-06-23 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Micromechanical optical switch and flat panel display |
US5895115A (en) | 1996-01-16 | 1999-04-20 | Lumitex, Inc. | Light emitting panel assemblies for use in automotive applications and the like |
JPH09218360A (en) | 1996-02-08 | 1997-08-19 | Ricoh Co Ltd | Mechanical optical shutter |
JP2001502247A (en) | 1996-02-10 | 2001-02-20 | フラウンホーファー―ゲゼルシャフト、ツール、フェルデルング、デァ、アンゲヴァンテン、フォルシュング、アインゲトラーゲネル、フェライン | Bistable microactuator with membrane connection |
US5745284A (en) | 1996-02-23 | 1998-04-28 | President And Fellows Of Harvard College | Solid-state laser source of tunable narrow-bandwidth ultraviolet radiation |
TW395121B (en) | 1996-02-26 | 2000-06-21 | Seiko Epson Corp | Personal wearing information display device and the display method using such device |
US5745203A (en) | 1996-03-28 | 1998-04-28 | Motorola, Inc. | Liquid crystal display device including multiple ambient light illumination modes with switchable holographic optical element |
DE69735860T2 (en) | 1996-04-17 | 2006-12-28 | Huntsman Advanced Materials (Switzerland) Gmbh | Device for light control |
FR2747802B1 (en) | 1996-04-18 | 1998-05-15 | Commissariat Energie Atomique | OPTOMECHANICAL MICRODISPOSITIVE, AND APPLICATION TO AN OPTOMECHANICAL MICRODEFLECTOR |
US5731802A (en) | 1996-04-22 | 1998-03-24 | Silicon Light Machines | Time-interleaved bit-plane, pulse-width-modulation digital display system |
JPH09292576A (en) | 1996-04-25 | 1997-11-11 | Casio Comput Co Ltd | Optical control element and display device using the same |
FR2748578B1 (en) | 1996-05-10 | 1998-05-29 | Commissariat Energie Atomique | OPTOMECHANICAL DEVICE AND APPLICATION TO SENSORS IN INTEGRATED OPTICS |
US5691695A (en) | 1996-07-24 | 1997-11-25 | United Technologies Automotive Systems, Inc. | Vehicle information display on steering wheel surface |
WO1998004950A1 (en) | 1996-07-25 | 1998-02-05 | Anvik Corporation | Seamless, maskless lithography system using spatial light modulator |
JP4050802B2 (en) | 1996-08-02 | 2008-02-20 | シチズン電子株式会社 | Color display device |
JP3442581B2 (en) | 1996-08-06 | 2003-09-02 | 株式会社ヒューネット | Driving method of nematic liquid crystal |
US5781333A (en) | 1996-08-20 | 1998-07-14 | Lanzillotta; John | Piezoelectric light shutter |
US5884083A (en) | 1996-09-20 | 1999-03-16 | Royce; Robert | Computer system to compile non-incremental computer source code to execute within an incremental type computer system |
US5854872A (en) | 1996-10-08 | 1998-12-29 | Clio Technologies, Inc. | Divergent angle rotator system and method for collimating light beams |
US6028656A (en) | 1996-10-09 | 2000-02-22 | Cambridge Research & Instrumentation Inc. | Optical polarization switch and method of using same |
WO1998019201A1 (en) | 1996-10-29 | 1998-05-07 | Xeotron Corporation | Optical device utilizing optical waveguides and mechanical light-switches |
US6677936B2 (en) | 1996-10-31 | 2004-01-13 | Kopin Corporation | Color display system for a camera |
DE19730715C1 (en) | 1996-11-12 | 1998-11-26 | Fraunhofer Ges Forschung | Method of manufacturing a micromechanical relay |
US6046716A (en) | 1996-12-19 | 2000-04-04 | Colorado Microdisplay, Inc. | Display system having electrode modulation to alter a state of an electro-optic layer |
US7471444B2 (en) | 1996-12-19 | 2008-12-30 | Idc, Llc | Interferometric modulation of radiation |
JPH10186249A (en) | 1996-12-24 | 1998-07-14 | Casio Comput Co Ltd | Display device |
US5781331A (en) | 1997-01-24 | 1998-07-14 | Roxburgh Ltd. | Optical microshutter array |
JP3726441B2 (en) | 1997-03-18 | 2005-12-14 | 株式会社デンソー | Radar equipment |
JPH10282521A (en) | 1997-04-04 | 1998-10-23 | Sony Corp | Reflection type liquid crystal display device |
JP2877136B2 (en) | 1997-04-11 | 1999-03-31 | 日本電気株式会社 | Reflective color liquid crystal display |
ES2335452T3 (en) | 1997-04-14 | 2010-03-26 | Huntsman Advanced Materials (Switzerland) Gmbh | LIGHTING AND PROCEDURE UNIT FOR THE PUNCT LIGHTING OF A MEDIA. |
US5973727A (en) | 1997-05-13 | 1999-10-26 | New Light Industries, Ltd. | Video image viewing device and method |
US5986628A (en) | 1997-05-14 | 1999-11-16 | Planar Systems, Inc. | Field sequential color AMEL display |
US5889625A (en) | 1997-05-21 | 1999-03-30 | Raytheon Company | Chromatic aberration correction for display systems |
US6529250B1 (en) | 1997-05-22 | 2003-03-04 | Seiko Epson Corporation | Projector |
JPH10333145A (en) | 1997-05-30 | 1998-12-18 | Sanyo Electric Co Ltd | Liquid crystal display device equipped with lighting mechanism |
TW482921B (en) | 1997-06-16 | 2002-04-11 | Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd | Reflective liquid crystal display device |
US6137313A (en) | 1997-06-20 | 2000-10-24 | Altera Corporation | Resistive pull-up device for I/O pin |
GB9713658D0 (en) | 1997-06-28 | 1997-09-03 | Travis Adrian R L | View-sequential holographic display |
JP3840746B2 (en) | 1997-07-02 | 2006-11-01 | ソニー株式会社 | Image display device and image display method |
US6591049B2 (en) | 1997-07-02 | 2003-07-08 | Lumitex, Inc. | Light delivery systems and applications thereof |
US20050171408A1 (en) | 1997-07-02 | 2005-08-04 | Parker Jeffery R. | Light delivery systems and applications thereof |
US6852095B1 (en) | 1997-07-09 | 2005-02-08 | Charles D. Ray | Interbody device and method for treatment of osteoporotic vertebral collapse |
US6239777B1 (en) | 1997-07-22 | 2001-05-29 | Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba | Display device |
JPH1195693A (en) | 1997-07-22 | 1999-04-09 | Toshiba Corp | Display device |
US5867302A (en) | 1997-08-07 | 1999-02-02 | Sandia Corporation | Bistable microelectromechanical actuator |
US6214633B1 (en) | 1997-08-28 | 2001-04-10 | Mems Optical Inc. | System for controlling light including a micromachined foucault shutter array and a method of manufacturing the same |
JPH1184419A (en) | 1997-09-09 | 1999-03-26 | Hitachi Ltd | Liquid crystal light valve and projection type display device |
GB9719824D0 (en) | 1997-09-18 | 1997-11-19 | A P Valves | Self-contained breathing apparatus |
US5963367A (en) * | 1997-09-23 | 1999-10-05 | Lucent Technologies, Inc. | Micromechanical xyz stage for use with optical elements |
CA2306384A1 (en) | 1997-10-14 | 1999-04-22 | Patterning Technologies Limited | Method of forming an electronic device |
JP3371200B2 (en) | 1997-10-14 | 2003-01-27 | 富士通株式会社 | Display control method of liquid crystal display device and liquid crystal display device |
US5943223A (en) * | 1997-10-15 | 1999-08-24 | Reliance Electric Industrial Company | Electric switches for reducing on-state power loss |
JP4550175B2 (en) | 1997-10-23 | 2010-09-22 | 株式会社東芝 | Electronic device, backlight control method, and recording medium |
US6486997B1 (en) | 1997-10-28 | 2002-11-26 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Reflective LCD projection system using wide-angle Cartesian polarizing beam splitter |
US6127908A (en) | 1997-11-17 | 2000-10-03 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Microelectro-mechanical system actuator device and reconfigurable circuits utilizing same |
WO1999028890A1 (en) | 1997-11-29 | 1999-06-10 | Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. | Display device comprising a light guide |
GB9727148D0 (en) | 1997-12-22 | 1998-02-25 | Fki Plc | Improvemnts in and relating to electomagnetic actuators |
JP4118389B2 (en) | 1997-12-29 | 2008-07-16 | 日本ライツ株式会社 | Light guide plate and flat illumination device |
JPH11202325A (en) | 1998-01-08 | 1999-07-30 | Seiko Instruments Inc | Reflection type liquid crystal display device and production therefor |
US6473220B1 (en) | 1998-01-22 | 2002-10-29 | Trivium Technologies, Inc. | Film having transmissive and reflective properties |
US6282951B1 (en) | 1998-02-03 | 2001-09-04 | Dresser Industries, Inc. | Fluid flow system having a stress relief casing |
AUPP176898A0 (en) | 1998-02-12 | 1998-03-05 | Moldflow Pty Ltd | Automated machine technology for thermoplastic injection molding |
IL123579A0 (en) | 1998-03-06 | 1998-10-30 | Heines Amihai | Apparatus for producing high contrast imagery |
US6046836A (en) | 1998-03-06 | 2000-04-04 | Electro-Optical Products Corporation | Low frequency optical shutter |
JP3824290B2 (en) | 1998-05-07 | 2006-09-20 | 富士写真フイルム株式会社 | Array type light modulation element, array type exposure element, flat display, and method for driving array type light modulation element |
US6195196B1 (en) | 1998-03-13 | 2001-02-27 | Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd. | Array-type exposing device and flat type display incorporating light modulator and driving method thereof |
US6211521B1 (en) | 1998-03-13 | 2001-04-03 | Intel Corporation | Infrared pixel sensor and infrared signal correction |
JP3376308B2 (en) | 1998-03-16 | 2003-02-10 | 株式会社東芝 | Reflector and liquid crystal display |
JPH11271744A (en) | 1998-03-24 | 1999-10-08 | Minolta Co Ltd | Color liquid crystal display device |
US6710920B1 (en) | 1998-03-27 | 2004-03-23 | Sanyo Electric Co., Ltd | Stereoscopic display |
WO1999052006A2 (en) | 1998-04-08 | 1999-10-14 | Etalon, Inc. | Interferometric modulation of radiation |
JPH11296150A (en) | 1998-04-10 | 1999-10-29 | Masaya Okita | High-speed driving method for liquid crystal |
US20020163482A1 (en) | 1998-04-20 | 2002-11-07 | Alan Sullivan | Multi-planar volumetric display system including optical elements made from liquid crystal having polymer stabilized cholesteric textures |
US6329974B1 (en) | 1998-04-30 | 2001-12-11 | Agilent Technologies, Inc. | Electro-optical material-based display device having analog pixel drivers |
CA2294438A1 (en) | 1998-04-30 | 1999-11-11 | Hisashi Aoki | Display device using ambient light and a lighting panel |
US6249269B1 (en) | 1998-04-30 | 2001-06-19 | Agilent Technologies, Inc. | Analog pixel drive circuit for an electro-optical material-based display device |
US6459467B1 (en) | 1998-05-15 | 2002-10-01 | Minolta Co., Ltd. | Liquid crystal light modulating device, and a manufacturing method and a manufacturing apparatus thereof |
US20010040538A1 (en) | 1999-05-13 | 2001-11-15 | William A. Quanrud | Display system with multiplexed pixels |
US5995688A (en) | 1998-06-01 | 1999-11-30 | Lucent Technologies, Inc. | Micro-opto-electromechanical devices and method therefor |
JP3954198B2 (en) | 1998-06-01 | 2007-08-08 | 富士通株式会社 | Output circuit, level converter circuit, logic circuit, and operational amplifier circuit |
CA2334403A1 (en) | 1998-06-02 | 1999-12-09 | Rainer Glatzer | Flat display screen |
JP3428446B2 (en) | 1998-07-09 | 2003-07-22 | 富士通株式会社 | Plasma display panel and method of manufacturing the same |
JP2000028938A (en) | 1998-07-13 | 2000-01-28 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Array type optical modulation element, array type exposure element, and method for driving plane display device |
JP2000057832A (en) | 1998-07-31 | 2000-02-25 | Hitachi Ltd | Lighting system and liquid crystal display device using same |
GB2340281A (en) | 1998-08-04 | 2000-02-16 | Sharp Kk | A reflective liquid crystal display device |
US6710538B1 (en) | 1998-08-26 | 2004-03-23 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Field emission display having reduced power requirements and method |
IT1302170B1 (en) | 1998-08-31 | 2000-07-31 | St Microelectronics Srl | VOLTAGE REGULATOR WITH SOFT VARIATION OF THE ABSORBED CURRENT. |
EP0994373A1 (en) | 1998-09-18 | 2000-04-19 | Ngk Insulators, Ltd. | Display device comprising actuators |
US6962419B2 (en) | 1998-09-24 | 2005-11-08 | Reflectivity, Inc | Micromirror elements, package for the micromirror elements, and projection system therefor |
US6523961B2 (en) | 2000-08-30 | 2003-02-25 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Projection system and mirror elements for improved contrast ratio in spatial light modulators |
DE69834847T2 (en) | 1998-09-24 | 2007-02-15 | Reflectivity Inc., Santa Clara | REFLECTIVE SPATIAL LIGHT MODULATOR WITH DOUBLE SUBSTRATE AND SELF-RESTRICTING MICROMECHANICAL ELEMENTS |
JP2000105547A (en) | 1998-09-29 | 2000-04-11 | Casio Comput Co Ltd | Information processor |
JP2000111813A (en) | 1998-10-05 | 2000-04-21 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Optical modulation element and array type optical modulation element as well as plane display device |
US6288829B1 (en) | 1998-10-05 | 2001-09-11 | Fuji Photo Film, Co., Ltd. | Light modulation element, array-type light modulation element, and flat-panel display unit |
JP2000214393A (en) | 1999-01-20 | 2000-08-04 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Optical modulator, array optical modulator and flat- panel display device |
JP3934269B2 (en) | 1999-01-20 | 2007-06-20 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Flat panel display |
JP2000131627A (en) | 1998-10-27 | 2000-05-12 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Optical modulation element and array type optical modulation element as well as plane display device |
US6323834B1 (en) | 1998-10-08 | 2001-11-27 | International Business Machines Corporation | Micromechanical displays and fabrication method |
JP3919954B2 (en) | 1998-10-16 | 2007-05-30 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Array type light modulation element and flat display driving method |
US6404942B1 (en) | 1998-10-23 | 2002-06-11 | Corning Incorporated | Fluid-encapsulated MEMS optical switch |
US6639572B1 (en) | 1998-10-28 | 2003-10-28 | Intel Corporation | Paper white direct view display |
US6034807A (en) | 1998-10-28 | 2000-03-07 | Memsolutions, Inc. | Bistable paper white direct view display |
IL126866A (en) | 1998-11-02 | 2003-02-12 | Orbotech Ltd | Apparatus and method for fabricating flat workpieces |
US6288824B1 (en) | 1998-11-03 | 2001-09-11 | Alex Kastalsky | Display device based on grating electromechanical shutter |
US6201664B1 (en) | 1998-11-16 | 2001-03-13 | International Business Machines Corporation | Polymer bumps for trace and shock protection |
US6300294B1 (en) | 1998-11-16 | 2001-10-09 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Lubricant delivery for micromechanical devices |
GB2343980A (en) | 1998-11-18 | 2000-05-24 | Sharp Kk | Spatial light modulator and display |
JP4434359B2 (en) | 1999-05-19 | 2010-03-17 | 東芝モバイルディスプレイ株式会社 | Flat display device and manufacturing method thereof |
JP2000172219A (en) | 1998-12-08 | 2000-06-23 | Canon Inc | Display controller, display control method and record medium |
GB9828074D0 (en) | 1998-12-18 | 1999-02-17 | Glaxo Group Ltd | Therapeutically useful compounds |
US6154586A (en) | 1998-12-24 | 2000-11-28 | Jds Fitel Inc. | Optical switch mechanism |
US6498685B1 (en) | 1999-01-11 | 2002-12-24 | Kenneth C. Johnson | Maskless, microlens EUV lithography system |
JP3912760B2 (en) | 1999-01-20 | 2007-05-09 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Driving method of array type light modulation element and flat display device |
JP2000214397A (en) | 1999-01-22 | 2000-08-04 | Canon Inc | Optical polarizer |
JP2000214831A (en) | 1999-01-27 | 2000-08-04 | Hitachi Ltd | Display processor and information processor |
US6266240B1 (en) | 1999-02-04 | 2001-07-24 | Palm, Inc. | Encasement for a handheld computer |
JP2000235152A (en) | 1999-02-12 | 2000-08-29 | Victor Co Of Japan Ltd | Light deflector |
US6556261B1 (en) | 1999-02-15 | 2003-04-29 | Rainbow Displays, Inc. | Method for assembling a tiled, flat-panel microdisplay array having reflective microdisplay tiles and attaching thermally-conductive substrate |
US6476886B2 (en) | 1999-02-15 | 2002-11-05 | Rainbow Displays, Inc. | Method for assembling a tiled, flat-panel microdisplay array |
US6752505B2 (en) | 1999-02-23 | 2004-06-22 | Solid State Opto Limited | Light redirecting films and film systems |
US6827456B2 (en) | 1999-02-23 | 2004-12-07 | Solid State Opto Limited | Transreflectors, transreflector systems and displays and methods of making transreflectors |
US7364341B2 (en) | 1999-02-23 | 2008-04-29 | Solid State Opto Limited | Light redirecting films including non-interlockable optical elements |
US20050024849A1 (en) | 1999-02-23 | 2005-02-03 | Parker Jeffery R. | Methods of cutting or forming cavities in a substrate for use in making optical films, components or wave guides |
US7167156B1 (en) | 1999-02-26 | 2007-01-23 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Electrowetting display |
JP2002538512A (en) | 1999-03-04 | 2002-11-12 | フリクセル リミテッド | Micro mechanical flat panel display with touch sensitive input and vibration source |
JP2000259116A (en) | 1999-03-09 | 2000-09-22 | Nec Corp | Driving method and device for multi-level display plasma display |
US6316278B1 (en) | 1999-03-16 | 2001-11-13 | Alien Technology Corporation | Methods for fabricating a multiple modular assembly |
JP2000275604A (en) | 1999-03-23 | 2000-10-06 | Hitachi Ltd | Liquid crystal display device |
JP2000321566A (en) | 1999-05-11 | 2000-11-24 | Ricoh Microelectronics Co Ltd | Liquid crystal display device |
US6633301B1 (en) | 1999-05-17 | 2003-10-14 | Displaytech, Inc. | RGB illuminator with calibration via single detector servo |
JP2000338523A (en) | 1999-05-25 | 2000-12-08 | Nec Corp | Liquid crystal display device |
US6201633B1 (en) | 1999-06-07 | 2001-03-13 | Xerox Corporation | Micro-electromechanical based bistable color display sheets |
WO2000079338A1 (en) | 1999-06-23 | 2000-12-28 | Citizen Watch Co., Ltd. | Liquid crystal display |
US6507138B1 (en) | 1999-06-24 | 2003-01-14 | Sandia Corporation | Very compact, high-stability electrostatic actuator featuring contact-free self-limiting displacement |
DE60040181D1 (en) | 1999-07-14 | 2008-10-16 | Nec Display Solutions Ltd | See-through protection system with obliquely incident light beam |
JP2001035222A (en) | 1999-07-23 | 2001-02-09 | Minebea Co Ltd | Surface lighting system |
US6248509B1 (en) | 1999-07-27 | 2001-06-19 | James E. Sanford | Maskless photoresist exposure system using mems devices |
JP2001042340A (en) | 1999-08-03 | 2001-02-16 | Minolta Co Ltd | Production of liquid crystal display device |
US6229640B1 (en) | 1999-08-11 | 2001-05-08 | Adc Telecommunications, Inc. | Microelectromechanical optical switch and method of manufacture thereof |
JP3926948B2 (en) | 1999-08-19 | 2007-06-06 | 株式会社小糸製作所 | Vehicle headlamp |
JP3665515B2 (en) | 1999-08-26 | 2005-06-29 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Image display device |
US6322712B1 (en) | 1999-09-01 | 2001-11-27 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Buffer layer in flat panel display |
JP2001075534A (en) | 1999-09-01 | 2001-03-23 | Victor Co Of Japan Ltd | Liquid crystal display device |
JP4198281B2 (en) | 1999-09-13 | 2008-12-17 | 日本ライツ株式会社 | Light guide plate and flat illumination device |
WO2001021580A1 (en) | 1999-09-20 | 2001-03-29 | E.I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company | Multidentate phosphite ligands, catalytic compositions containing such ligands and catalytic processes utilizing such catalytic compositions |
US6275320B1 (en) | 1999-09-27 | 2001-08-14 | Jds Uniphase, Inc. | MEMS variable optical attenuator |
JP3643508B2 (en) | 1999-09-28 | 2005-04-27 | 株式会社東芝 | Movable film type display device |
US6441829B1 (en) | 1999-09-30 | 2002-08-27 | Agilent Technologies, Inc. | Pixel driver that generates, in response to a digital input value, a pixel drive signal having a duty cycle that determines the apparent brightness of the pixel |
JP2001175216A (en) | 1999-10-04 | 2001-06-29 | Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd | High gradation display technology |
KR20010050623A (en) | 1999-10-04 | 2001-06-15 | 모리시타 요이찌 | Display technique for high gradation degree |
WO2003007049A1 (en) | 1999-10-05 | 2003-01-23 | Iridigm Display Corporation | Photonic mems and structures |
US6583915B1 (en) | 1999-10-08 | 2003-06-24 | Lg. Philips Lcd Co., Ltd. | Display device using a micro light modulator and fabricating method thereof |
US7046905B1 (en) | 1999-10-08 | 2006-05-16 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Blacklight with structured surfaces |
CA2323189A1 (en) | 1999-10-15 | 2001-04-15 | Cristian A. Bolle | Dual motion electrostatic actuator design for mems micro-relay |
JP3618066B2 (en) | 1999-10-25 | 2005-02-09 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Liquid crystal display |
US7071520B2 (en) | 2000-08-23 | 2006-07-04 | Reflectivity, Inc | MEMS with flexible portions made of novel materials |
US7041224B2 (en) | 1999-10-26 | 2006-05-09 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Method for vapor phase etching of silicon |
US6690422B1 (en) | 1999-11-03 | 2004-02-10 | Sharp Laboratories Of America, Inc. | Method and system for field sequential color image capture using color filter array |
KR100312432B1 (en) | 1999-11-25 | 2001-11-05 | 오길록 | Optical Switch using Micro Structures |
EP1240708A2 (en) | 1999-11-29 | 2002-09-18 | Iolon, Inc. | Balanced microdevice and rotary electrostatic microactuator for use therewith |
JP2001154642A (en) | 1999-11-30 | 2001-06-08 | Toshiba Corp | Information processor |
JP3639482B2 (en) | 1999-12-01 | 2005-04-20 | 理想科学工業株式会社 | Screen printing apparatus and stencil sheet assembly |
US6700554B2 (en) | 1999-12-04 | 2004-03-02 | Lg. Philips Lcd Co., Ltd. | Transmissive display device using micro light modulator |
US6535311B1 (en) | 1999-12-09 | 2003-03-18 | Corning Incorporated | Wavelength selective cross-connect switch using a MEMS shutter array |
KR100679095B1 (en) | 1999-12-10 | 2007-02-05 | 엘지.필립스 엘시디 주식회사 | Transparent Type Display Device Using Micro Light Modulator |
US6466358B2 (en) | 1999-12-30 | 2002-10-15 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Analog pulse width modulation cell for digital micromechanical device |
JP2001201698A (en) | 2000-01-19 | 2001-07-27 | Seiko Epson Corp | Image display device, optical modulation unit suitable for the same and drive unit |
JP3884207B2 (en) | 2000-01-20 | 2007-02-21 | インターナショナル・ビジネス・マシーンズ・コーポレーション | Liquid crystal display |
EP1118901A1 (en) | 2000-01-21 | 2001-07-25 | Dicon A/S | A rear-projecting device |
JP2002262551A (en) | 2000-02-07 | 2002-09-13 | Fiderikkusu:Kk | Voltage step-down dc-dc converter |
US6407851B1 (en) | 2000-08-01 | 2002-06-18 | Mohammed N. Islam | Micromechanical optical switch |
US6888678B2 (en) | 2000-02-16 | 2005-05-03 | Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. | Irregular-shape body, reflection sheet and reflection-type liquid crystal display element, and production method and production device therefor |
JP4006918B2 (en) | 2000-02-28 | 2007-11-14 | オムロン株式会社 | Surface light source device and manufacturing method thereof |
JP2001242826A (en) | 2000-03-02 | 2001-09-07 | Fujitsu Hitachi Plasma Display Ltd | Plasma display device and its driving method |
WO2001069584A1 (en) | 2000-03-14 | 2001-09-20 | Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha | Image display and image displaying method |
EP1143744B1 (en) | 2000-03-17 | 2008-09-24 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Image display device |
US6747784B2 (en) | 2000-03-20 | 2004-06-08 | Np Photonics, Inc. | Compliant mechanism and method of forming same |
US6593677B2 (en) | 2000-03-24 | 2003-07-15 | Onix Microsystems, Inc. | Biased rotatable combdrive devices and methods |
US6296838B1 (en) | 2000-03-24 | 2001-10-02 | Council Of Scientific And Industrial Research | Anti-fungal herbal formulation for treatment of human nails fungus and process thereof |
US6697035B2 (en) | 2000-03-30 | 2004-02-24 | Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba | Display device and moving-film display device |
JP3558332B2 (en) | 2000-03-30 | 2004-08-25 | 株式会社東芝 | Movable film display |
AU7289801A (en) | 2000-04-11 | 2001-10-23 | Sandia Corp | Microelectromechanical apparatus for elevating and tilting a platform |
US20010043177A1 (en) | 2000-04-14 | 2001-11-22 | Huston James R. | System and method for color and grayscale drive methods for graphical displays utilizing analog controlled waveforms |
US20020034418A1 (en) | 2000-04-19 | 2002-03-21 | Koch Earl D. | Temporary ramp |
US6227677B1 (en) | 2000-04-21 | 2001-05-08 | Mary M. Willis | Portable light |
KR100806056B1 (en) | 2000-04-25 | 2008-02-21 | 코닌클리케 필립스 일렉트로닉스 엔.브이. | Method of reducing errors in displays using double-line sub-field addressing |
US6388661B1 (en) | 2000-05-03 | 2002-05-14 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Monochrome and color digital display systems and methods |
JP2001320310A (en) | 2000-05-09 | 2001-11-16 | Nec Corp | Diversity radio transmitter/receiver |
JP4403633B2 (en) | 2000-05-10 | 2010-01-27 | ソニー株式会社 | Liquid crystal display device and manufacturing method thereof |
US6578436B1 (en) | 2000-05-16 | 2003-06-17 | Fidelica Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for pressure sensing |
JP2001331142A (en) | 2000-05-18 | 2001-11-30 | Canon Inc | Picture display device and method therefor |
JP2001331144A (en) | 2000-05-18 | 2001-11-30 | Canon Inc | Video signal processing device, display device, projector, display method, and information storage medium |
AU2001262065A1 (en) | 2000-05-26 | 2001-12-03 | Chaker Khalfaoui | A stiction-free electrostatically driven microstructure device |
JP2001337649A (en) | 2000-05-29 | 2001-12-07 | Mitsubishi Electric Corp | Plasma display equipment |
CA2843053C (en) | 2000-06-01 | 2015-08-25 | Georgetown University | Systems and methods for monitoring health and delivering drugs transdermally |
AU2001265426A1 (en) | 2000-06-06 | 2001-12-17 | Iolon, Inc. | Damped micromechanical device and method for making same |
US6568811B2 (en) | 2000-06-12 | 2003-05-27 | Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. | Color image display device and projection-type image display apparatus |
JP2001356281A (en) | 2000-06-14 | 2001-12-26 | Sharp Corp | Display element and display device |
JP4439084B2 (en) | 2000-06-14 | 2010-03-24 | 日東電工株式会社 | Liquid crystal display |
US7555333B2 (en) | 2000-06-19 | 2009-06-30 | University Of Washington | Integrated optical scanning image acquisition and display |
JP2002006325A (en) | 2000-06-20 | 2002-01-09 | Nec Corp | Method for manufacturing liquid crystal display panel |
DE60142452D1 (en) | 2000-07-03 | 2010-08-05 | Sony Corp | Optical multilayer structure, optical switching device and image display device |
TW594218B (en) | 2000-07-03 | 2004-06-21 | Alps Electric Co Ltd | Reflector and reflective liquid crystal display device |
JP4801289B2 (en) | 2000-07-11 | 2011-10-26 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Micromirror devices, projectors, printers, and copiers |
US6781742B2 (en) | 2000-07-11 | 2004-08-24 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Digital micromirror device and method of driving digital micromirror device |
US6677709B1 (en) | 2000-07-18 | 2004-01-13 | General Electric Company | Micro electromechanical system controlled organic led and pixel arrays and method of using and of manufacturing same |
JP2002040336A (en) | 2000-07-21 | 2002-02-06 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Optical modulation element and exposure device and flat display device using the same |
JP4460732B2 (en) | 2000-07-21 | 2010-05-12 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Flat display device and exposure apparatus |
US6532044B1 (en) | 2000-07-21 | 2003-03-11 | Corning Precision Lens, Incorporated | Electronic projector with equal-length color component paths |
JP4066620B2 (en) | 2000-07-21 | 2008-03-26 | 日亜化学工業株式会社 | LIGHT EMITTING ELEMENT, DISPLAY DEVICE HAVING LIGHT EMITTING ELEMENT AND METHOD FOR MANUFACTURING DISPLAY DEVICE |
JP2002040337A (en) | 2000-07-24 | 2002-02-06 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Optical modulation element and exposure device and flat display device using the same |
JP4136334B2 (en) | 2000-07-27 | 2008-08-20 | 日本ビクター株式会社 | Information collection system |
JP4542243B2 (en) | 2000-07-28 | 2010-09-08 | エーユー オプトロニクス コーポレイション | Liquid crystal cell, display device, and method of manufacturing liquid crystal cell |
IT1318679B1 (en) | 2000-08-11 | 2003-08-27 | Enichem Spa | PROCESS FOR THE PRODUCTION OF OXYGEN WATER. |
US6559827B1 (en) | 2000-08-16 | 2003-05-06 | Gateway, Inc. | Display assembly |
US7057246B2 (en) | 2000-08-23 | 2006-06-06 | Reflectivity, Inc | Transition metal dielectric alloy materials for MEMS |
US7006275B2 (en) | 2000-08-30 | 2006-02-28 | Reflectivity, Inc | Packaged micromirror array for a projection display |
US6733354B1 (en) | 2000-08-31 | 2004-05-11 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Spacers for field emission displays |
US6738177B1 (en) | 2000-09-05 | 2004-05-18 | Siwave, Inc. | Soft snap-down optical element using kinematic supports |
JP3876600B2 (en) | 2000-09-08 | 2007-01-31 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Electro-optical device driving method, electro-optical device driving circuit, electro-optical device, and electronic apparatus |
US6531947B1 (en) | 2000-09-12 | 2003-03-11 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Direct acting vertical thermal actuator with controlled bending |
US8157654B2 (en) | 2000-11-28 | 2012-04-17 | Nintendo Co., Ltd. | Hand-held video game platform emulation |
WO2002025167A1 (en) | 2000-09-25 | 2002-03-28 | Mitsubishi Rayon Co., Ltd. | Light source device |
GB0024804D0 (en) | 2000-10-10 | 2000-11-22 | Microemissive Displays Ltd | An optoelectronic device |
US6775048B1 (en) | 2000-10-31 | 2004-08-10 | Microsoft Corporation | Microelectrical mechanical structure (MEMS) optical modulator and optical display system |
JP4594510B2 (en) | 2000-11-02 | 2010-12-08 | 三菱電機株式会社 | Transmission type image display device and driving method of transmission type image display device |
US6760505B1 (en) | 2000-11-08 | 2004-07-06 | Xerox Corporation | Method of aligning mirrors in an optical cross switch |
US6762868B2 (en) | 2000-11-16 | 2004-07-13 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Electro-optical package with drop-in aperture |
US6664779B2 (en) | 2000-11-16 | 2003-12-16 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Package with environmental control material carrier |
DE10057783A1 (en) | 2000-11-22 | 2002-06-06 | Siemens Ag | Method for controlling a matrix converter |
JP2004524550A (en) | 2000-11-22 | 2004-08-12 | フリクセル リミテッド | Micro electro mechanical display device |
WO2002045061A2 (en) | 2000-11-29 | 2002-06-06 | E Ink Corporation | Addressing circuitry for large electronic displays |
US6992375B2 (en) | 2000-11-30 | 2006-01-31 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Anchor for device package |
US6414316B1 (en) | 2000-11-30 | 2002-07-02 | Fyodor I. Maydanich | Protective cover and attachment method for moisture sensitive devices |
JP2002229532A (en) | 2000-11-30 | 2002-08-16 | Toshiba Corp | Liquid crystal display and its driving method |
US6504641B2 (en) | 2000-12-01 | 2003-01-07 | Agere Systems Inc. | Driver and method of operating a micro-electromechanical system device |
US7307775B2 (en) | 2000-12-07 | 2007-12-11 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Methods for depositing, releasing and packaging micro-electromechanical devices on wafer substrates |
US6906847B2 (en) | 2000-12-07 | 2005-06-14 | Reflectivity, Inc | Spatial light modulators with light blocking/absorbing areas |
AU2001297774A1 (en) | 2000-12-19 | 2002-10-28 | Coventor, Incorporated | Light transmissive substrate for an optical mems device |
JP4446591B2 (en) | 2000-12-20 | 2010-04-07 | 京セラ株式会社 | Optical waveguide and optical circuit board |
JP4560958B2 (en) | 2000-12-21 | 2010-10-13 | 日本テキサス・インスツルメンツ株式会社 | Micro electro mechanical system |
JP3649145B2 (en) | 2000-12-28 | 2005-05-18 | オムロン株式会社 | REFLECTIVE DISPLAY DEVICE, ITS MANUFACTURING METHOD, AND DEVICE USING THE SAME |
JP2002207182A (en) | 2001-01-10 | 2002-07-26 | Sony Corp | Optical multilayered structure and method for manufacturing the same, optical switching element, and image display device |
JP2002287718A (en) | 2001-01-18 | 2002-10-04 | Sharp Corp | Display device, portable appliance and substrate |
US6947195B2 (en) | 2001-01-18 | 2005-09-20 | Ricoh Company, Ltd. | Optical modulator, optical modulator manufacturing method, light information processing apparatus including optical modulator, image formation apparatus including optical modulator, and image projection and display apparatus including optical modulator |
US6911891B2 (en) | 2001-01-19 | 2005-06-28 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Bistable actuation techniques, mechanisms, and applications |
US20030009898A1 (en) | 2001-01-19 | 2003-01-16 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Characterization of compliant structure force-displacement behavior |
TW548689B (en) | 2001-01-25 | 2003-08-21 | Fujitsu Display Tech | Reflection type liquid crystal display device and manufacturing method thereof |
JP4724924B2 (en) | 2001-02-08 | 2011-07-13 | ソニー株式会社 | Manufacturing method of display device |
US20030058543A1 (en) | 2001-02-21 | 2003-03-27 | Sheedy James B. | Optically corrective lenses for a head-mounted computer display |
JP2002279812A (en) | 2001-03-19 | 2002-09-27 | Casio Comput Co Ltd | Surface light source |
US6746886B2 (en) | 2001-03-19 | 2004-06-08 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | MEMS device with controlled gas space chemistry |
JP2002278501A (en) | 2001-03-19 | 2002-09-27 | Ricoh Co Ltd | Gradation display method, image display method and image display device |
JP4619565B2 (en) | 2001-03-29 | 2011-01-26 | 株式会社リコー | Image forming apparatus |
JP2002297085A (en) | 2001-03-30 | 2002-10-09 | Ricoh Co Ltd | Gradation display method and gradation display device |
TW583299B (en) | 2001-04-13 | 2004-04-11 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Liquid crystal composition, color filter and liquid crystal display device |
JP3912999B2 (en) | 2001-04-20 | 2007-05-09 | 富士通株式会社 | Display device |
US6756317B2 (en) | 2001-04-23 | 2004-06-29 | Memx, Inc. | Method for making a microstructure by surface micromachining |
US6965375B1 (en) | 2001-04-27 | 2005-11-15 | Palm, Inc. | Compact integrated touch panel display for a handheld device |
WO2002091025A2 (en) | 2001-05-04 | 2002-11-14 | L3 Optics, Inc. | Method and apparatus for detecting and latching the position of a mems moving member |
JP2002333619A (en) | 2001-05-07 | 2002-11-22 | Nec Corp | Liquid crystal display element and manufacturing method therefor |
JP2002341343A (en) | 2001-05-14 | 2002-11-27 | Nitto Denko Corp | Lighting device and liquid crystal display device |
JP3475940B2 (en) | 2001-05-14 | 2003-12-10 | ソニー株式会社 | Projector device |
US6429625B1 (en) | 2001-05-18 | 2002-08-06 | Palm, Inc. | Method and apparatus for indicating battery charge status |
US6671078B2 (en) | 2001-05-23 | 2003-12-30 | Axsun Technologies, Inc. | Electrostatic zipper actuator optical beam switching system and method of operation |
JP2002351431A (en) | 2001-05-30 | 2002-12-06 | Sony Corp | Display driving method |
JP3548136B2 (en) | 2001-06-01 | 2004-07-28 | 三洋電機株式会社 | Image processing device |
JP2002365650A (en) | 2001-06-05 | 2002-12-18 | Fujitsu Ltd | Method for manufacturing liquid crystal display panel |
WO2002099527A1 (en) | 2001-06-05 | 2002-12-12 | Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. | Display device based on frustrated total internal reflection |
US6710008B2 (en) | 2002-01-17 | 2004-03-23 | Exxonmobil Chemical Patents Inc. | Method of making molecular sieve catalyst |
US6764796B2 (en) | 2001-06-27 | 2004-07-20 | University Of South Florida | Maskless photolithography using plasma displays |
US6998219B2 (en) | 2001-06-27 | 2006-02-14 | University Of South Florida | Maskless photolithography for etching and deposition |
US7119786B2 (en) | 2001-06-28 | 2006-10-10 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for enabling power management of a flat panel display |
EP1271187A3 (en) | 2001-06-28 | 2004-09-22 | Alps Electric Co., Ltd. | Reflector and reflective liquid crystal display |
US7019809B2 (en) | 2001-06-29 | 2006-03-28 | Citizen Watch Co., Ltd | Liquid crystal display panel having an insulating member to protect lead electrodes |
US7291363B2 (en) | 2001-06-30 | 2007-11-06 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Lubricating micro-machined devices using fluorosurfactants |
FR2826691B1 (en) | 2001-07-02 | 2003-09-26 | Solvay | CIRCUIT FOR RESPIRATING THE CRANKCASE GASES OF AN INTERNAL COMBUSTION ENGINE |
EP1415480A1 (en) | 2001-07-06 | 2004-05-06 | Explay Ltd. | An image projecting device and method |
US7535624B2 (en) | 2001-07-09 | 2009-05-19 | E Ink Corporation | Electro-optic display and materials for use therein |
KR100853131B1 (en) | 2001-07-10 | 2008-08-20 | 이리다임 디스플레이 코포레이션 | Method and apparatus for driving electronic device |
JP2003029295A (en) | 2001-07-11 | 2003-01-29 | Sony Corp | Liquid crystal display device |
JP2003091002A (en) | 2001-07-12 | 2003-03-28 | Alps Electric Co Ltd | Liquid crystal display device |
US6897843B2 (en) | 2001-07-14 | 2005-05-24 | Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. | Active matrix display devices |
JP2003029720A (en) | 2001-07-16 | 2003-01-31 | Fujitsu Ltd | Display device |
JP3909812B2 (en) | 2001-07-19 | 2007-04-25 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Display element and exposure element |
US7057251B2 (en) | 2001-07-20 | 2006-06-06 | Reflectivity, Inc | MEMS device made of transition metal-dielectric oxide materials |
JP2003036057A (en) | 2001-07-23 | 2003-02-07 | Toshiba Corp | Display device |
JP2003036713A (en) | 2001-07-25 | 2003-02-07 | International Manufacturing & Engineering Services Co Ltd | Surface light source device |
EP1279994A3 (en) | 2001-07-27 | 2003-10-01 | Alps Electric Co., Ltd. | Semitransparent reflective liquid-crystal display device |
US6702759B2 (en) | 2001-07-31 | 2004-03-09 | Private Concepts, Inc. | Intra-vaginal self-administered cell collecting device and method |
US6589625B1 (en) | 2001-08-01 | 2003-07-08 | Iridigm Display Corporation | Hermetic seal and method to create the same |
US6980177B2 (en) | 2001-08-03 | 2005-12-27 | Waterstrike Incorporated | Sequential inverse encoding apparatus and method for providing confidential viewing of a fundamental display image |
US7023606B2 (en) | 2001-08-03 | 2006-04-04 | Reflectivity, Inc | Micromirror array for projection TV |
US6576887B2 (en) | 2001-08-15 | 2003-06-10 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Light guide for use with backlit display |
US6863219B1 (en) | 2001-08-17 | 2005-03-08 | Alien Technology Corporation | Apparatuses and methods for forming electronic assemblies |
US6781208B2 (en) | 2001-08-17 | 2004-08-24 | Nec Corporation | Functional device, method of manufacturing therefor and driver circuit |
US6755534B2 (en) | 2001-08-24 | 2004-06-29 | Brookhaven Science Associates | Prismatic optical display |
US20030042157A1 (en) | 2001-08-30 | 2003-03-06 | Mays Joe N. | Baseball bat and accessory bag |
US6784500B2 (en) | 2001-08-31 | 2004-08-31 | Analog Devices, Inc. | High voltage integrated circuit amplifier |
US20030048036A1 (en) | 2001-08-31 | 2003-03-13 | Lemkin Mark Alan | MEMS comb-finger actuator |
JP4880838B2 (en) | 2001-09-05 | 2012-02-22 | 株式会社東芝 | Method and apparatus for assembling liquid crystal display device |
JP2003086233A (en) | 2001-09-07 | 2003-03-20 | Mitsubishi Electric Corp | Flat plate type battery |
US6731492B2 (en) | 2001-09-07 | 2004-05-04 | Mcnc Research And Development Institute | Overdrive structures for flexible electrostatic switch |
JP4785300B2 (en) | 2001-09-07 | 2011-10-05 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | Electrophoretic display device, display device, and electronic device |
JP3928395B2 (en) | 2001-09-21 | 2007-06-13 | オムロン株式会社 | Surface light source device |
JP2003098984A (en) | 2001-09-25 | 2003-04-04 | Rohm Co Ltd | Image display device |
US6794793B2 (en) | 2001-09-27 | 2004-09-21 | Memx, Inc. | Microelectromechnical system for tilting a platform |
CN1559022A (en) | 2001-09-28 | 2004-12-29 | 皇家飞利浦电子股份有限公司 | Apparatus having a flat display |
US6701039B2 (en) | 2001-10-04 | 2004-03-02 | Colibrys S.A. | Switching device, in particular for optical applications |
KR20030029251A (en) | 2001-10-05 | 2003-04-14 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Liquid crystal display device |
US7046221B1 (en) | 2001-10-09 | 2006-05-16 | Displaytech, Inc. | Increasing brightness in field-sequential color displays |
US20090065429A9 (en) | 2001-10-22 | 2009-03-12 | Dickensheets David L | Stiffened surface micromachined structures and process for fabricating the same |
JP4032696B2 (en) | 2001-10-23 | 2008-01-16 | 日本電気株式会社 | Liquid crystal display |
US6809851B1 (en) | 2001-10-24 | 2004-10-26 | Decicon, Inc. | MEMS driver |
JP2003140561A (en) | 2001-10-30 | 2003-05-16 | Seiko Epson Corp | Optoelectronic device and its manufacturing method and electronic equipment |
KR100764592B1 (en) | 2001-10-30 | 2007-10-08 | 엘지.필립스 엘시디 주식회사 | backlight for liquid crystal display devices |
JP2006502421A (en) | 2001-11-06 | 2006-01-19 | キーオティ | Image projection device |
US6936968B2 (en) | 2001-11-30 | 2005-08-30 | Mule Lighting, Inc. | Retrofit light emitting diode tube |
EP1454178A2 (en) | 2001-12-03 | 2004-09-08 | Flixel Ltd. | Display devices |
KR20050044695A (en) | 2001-12-05 | 2005-05-12 | 솔리드 스테이트 옵토 리미티드 | Transreflectors, transreflector systems and displays and methods of making transreflectors |
US7185542B2 (en) | 2001-12-06 | 2007-03-06 | Microfabrica Inc. | Complex microdevices and apparatus and methods for fabricating such devices |
JP2003177723A (en) | 2001-12-11 | 2003-06-27 | Seiko Epson Corp | Method for driving electro-optical device, driving circuit therefor, electro-optical device, and electronic equipment |
US7072096B2 (en) | 2001-12-14 | 2006-07-04 | Digital Optics International, Corporation | Uniform illumination system |
KR100685948B1 (en) | 2001-12-14 | 2007-02-23 | 엘지.필립스 엘시디 주식회사 | A Liquid Crystal Display Device And The Method For Manufacturing The Same |
US6710758B2 (en) | 2001-12-20 | 2004-03-23 | Corning Incorporated | Spatial light modulators with improved inter-pixel performance |
GB2383641A (en) | 2001-12-21 | 2003-07-02 | Nokia Corp | Reflective displays |
JP3755460B2 (en) | 2001-12-26 | 2006-03-15 | ソニー株式会社 | Electrostatically driven MEMS element and manufacturing method thereof, optical MEMS element, light modulation element, GLV device, laser display, and MEMS apparatus |
US6785436B2 (en) | 2001-12-28 | 2004-08-31 | Axiowave Networks, Inc. | Method of and operating architectural enhancement for combining optical (photonic) and data packet-based electrical switch fabric networks with a common software control plane while providing increased utilization of such combined networks |
JP2003202519A (en) | 2001-12-28 | 2003-07-18 | Canon Inc | Stereoscopic image display device |
WO2003060920A1 (en) | 2002-01-11 | 2003-07-24 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Spatial light modulator with charge-pump pixel cell |
KR20040083425A (en) | 2002-01-15 | 2004-10-01 | 코닌클리케 필립스 일렉트로닉스 엔.브이. | Light emitting display device with mechanical pixel switch |
JP4013562B2 (en) | 2002-01-25 | 2007-11-28 | 豊田合成株式会社 | Lighting device |
US6794119B2 (en) | 2002-02-12 | 2004-09-21 | Iridigm Display Corporation | Method for fabricating a structure for a microelectromechanical systems (MEMS) device |
US6897164B2 (en) | 2002-02-14 | 2005-05-24 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Aperture masks for circuit fabrication |
CN1633622A (en) | 2002-02-19 | 2005-06-29 | 皇家飞利浦电子股份有限公司 | Display device |
JP2005517994A (en) | 2002-02-19 | 2005-06-16 | コーニンクレッカ フィリップス エレクトロニクス エヌ ヴィ | Display device |
EP1478964B1 (en) | 2002-02-20 | 2013-07-17 | Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. | Display apparatus |
JP2003248463A (en) | 2002-02-25 | 2003-09-05 | Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd | Liquid crystal display device |
JP2003254115A (en) | 2002-02-26 | 2003-09-10 | Yamaha Motor Co Ltd | Throttle opening sensor |
CA2477490A1 (en) | 2002-02-26 | 2003-09-04 | Martin G. Selbrede | Enhancements to optical flat panel displays |
US6574033B1 (en) | 2002-02-27 | 2003-06-03 | Iridigm Display Corporation | Microelectromechanical systems device and method for fabricating same |
US7283112B2 (en) | 2002-03-01 | 2007-10-16 | Microsoft Corporation | Reflective microelectrical mechanical structure (MEMS) optical modulator and optical display system |
JP2003262734A (en) | 2002-03-08 | 2003-09-19 | Citizen Electronics Co Ltd | Light guide plate |
US7256927B2 (en) | 2002-03-11 | 2007-08-14 | Uni-Pixel Displays, Inc. | Double-electret mems actuator |
US7055975B2 (en) | 2002-03-12 | 2006-06-06 | Memx, Inc. | Microelectromechanical system with non-collinear force compensation |
US6707176B1 (en) | 2002-03-14 | 2004-03-16 | Memx, Inc. | Non-linear actuator suspension for microelectromechanical systems |
US6650806B2 (en) | 2002-03-14 | 2003-11-18 | Memx, Inc. | Compliant push/pull connector microstructure |
US6831390B2 (en) | 2002-03-14 | 2004-12-14 | Memx, Inc. | Microelectromechanical system with stiff coupling |
JP2005521085A (en) | 2002-03-20 | 2005-07-14 | コーニンクレッカ フィリップス エレクトロニクス エヌ ヴィ | Foil display screen drive method and apparatus having the display screen |
JP3895202B2 (en) | 2002-03-22 | 2007-03-22 | 富士通株式会社 | Method and apparatus for forming coating film on inner surface of thin tube |
US7345824B2 (en) | 2002-03-26 | 2008-03-18 | Trivium Technologies, Inc. | Light collimating device |
AU2002256611A1 (en) | 2002-03-26 | 2003-10-08 | Dicon A/S | Micro light modulator arrangement |
JP3875130B2 (en) | 2002-03-26 | 2007-01-31 | 株式会社東芝 | Display device and manufacturing method thereof |
US7053519B2 (en) | 2002-03-29 | 2006-05-30 | Microsoft Corporation | Electrostatic bimorph actuator |
CN100409063C (en) | 2002-04-09 | 2008-08-06 | 赛多尼克股份有限公司 | Light modulating engine |
JP2003313299A (en) | 2002-04-22 | 2003-11-06 | Seiko Epson Corp | Higher order silane composition and process for forming silicon film using the same |
US7125451B2 (en) | 2002-04-23 | 2006-10-24 | Sharp Laboratories Of America, Inc. | Crystal-structure-processed mechanical devices and methods and systems for making |
US7217588B2 (en) | 2005-01-05 | 2007-05-15 | Sharp Laboratories Of America, Inc. | Integrated MEMS packaging |
CA2485162A1 (en) | 2002-05-06 | 2003-11-13 | Uni-Pixel Displays, Inc. | Uni-pixel displays, inc. |
US7362889B2 (en) | 2002-05-10 | 2008-04-22 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Elastomeric actuator devices for magnetic resonance imaging |
US6879307B1 (en) | 2002-05-15 | 2005-04-12 | Ernest Stern | Method and apparatus for reducing driver count and power consumption in micromechanical flat panel displays |
JP4140816B2 (en) | 2002-05-24 | 2008-08-27 | 富士通株式会社 | Micro mirror element |
JP2004004216A (en) | 2002-05-31 | 2004-01-08 | Victor Co Of Japan Ltd | Liquid crystal display device |
JP3871615B2 (en) | 2002-06-13 | 2007-01-24 | 富士通株式会社 | Display device |
US6972889B2 (en) | 2002-06-27 | 2005-12-06 | Research Triangle Institute | Mems electrostatically actuated optical display device and associated arrays |
US6777946B2 (en) | 2002-07-01 | 2004-08-17 | Honeywell International Inc. | Cell buffer with built-in test |
US6741377B2 (en) | 2002-07-02 | 2004-05-25 | Iridigm Display Corporation | Device having a light-absorbing mask and a method for fabricating same |
JP2005532583A (en) | 2002-07-08 | 2005-10-27 | コーニンクレッカ フィリップス エレクトロニクス エヌ ヴィ | Foil display with two light guides |
US20040013204A1 (en) | 2002-07-16 | 2004-01-22 | Nati Dinur | Method and apparatus to compensate imbalance of demodulator |
JP2004053839A (en) | 2002-07-18 | 2004-02-19 | Murata Mfg Co Ltd | Light switching device |
KR20040010026A (en) | 2002-07-25 | 2004-01-31 | 가부시키가이샤 히타치세이사쿠쇼 | Field emission display |
JP3882709B2 (en) | 2002-08-01 | 2007-02-21 | 日本ビクター株式会社 | Driving method of liquid crystal display device |
US7317465B2 (en) | 2002-08-07 | 2008-01-08 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Image display system and method |
KR100484953B1 (en) | 2002-08-12 | 2005-04-22 | 엘지.필립스 엘시디 주식회사 | reflective electrode of reflection or transflective type LCD and fabrication method of thereof |
TWM251142U (en) | 2002-08-14 | 2004-11-21 | Hannstar Display Corp | Liquid crystal display panel |
US6700173B1 (en) | 2002-08-20 | 2004-03-02 | Memx, Inc. | Electrically isolated support for overlying MEM structure |
US7154458B2 (en) | 2002-08-21 | 2006-12-26 | Nec Viewtechnology, Ltd. | Video display device with spatial light modulator |
JP3781743B2 (en) | 2002-08-21 | 2006-05-31 | Necビューテクノロジー株式会社 | Video display device |
CN100374925C (en) | 2002-08-21 | 2008-03-12 | 诺基亚有限公司 | Switchable lens display |
JP2004093760A (en) | 2002-08-30 | 2004-03-25 | Fujitsu Display Technologies Corp | Method of manufacturing liquid crystal display |
JP4595296B2 (en) | 2002-09-18 | 2010-12-08 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | ELECTRO-OPTICAL DEVICE, ELECTRONIC DEVICE, AND PROJECTOR |
US6934080B2 (en) | 2002-09-20 | 2005-08-23 | Honeywell International, Inc. | High efficiency viewing screen |
JP2004117833A (en) | 2002-09-26 | 2004-04-15 | Seiko Epson Corp | Optical attenuator, electronic equipment, and method for driving optical attenuator |
DE60321695D1 (en) | 2002-09-27 | 2008-07-31 | Professional Tool Mfg Llc | DRILL GRINDING DEVICE |
US7102605B2 (en) | 2002-09-30 | 2006-09-05 | Nanosys, Inc. | Integrated displays using nanowire transistors |
US6908202B2 (en) | 2002-10-03 | 2005-06-21 | General Electric Company | Bulk diffuser for flat panel display |
US6967986B2 (en) | 2002-10-16 | 2005-11-22 | Eastman Kodak Company | Light modulation apparatus using a VCSEL array with an electromechanical grating device |
JP3774715B2 (en) | 2002-10-21 | 2006-05-17 | キヤノン株式会社 | Projection display |
US7113165B2 (en) | 2002-10-25 | 2006-09-26 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Molecular light valve display having sequenced color illumination |
US6666561B1 (en) | 2002-10-28 | 2003-12-23 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Continuously variable analog micro-mirror device |
US7370185B2 (en) | 2003-04-30 | 2008-05-06 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Self-packaged optical interference display device having anti-stiction bumps, integral micro-lens, and reflection-absorbing layers |
US6747773B2 (en) | 2002-10-31 | 2004-06-08 | Agilent Technologies, Inc. | Method and structure for stub tunable resonant cavity for photonic crystals |
US7474180B2 (en) | 2002-11-01 | 2009-01-06 | Georgia Tech Research Corp. | Single substrate electromagnetic actuator |
US6911964B2 (en) | 2002-11-07 | 2005-06-28 | Duke University | Frame buffer pixel circuit for liquid crystal display |
KR100513723B1 (en) | 2002-11-18 | 2005-09-08 | 삼성전자주식회사 | MicroElectro Mechanical system switch |
US7405860B2 (en) | 2002-11-26 | 2008-07-29 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Spatial light modulators with light blocking/absorbing areas |
US6844959B2 (en) | 2002-11-26 | 2005-01-18 | Reflectivity, Inc | Spatial light modulators with light absorbing areas |
JP4150250B2 (en) | 2002-12-02 | 2008-09-17 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Drawing head, drawing apparatus and drawing method |
WO2004086098A2 (en) | 2002-12-03 | 2004-10-07 | Flixel Ltd. | Display devices |
JP3873149B2 (en) | 2002-12-11 | 2007-01-24 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Display device |
US6698348B1 (en) | 2002-12-11 | 2004-03-02 | Edgetec Group Pty. Ltd. | Stencil clip for a curb |
JP2004191736A (en) | 2002-12-12 | 2004-07-08 | Ngk Insulators Ltd | Display device |
US7365733B2 (en) | 2002-12-16 | 2008-04-29 | E Ink Corporation | Backplanes for electro-optic displays |
US6857751B2 (en) | 2002-12-20 | 2005-02-22 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Adaptive illumination modulator |
JP2004205973A (en) | 2002-12-26 | 2004-07-22 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Flat plane display element and method of driving the same |
JP2004212444A (en) | 2002-12-27 | 2004-07-29 | Internatl Business Mach Corp <Ibm> | Method for manufacturing liquid crystal display device and device for bonding substrate |
JP2004212673A (en) | 2002-12-27 | 2004-07-29 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Planar display device and its driving method |
JP4238124B2 (en) | 2003-01-07 | 2009-03-11 | 積水化学工業株式会社 | Curable resin composition, adhesive epoxy resin paste, adhesive epoxy resin sheet, conductive connection paste, conductive connection sheet, and electronic component assembly |
US20040136680A1 (en) | 2003-01-09 | 2004-07-15 | Teraop Ltd. | Single layer MEMS based variable optical attenuator with transparent shutter |
TWI234041B (en) | 2003-01-14 | 2005-06-11 | Benq Corp | Low power backlight module |
EP1584114A1 (en) | 2003-01-17 | 2005-10-12 | Diode Solutions, Inc. | Display employing organic material |
JP2004246324A (en) | 2003-01-24 | 2004-09-02 | Murata Mfg Co Ltd | Electrostatic type actuator |
US7359108B2 (en) | 2003-01-27 | 2008-04-15 | Liquavista B.V. | Display device |
US6888657B2 (en) | 2003-01-28 | 2005-05-03 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Multiple-bit storage element for binary optical display element |
JP4493274B2 (en) | 2003-01-29 | 2010-06-30 | 富士通株式会社 | Display device and display method |
US20040145580A1 (en) | 2003-01-29 | 2004-07-29 | Perlman Stephen G. | Apparatus and method for reflective display of images on a card |
US7180677B2 (en) | 2003-01-31 | 2007-02-20 | Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd. | Display device |
US7042622B2 (en) | 2003-10-30 | 2006-05-09 | Reflectivity, Inc | Micromirror and post arrangements on substrates |
US7417782B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2008-08-26 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for spatial light modulation |
JP3669363B2 (en) | 2003-03-06 | 2005-07-06 | ソニー株式会社 | Electrodeposition type display panel manufacturing method, electrodeposition type display panel, and electrodeposition type display device |
US6967763B2 (en) | 2003-03-11 | 2005-11-22 | Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd. | Display device |
US6947624B2 (en) | 2003-03-19 | 2005-09-20 | Xerox Corporation | MEMS optical latching switch |
CA2460765C (en) | 2003-03-19 | 2010-07-06 | Xerox Corporation | Mems optical latching switch |
JP4505189B2 (en) | 2003-03-24 | 2010-07-21 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Transmission type light modulation device and mounting method thereof |
JP4138672B2 (en) | 2003-03-27 | 2008-08-27 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Manufacturing method of electro-optical device |
JP4413515B2 (en) | 2003-03-31 | 2010-02-10 | シャープ株式会社 | Image processing method and liquid crystal display device using the same |
US20060291774A1 (en) | 2003-04-02 | 2006-12-28 | Volker Schoellmann | Foil display |
TW591287B (en) | 2003-04-10 | 2004-06-11 | Au Optronics Corp | Liquid crystal display with an uniform common voltage and method thereof |
JP4396124B2 (en) | 2003-04-11 | 2010-01-13 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Display device, projector, and driving method thereof |
US20040207768A1 (en) | 2003-04-15 | 2004-10-21 | Yin Liu | Electron-beam controlled micromirror (ECM) projection display system |
JP2004317785A (en) | 2003-04-16 | 2004-11-11 | Seiko Epson Corp | Method for driving electrooptical device, electrooptical device, and electronic device |
JP4846571B2 (en) | 2003-04-24 | 2011-12-28 | ディスプレイテック,インコーポレイテッド | Microdisplay system and image display method |
US7129925B2 (en) | 2003-04-24 | 2006-10-31 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Dynamic self-refresh display memory |
US7095546B2 (en) | 2003-04-24 | 2006-08-22 | Metconnex Canada Inc. | Micro-electro-mechanical-system two dimensional mirror with articulated suspension structures for high fill factor arrays |
JP4149305B2 (en) | 2003-04-25 | 2008-09-10 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Optical shutter and image display device using the same |
US6741384B1 (en) | 2003-04-30 | 2004-05-25 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Control of MEMS and light modulator arrays |
US7218499B2 (en) * | 2003-05-14 | 2007-05-15 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Charge control circuit |
US6846089B2 (en) | 2003-05-16 | 2005-01-25 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Method for stacking surface structured optical films |
KR20060014407A (en) | 2003-05-22 | 2006-02-15 | 코닌클리케 필립스 일렉트로닉스 엔.브이. | Dynamic foil display having low resistivity electrodes |
KR101100980B1 (en) | 2003-05-22 | 2011-12-29 | 삼성 엘씨디 네덜란드 알앤디 센터 비.브이. | Display device |
JP4338442B2 (en) | 2003-05-23 | 2009-10-07 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Manufacturing method of transmissive light modulation element |
US20050018322A1 (en) | 2003-05-28 | 2005-01-27 | Terraop Ltd. | Magnetically actuated fast MEMS mirrors and microscanners |
JP4039314B2 (en) | 2003-05-29 | 2008-01-30 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Image reading apparatus having power saving mode |
JP2004354763A (en) | 2003-05-29 | 2004-12-16 | Seiko Epson Corp | Screen, image display device, and rear projector |
US7292235B2 (en) | 2003-06-03 | 2007-11-06 | Nec Electronics Corporation | Controller driver and display apparatus using the same |
CN1234237C (en) | 2003-06-12 | 2005-12-28 | 浙江大学 | Tricolour convergent method for matrix pixel device projector scope |
EP1489449A1 (en) | 2003-06-20 | 2004-12-22 | ASML Netherlands B.V. | Spatial light modulator |
US7221495B2 (en) | 2003-06-24 | 2007-05-22 | Idc Llc | Thin film precursor stack for MEMS manufacturing |
US20050012197A1 (en) | 2003-07-15 | 2005-01-20 | Smith Mark A. | Fluidic MEMS device |
DE10332647A1 (en) | 2003-07-18 | 2005-02-17 | Monty Knopp | Method for image generation with microelectromechanical system (MEMS) switch filters, with several information of colour, red, green, blue plasma monitors reproducing full information per pixel |
JP2005043674A (en) | 2003-07-22 | 2005-02-17 | Moritex Corp | Comb type electrostatic actuator and optical controller using the same |
JP2005043726A (en) | 2003-07-23 | 2005-02-17 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Display element and portable equipment using it |
EP1564571A4 (en) | 2003-08-11 | 2010-01-06 | Murata Manufacturing Co | Buckling type actuator |
TWI294976B (en) | 2003-08-18 | 2008-03-21 | Seiko Epson Corp | Method for controlling optical control device, optical control device, spatial light modulation device, and projector |
US7315294B2 (en) | 2003-08-25 | 2008-01-01 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Deinterleaving transpose circuits in digital display systems |
US6996306B2 (en) | 2003-08-25 | 2006-02-07 | Asia Pacific Microsystems, Inc. | Electrostatically operated micro-optical devices and method for manufacturing thereof |
JP4131218B2 (en) | 2003-09-17 | 2008-08-13 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Display panel and display device |
JP4530632B2 (en) | 2003-09-19 | 2010-08-25 | 富士通株式会社 | Liquid crystal display |
TW200523503A (en) | 2003-09-29 | 2005-07-16 | Sony Corp | Backlight, light guiding plate, method for manufacturing diffusion plate and light guiding plate, and liquid crystal display device |
US20050073471A1 (en) | 2003-10-03 | 2005-04-07 | Uni-Pixel Displays, Inc. | Z-axis redundant display/multilayer display |
JP2005134896A (en) | 2003-10-10 | 2005-05-26 | Japan Aviation Electronics Industry Ltd | Fine movable device |
US7012726B1 (en) | 2003-11-03 | 2006-03-14 | Idc, Llc | MEMS devices with unreleased thin film components |
EP1690247A4 (en) | 2003-11-14 | 2008-11-19 | Uni Pixel Displays Inc | Simple matrix addressing in a display |
US7142751B2 (en) * | 2003-11-18 | 2006-11-28 | Avago Technologies Fiber Ip (Singapore) Pte. Ltd. | Methods and systems for chromatic dispersion compensation in switched grating WDM devices |
JP2005158665A (en) | 2003-11-24 | 2005-06-16 | Toyota Industries Corp | Lighting system |
KR20050055203A (en) | 2003-12-05 | 2005-06-13 | 한국전자통신연구원 | Structure for manufacturing optical module |
US7123796B2 (en) | 2003-12-08 | 2006-10-17 | University Of Cincinnati | Light emissive display based on lightwave coupling |
US7430355B2 (en) | 2003-12-08 | 2008-09-30 | University Of Cincinnati | Light emissive signage devices based on lightwave coupling |
US7161728B2 (en) | 2003-12-09 | 2007-01-09 | Idc, Llc | Area array modulation and lead reduction in interferometric modulators |
US7142346B2 (en) | 2003-12-09 | 2006-11-28 | Idc, Llc | System and method for addressing a MEMS display |
KR100531796B1 (en) | 2003-12-10 | 2005-12-02 | 엘지전자 주식회사 | Optical shutter for plasma display panel and driving method therof |
US7182463B2 (en) | 2003-12-23 | 2007-02-27 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Pixel-shifting projection lens assembly to provide optical interlacing for increased addressability |
FR2864526B1 (en) | 2003-12-26 | 2006-10-13 | Commissariat Energie Atomique | ELECTROSTATIC ACTUATING DEVICE |
KR101029432B1 (en) | 2003-12-29 | 2011-04-14 | 엘지디스플레이 주식회사 | Method and Apparatus of Driving Liquid Crystal Display |
DE10361915B4 (en) | 2003-12-29 | 2009-03-05 | Bausenwein, Bernhard, Dr. | 2-channel stereo image display device with microelectromechanical systems |
JP2005195734A (en) | 2004-01-05 | 2005-07-21 | Fujitsu Ltd | Light-emitting control apparatus, display apparatus, display control apparatus and display control program |
JP4267465B2 (en) | 2004-01-07 | 2009-05-27 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | REFLECTIVE COLOR DISPLAY ELEMENT, ITS MANUFACTURING METHOD, AND INFORMATION DISPLAY DEVICE PROVIDED WITH THE DISPLAY ELEMENT |
US7532194B2 (en) | 2004-02-03 | 2009-05-12 | Idc, Llc | Driver voltage adjuster |
US7342705B2 (en) | 2004-02-03 | 2008-03-11 | Idc, Llc | Spatial light modulator with integrated optical compensation structure |
ITVA20040004A1 (en) | 2004-02-06 | 2004-05-06 | St Microelectronics Srl | OPEN RING VOLTAGE DRIVING METHOD AND CIRCUIT OF A DC MOTOR |
TW200536536A (en) | 2004-02-25 | 2005-11-16 | Schering Corp | Pyrazolotriazines as kinase inhibitors |
US7119945B2 (en) | 2004-03-03 | 2006-10-10 | Idc, Llc | Altering temporal response of microelectromechanical elements |
US7706050B2 (en) | 2004-03-05 | 2010-04-27 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Integrated modulator illumination |
US7855824B2 (en) | 2004-03-06 | 2010-12-21 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Method and system for color optimization in a display |
JP2005257981A (en) | 2004-03-11 | 2005-09-22 | Fuji Photo Film Co Ltd | Method of driving optical modulation element array, optical modulation apparatus, and image forming apparatus |
US6912082B1 (en) | 2004-03-11 | 2005-06-28 | Palo Alto Research Center Incorporated | Integrated driver electronics for MEMS device using high voltage thin film transistors |
TWI244535B (en) | 2004-03-24 | 2005-12-01 | Yuan Lin | A full color and flexible illuminating strap device |
US7304782B2 (en) | 2004-03-24 | 2007-12-04 | Fujifilm Corporation | Driving method of spatial light modulator array, spatial light modulator array, and image forming apparatus |
US20050244099A1 (en) | 2004-03-24 | 2005-11-03 | Pasch Nicholas F | Cantilevered micro-electromechanical switch array |
JP4639104B2 (en) | 2004-03-24 | 2011-02-23 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Light modulation element array driving method, light modulation element array, and image forming apparatus |
US20050225501A1 (en) | 2004-03-30 | 2005-10-13 | Balakrishnan Srinivasan | Self-aligned microlens array for transmissive MEMS image arrray |
US8267780B2 (en) | 2004-03-31 | 2012-09-18 | Nintendo Co., Ltd. | Game console and memory card |
CN1957471A (en) | 2004-04-06 | 2007-05-02 | 彩光公司 | Color filter integrated with sensor array for flat panel display |
US7129938B2 (en) | 2004-04-12 | 2006-10-31 | Nuelight Corporation | Low power circuits for active matrix emissive displays and methods of operating the same |
US7158278B2 (en) | 2004-04-12 | 2007-01-02 | Alexander Kastalsky | Display device based on bistable electrostatic shutter |
JP2007532619A (en) | 2004-04-13 | 2007-11-15 | ケンブリッジ バイオスタビリティ リミテッド | Liquid containing suspended glass particles |
US7026821B2 (en) | 2004-04-17 | 2006-04-11 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Testing MEM device array |
EP1591824B1 (en) | 2004-04-26 | 2012-05-09 | Panasonic Corporation | Microactuator |
JP2005317439A (en) | 2004-04-30 | 2005-11-10 | Seiko Epson Corp | Display panel and display device |
TWI330282B (en) | 2004-04-30 | 2010-09-11 | Chimei Innolux Corp | Light guide plate and backlight moudule using same |
US7476327B2 (en) | 2004-05-04 | 2009-01-13 | Idc, Llc | Method of manufacture for microelectromechanical devices |
US7060895B2 (en) | 2004-05-04 | 2006-06-13 | Idc, Llc | Modifying the electro-mechanical behavior of devices |
US7164520B2 (en) | 2004-05-12 | 2007-01-16 | Idc, Llc | Packaging for an interferometric modulator |
US8025831B2 (en) | 2004-05-24 | 2011-09-27 | Agency For Science, Technology And Research | Imprinting of supported and free-standing 3-D micro- or nano-structures |
US7067355B2 (en) | 2004-05-26 | 2006-06-27 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Package having bond-sealed underbump |
US7952189B2 (en) | 2004-05-27 | 2011-05-31 | Chang-Feng Wan | Hermetic packaging and method of manufacture and use therefore |
US7997771B2 (en) | 2004-06-01 | 2011-08-16 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | LED array systems |
JP4211689B2 (en) | 2004-06-14 | 2009-01-21 | オムロン株式会社 | Diffuser and surface light source device |
US7787170B2 (en) | 2004-06-15 | 2010-08-31 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Micromirror array assembly with in-array pillars |
JP4800305B2 (en) | 2004-06-24 | 2011-10-26 | コーネル リサーチ ファンデーション インク. | Fiber-like composite-based MEMS optical scanner |
US7636795B2 (en) | 2004-06-30 | 2009-12-22 | Intel Corporation | Configurable feature selection mechanism |
US7256922B2 (en) | 2004-07-02 | 2007-08-14 | Idc, Llc | Interferometric modulators with thin film transistors |
CA2572952C (en) | 2004-07-09 | 2012-12-04 | The University Of Cincinnati | Display capable electrowetting light valve |
US20060012781A1 (en) | 2004-07-14 | 2006-01-19 | Negevtech Ltd. | Programmable spatial filter for wafer inspection |
US7187487B2 (en) | 2004-07-30 | 2007-03-06 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Light modulator with a light-absorbing layer |
WO2006017745A2 (en) | 2004-08-05 | 2006-02-16 | Digital Ally, Inc. | Digital video recording flashlight |
US20060033676A1 (en) | 2004-08-10 | 2006-02-16 | Kenneth Faase | Display device |
US7453445B2 (en) | 2004-08-13 | 2008-11-18 | E Ink Corproation | Methods for driving electro-optic displays |
JP2006058770A (en) | 2004-08-23 | 2006-03-02 | Toshiba Matsushita Display Technology Co Ltd | Driving circuit for display apparatus |
US7119944B2 (en) | 2004-08-25 | 2006-10-10 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Micromirror device and method for making the same |
US7215459B2 (en) | 2004-08-25 | 2007-05-08 | Reflectivity, Inc. | Micromirror devices with in-plane deformable hinge |
US6980349B1 (en) | 2004-08-25 | 2005-12-27 | Reflectivity, Inc | Micromirrors with novel mirror plates |
US7889163B2 (en) | 2004-08-27 | 2011-02-15 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Drive method for MEMS devices |
US7551159B2 (en) | 2004-08-27 | 2009-06-23 | Idc, Llc | System and method of sensing actuation and release voltages of an interferometric modulator |
US7515147B2 (en) | 2004-08-27 | 2009-04-07 | Idc, Llc | Staggered column drive circuit systems and methods |
US7505108B2 (en) | 2004-09-02 | 2009-03-17 | Nano Loa, Inc. | Liquid crystal material filling method and liquid crystal material filling apparatus |
US7564874B2 (en) | 2004-09-17 | 2009-07-21 | Uni-Pixel Displays, Inc. | Enhanced bandwidth data encoding method |
US7417735B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2008-08-26 | Idc, Llc | Systems and methods for measuring color and contrast in specular reflective devices |
US20060066540A1 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2006-03-30 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Spatial light modulation display system |
US7545550B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2009-06-09 | Idc, Llc | Systems and methods of actuating MEMS display elements |
US7525730B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2009-04-28 | Idc, Llc | Method and device for generating white in an interferometric modulator display |
US7843410B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2010-11-30 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Method and device for electrically programmable display |
US7446927B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2008-11-04 | Idc, Llc | MEMS switch with set and latch electrodes |
US7184202B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2007-02-27 | Idc, Llc | Method and system for packaging a MEMS device |
US7420725B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2008-09-02 | Idc, Llc | Device having a conductive light absorbing mask and method for fabricating same |
US7345805B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2008-03-18 | Idc, Llc | Interferometric modulator array with integrated MEMS electrical switches |
US7535466B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2009-05-19 | Idc, Llc | System with server based control of client device display features |
US8004504B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2011-08-23 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Reduced capacitance display element |
US20060132383A1 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2006-06-22 | Idc, Llc | System and method for illuminating interferometric modulator display |
US7573547B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2009-08-11 | Idc, Llc | System and method for protecting micro-structure of display array using spacers in gap within display device |
JP4414855B2 (en) | 2004-09-30 | 2010-02-10 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Manufacturing method of transmissive light modulation element |
JP5102623B2 (en) | 2004-11-04 | 2012-12-19 | ランバス・インターナショナル・リミテッド | Long curved wedges in optical films |
US20060104061A1 (en) | 2004-11-16 | 2006-05-18 | Scott Lerner | Display with planar light source |
US7199916B2 (en) | 2004-12-07 | 2007-04-03 | Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. | Light modulator device |
JP4546266B2 (en) | 2005-01-13 | 2010-09-15 | シャープ株式会社 | Sheet image display device |
CN101487950A (en) | 2005-01-31 | 2009-07-22 | 凸版印刷株式会社 | Optical sheet, and backlight unit and display using the same |
US7627330B2 (en) | 2005-01-31 | 2009-12-01 | Research In Motion Limited | Mobile electronic device having a geographical position dependent light and method and system for achieving the same |
JP4534787B2 (en) | 2005-02-21 | 2010-09-01 | ブラザー工業株式会社 | Image forming apparatus |
US9158106B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-10-13 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display methods and apparatus |
US9082353B2 (en) | 2010-01-05 | 2015-07-14 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
ES2528386T3 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-02-09 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Procedures and devices for visual representation |
US7304786B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2007-12-04 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Methods and apparatus for bi-stable actuation of displays |
US7405852B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2008-07-29 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus and methods for manufacture thereof |
US7675665B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2010-03-09 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for actuating displays |
US9261694B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-02-16 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus and methods for manufacture thereof |
US8519945B2 (en) | 2006-01-06 | 2013-08-27 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US7999994B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2011-08-16 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus and methods for manufacture thereof |
US8310442B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2012-11-13 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US8159428B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2012-04-17 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display methods and apparatus |
US7616368B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2009-11-10 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Light concentrating reflective display methods and apparatus |
KR100991044B1 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2010-10-29 | 픽스트로닉스 인코포레이티드 | Display apparatus and methods for manufacture thereof |
US7271945B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2007-09-18 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Methods and apparatus for actuating displays |
US7502159B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2009-03-10 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Methods and apparatus for actuating displays |
US7755582B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2010-07-13 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Display methods and apparatus |
US7304785B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2007-12-04 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display methods and apparatus |
US8482496B2 (en) | 2006-01-06 | 2013-07-09 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling MEMS display apparatus on a transparent substrate |
CA2795356A1 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-08-31 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Methods and apparatus for actuating displays |
US7742016B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2010-06-22 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Display methods and apparatus |
US9229222B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-01-05 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Alignment methods in fluid-filled MEMS displays |
US20080158635A1 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2008-07-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus and methods for manufacture thereof |
US7746529B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2010-06-29 | Pixtronix, Inc. | MEMS display apparatus |
US20070205969A1 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2007-09-06 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Direct-view MEMS display devices and methods for generating images thereon |
US20060209012A1 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2006-09-21 | Pixtronix, Incorporated | Devices having MEMS displays |
WO2006094049A2 (en) | 2005-03-01 | 2006-09-08 | Parallel Synthesis Technologies, Inc. | Polymeric fluid transfer and printing devices |
US9042461B2 (en) | 2005-03-10 | 2015-05-26 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Efficient employment of digital upsampling using IFFT in OFDM systems for simpler analog filtering |
US8004558B2 (en) | 2005-04-07 | 2011-08-23 | Axis Engineering Technologies, Inc. | Stereoscopic wide field of view imaging system |
US7349140B2 (en) | 2005-05-31 | 2008-03-25 | Miradia Inc. | Triple alignment substrate method and structure for packaging devices |
US20060280319A1 (en) | 2005-06-08 | 2006-12-14 | General Mems Corporation | Micromachined Capacitive Microphone |
EP1734502A1 (en) | 2005-06-13 | 2006-12-20 | Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB | Illumination in a portable communication device |
US7826125B2 (en) | 2005-06-14 | 2010-11-02 | California Institute Of Technology | Light conductive controlled shape droplet display device |
US7773733B2 (en) | 2005-06-23 | 2010-08-10 | Agere Systems Inc. | Single-transformer digital isolation barrier |
WO2007002452A2 (en) | 2005-06-23 | 2007-01-04 | E Ink Corporation | Edge seals and processes for electro-optic displays |
US7684660B2 (en) | 2005-06-24 | 2010-03-23 | Intel Corporation | Methods and apparatus to mount a waveguide to a substrate |
US20070052660A1 (en) | 2005-08-23 | 2007-03-08 | Eastman Kodak Company | Forming display color image |
US7449759B2 (en) | 2005-08-30 | 2008-11-11 | Uni-Pixel Displays, Inc. | Electromechanical dynamic force profile articulating mechanism |
US8509582B2 (en) | 2005-08-30 | 2013-08-13 | Rambus Delaware Llc | Reducing light leakage and improving contrast ratio performance in FTIR display devices |
US7355779B2 (en) | 2005-09-02 | 2008-04-08 | Idc, Llc | Method and system for driving MEMS display elements |
WO2007029407A1 (en) | 2005-09-05 | 2007-03-15 | Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha | Backlight device and display device |
KR100668498B1 (en) | 2005-11-09 | 2007-01-12 | 주식회사 하이닉스반도체 | Apparatus and method for outputting data of semiconductor memory |
JP2007155983A (en) | 2005-12-02 | 2007-06-21 | Hitachi Displays Ltd | Liquid crystal display apparatus |
JP2007163647A (en) | 2005-12-12 | 2007-06-28 | Mitsubishi Electric Corp | Image display apparatus |
EP2402933A3 (en) | 2005-12-19 | 2012-10-17 | Pixtronix Inc. | A direct-view display |
US7486854B2 (en) | 2006-01-24 | 2009-02-03 | Uni-Pixel Displays, Inc. | Optical microstructures for light extraction and control |
US8526096B2 (en) | 2006-02-23 | 2013-09-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Mechanical light modulators with stressed beams |
JP4789662B2 (en) | 2006-03-17 | 2011-10-12 | 富士通セミコンダクター株式会社 | Power supply device control circuit, power supply device and control method therefor |
WO2007120887A2 (en) | 2006-04-13 | 2007-10-25 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc | Packaging a mems device using a frame |
US7711239B2 (en) | 2006-04-19 | 2010-05-04 | Qualcomm Mems Technologies, Inc. | Microelectromechanical device and method utilizing nanoparticles |
TW200745680A (en) | 2006-04-19 | 2007-12-16 | Omron Tateisi Electronics Co | Diffuser plate and surface light source device |
US7876489B2 (en) | 2006-06-05 | 2011-01-25 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus with optical cavities |
GB0611125D0 (en) | 2006-06-06 | 2006-07-19 | Liquavista Bv | Transflective electrowetting display device |
EP2029473A2 (en) | 2006-06-21 | 2009-03-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method for packaging an optical mems device |
US7843637B2 (en) | 2006-06-22 | 2010-11-30 | 3M Innovative Properties Company | Birefringent structured film for LED color mixing in a backlight |
JP5125005B2 (en) | 2006-07-04 | 2013-01-23 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Display device and display system using the same |
DE102006033312A1 (en) | 2006-07-17 | 2008-01-31 | Heraeus Kulzer Gmbh | Dental implant system part with a coating |
US20080043726A1 (en) | 2006-08-21 | 2008-02-21 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) | Selective Control of User Equipment Capabilities |
US8872753B2 (en) | 2006-08-31 | 2014-10-28 | Ati Technologies Ulc | Adjusting brightness of a display image in a display having an adjustable intensity light source |
JP2008098984A (en) | 2006-10-12 | 2008-04-24 | Fukushin Techno Research Co Ltd | Portable folding antenna |
EP2080045A1 (en) | 2006-10-20 | 2009-07-22 | Pixtronix Inc. | Light guides and backlight systems incorporating light redirectors at varying densities |
WO2008091339A2 (en) | 2007-01-19 | 2008-07-31 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Mems display apparatus |
JP2013061658A (en) | 2007-01-19 | 2013-04-04 | Pixtronix Inc | Mems display apparatus |
US7852546B2 (en) | 2007-10-19 | 2010-12-14 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Spacers for maintaining display apparatus alignment |
US9176318B2 (en) | 2007-05-18 | 2015-11-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Methods for manufacturing fluid-filled MEMS displays |
EP2139081B1 (en) | 2007-02-23 | 2014-11-05 | Ngk Spark Plug Co., Ltd. | Spark plug and internal combustion engine with spark plug |
US7903104B2 (en) | 2007-03-21 | 2011-03-08 | Spatial Photonics, Inc. | Spatial modulator display system using two memories and display time slices having differing times |
US8152124B2 (en) * | 2007-04-30 | 2012-04-10 | Lang-Mekra North America, Llc | Adjustable support arm for a vehicle exterior rearview mirror assembly |
JP5125378B2 (en) | 2007-10-03 | 2013-01-23 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Control method, control device, display body, and information display device |
JP2009111813A (en) | 2007-10-31 | 2009-05-21 | Seiko Epson Corp | Projector, image data acquisition method for projector, and imaging device |
WO2009102471A1 (en) | 2008-02-12 | 2009-08-20 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Mechanical light modulators with stressed beams |
JP2009207590A (en) | 2008-03-03 | 2009-09-17 | Topcon Corp | Stereomicroscope |
US7920317B2 (en) | 2008-08-04 | 2011-04-05 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display with controlled formation of bubbles |
US8169679B2 (en) | 2008-10-27 | 2012-05-01 | Pixtronix, Inc. | MEMS anchors |
WO2010062647A2 (en) | 2008-10-28 | 2010-06-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | System and method for selecting display modes |
FR2948689B1 (en) | 2009-07-29 | 2011-07-29 | Alcan Int Ltd | GROOVED ANODE OF ELECTROLYTIC TANK |
FI20095988A0 (en) | 2009-09-28 | 2009-09-28 | Valtion Teknillinen | Micromechanical resonator and method of manufacture thereof |
CN103000141B (en) | 2010-02-02 | 2016-01-13 | 皮克斯特罗尼克斯公司 | For controlling the circuit of display device |
US20120133006A1 (en) | 2010-11-29 | 2012-05-31 | International Business Machines Corporation | Oxide mems beam |
JP5870558B2 (en) | 2011-02-17 | 2016-03-01 | 株式会社リコー | Transmission management system, transmission management method, and program |
JP2012230079A (en) | 2011-04-27 | 2012-11-22 | Hitachi-Ge Nuclear Energy Ltd | Nuclear power plant, fuel pool water cooling apparatus, and fuel pool water cooling method |
US9809445B2 (en) | 2011-08-26 | 2017-11-07 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Electromechanical system structures with ribs having gaps |
US8698980B2 (en) | 2011-11-14 | 2014-04-15 | Planck Co., Ltd. | Color regulating device for illumination and apparatus using the same, and method of regulating color |
US20140078154A1 (en) | 2012-09-14 | 2014-03-20 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus with multi-height spacers |
US9201236B2 (en) | 2012-11-27 | 2015-12-01 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus with stiction reduction features |
US20140184573A1 (en) | 2012-12-28 | 2014-07-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Electromechanical Systems Color Transflective Display Apparatus |
US20140184621A1 (en) | 2012-12-28 | 2014-07-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus including dual actuation axis electromechanical systems light modulators |
US9134552B2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2015-09-15 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus with narrow gap electrostatic actuators |
US9176317B2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2015-11-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus incorporating dual-level shutters |
US9134530B2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2015-09-15 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus incorporating dual-level shutters |
-
2006
- 2006-12-01 US US11/607,715 patent/US8310442B2/en active Active
-
2012
- 2012-07-17 US US13/551,025 patent/US20120280971A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2012-09-14 US US13/617,112 patent/US9336732B2/en active Active
Patent Citations (3)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6428173B1 (en) * | 1999-05-03 | 2002-08-06 | Jds Uniphase, Inc. | Moveable microelectromechanical mirror structures and associated methods |
US6798935B2 (en) * | 2000-02-25 | 2004-09-28 | Colibrys S.A. | Switching device, particularly for optical switching |
US20070052636A1 (en) * | 2002-02-09 | 2007-03-08 | Kalt Charles G | Flexible video displays and their manufacture |
Cited By (25)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US9274333B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-03-01 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Alignment methods in fluid-filled MEMS displays |
US9135868B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-09-15 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Direct-view MEMS display devices and methods for generating images thereon |
US9500853B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-11-22 | Snaptrack, Inc. | MEMS-based display apparatus |
US9261694B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-02-16 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus and methods for manufacture thereof |
US8519923B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2013-08-27 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display methods and apparatus |
US9336732B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-05-10 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9087486B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-07-21 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9177523B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-11-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9158106B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2015-10-13 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display methods and apparatus |
US9229222B2 (en) | 2005-02-23 | 2016-01-05 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Alignment methods in fluid-filled MEMS displays |
US8482496B2 (en) | 2006-01-06 | 2013-07-09 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling MEMS display apparatus on a transparent substrate |
US8519945B2 (en) | 2006-01-06 | 2013-08-27 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9128277B2 (en) | 2006-02-23 | 2015-09-08 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Mechanical light modulators with stressed beams |
US8526096B2 (en) | 2006-02-23 | 2013-09-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Mechanical light modulators with stressed beams |
US9176318B2 (en) | 2007-05-18 | 2015-11-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Methods for manufacturing fluid-filled MEMS displays |
US8599463B2 (en) | 2008-10-27 | 2013-12-03 | Pixtronix, Inc. | MEMS anchors |
US9182587B2 (en) | 2008-10-27 | 2015-11-10 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Manufacturing structure and process for compliant mechanisms |
US9116344B2 (en) | 2008-10-27 | 2015-08-25 | Pixtronix, Inc. | MEMS anchors |
US9082353B2 (en) | 2010-01-05 | 2015-07-14 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
US9291813B2 (en) | 2010-12-20 | 2016-03-22 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Systems and methods for MEMS light modulator arrays with reduced acoustic emission |
US9857628B2 (en) | 2011-01-07 | 2018-01-02 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Display device |
US9170421B2 (en) | 2013-02-05 | 2015-10-27 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus incorporating multi-level shutters |
US9134552B2 (en) | 2013-03-13 | 2015-09-15 | Pixtronix, Inc. | Display apparatus with narrow gap electrostatic actuators |
US10685598B2 (en) | 2016-03-25 | 2020-06-16 | Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha | Display panel, display apparatus, and method for manufacturing display panel |
US11024656B2 (en) | 2016-06-28 | 2021-06-01 | Sharp Kabushiki Kaisha | Active matrix substrate, optical shutter substrate, display device, and method for manufacturing active matrix substrate |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
US20070086078A1 (en) | 2007-04-19 |
US9336732B2 (en) | 2016-05-10 |
US8310442B2 (en) | 2012-11-13 |
US20130010344A1 (en) | 2013-01-10 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US9177523B2 (en) | Circuits for controlling display apparatus | |
US9336732B2 (en) | Circuits for controlling display apparatus | |
US8519923B2 (en) | Display methods and apparatus | |
US9158106B2 (en) | Display methods and apparatus | |
US7742016B2 (en) | Display methods and apparatus | |
US7755582B2 (en) | Display methods and apparatus | |
EP1859310B1 (en) | Display methods and apparatus | |
US8482496B2 (en) | Circuits for controlling MEMS display apparatus on a transparent substrate | |
US9530344B2 (en) | Circuits for controlling display apparatus | |
EP2030192B1 (en) | Circuits for controlling display apparatus |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: PIXTRONIX, INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:HAGOOD, NESBITT W.;LEWIS, STEPHEN;MCALLISTER, ABRAHAM;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20090109 TO 20090120;REEL/FRAME:028762/0865 |
|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO PAY ISSUE FEE |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: SNAPTRACK, INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:PIXTRONIX, INC.;REEL/FRAME:039905/0188 Effective date: 20160901 |